public inbox for [email protected]help / color / mirror / Atom feed
[PATCH v9 1/1] Allow recovery via loadable modules. 17+ messages / 4 participants [nested] [flat]
* [PATCH v9 1/1] Allow recovery via loadable modules. @ 2022-12-10 03:40 Nathan Bossart <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 17+ messages in thread From: Nathan Bossart @ 2022-12-10 03:40 UTC (permalink / raw) This adds the restore_library parameter to allow archive recovery via a loadable module, rather than running shell commands. --- contrib/basic_archive/Makefile | 4 +- contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c | 67 ++++++- contrib/basic_archive/meson.build | 7 +- contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl | 44 +++++ doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml | 168 ++++++++++++++++-- doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml | 43 ++++- doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml | 33 ++-- doc/src/sgml/config.sgml | 54 +++++- doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml | 23 ++- src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c | 21 ++- src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c | 13 +- src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c | 70 +++++++- src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c | 26 ++- src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c | 26 +++ src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c | 7 +- src/backend/postmaster/startup.c | 23 ++- src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c | 14 ++ src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c | 10 ++ src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample | 1 + src/include/access/xlog_internal.h | 1 + src/include/access/xlogarchive.h | 44 ++++- src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h | 1 + src/include/utils/guc.h | 2 + 23 files changed, 618 insertions(+), 84 deletions(-) create mode 100644 contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl diff --git a/contrib/basic_archive/Makefile b/contrib/basic_archive/Makefile index 55d299d650..487dc563f3 100644 --- a/contrib/basic_archive/Makefile +++ b/contrib/basic_archive/Makefile @@ -1,7 +1,7 @@ # contrib/basic_archive/Makefile MODULES = basic_archive -PGFILEDESC = "basic_archive - basic archive module" +PGFILEDESC = "basic_archive - basic archive and recovery module" REGRESS = basic_archive REGRESS_OPTS = --temp-config $(top_srcdir)/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.conf @@ -9,6 +9,8 @@ REGRESS_OPTS = --temp-config $(top_srcdir)/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c # which typical installcheck users do not have (e.g. buildfarm clients). NO_INSTALLCHECK = 1 +TAP_TESTS = 1 + ifdef USE_PGXS PG_CONFIG = pg_config PGXS := $(shell $(PG_CONFIG) --pgxs) diff --git a/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c b/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c index 3d29711a31..225a9bd3d4 100644 --- a/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c +++ b/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c @@ -17,6 +17,11 @@ * a file is successfully archived and then the system crashes before * a durable record of the success has been made. * + * This file also demonstrates a basic restore library implementation that + * is roughly equivalent to the following shell command: + * + * cp /path/to/archivedir/%f %p + * * Copyright (c) 2022-2023, PostgreSQL Global Development Group * * IDENTIFICATION @@ -30,6 +35,7 @@ #include <sys/time.h> #include <unistd.h> +#include "access/xlogarchive.h" #include "common/int.h" #include "miscadmin.h" #include "postmaster/pgarch.h" @@ -48,6 +54,8 @@ static bool basic_archive_file(const char *file, const char *path); static void basic_archive_file_internal(const char *file, const char *path); static bool check_archive_directory(char **newval, void **extra, GucSource source); static bool compare_files(const char *file1, const char *file2); +static bool basic_restore_file(const char *file, const char *path, + const char *lastRestartPointFileName); /* * _PG_init @@ -87,6 +95,19 @@ _PG_archive_module_init(ArchiveModuleCallbacks *cb) cb->archive_file_cb = basic_archive_file; } +/* + * _PG_recovery_module_init + * + * Returns the module's restore callback. + */ +void +_PG_recovery_module_init(RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb) +{ + AssertVariableIsOfType(&_PG_recovery_module_init, RecoveryModuleInit); + + cb->restore_cb = basic_restore_file; +} + /* * check_archive_directory * @@ -99,8 +120,8 @@ check_archive_directory(char **newval, void **extra, GucSource source) /* * The default value is an empty string, so we have to accept that value. - * Our check_configured callback also checks for this and prevents - * archiving from proceeding if it is still empty. + * Our check_configured and restore callbacks also check for this and + * prevent archiving or recovery from proceeding if it is still empty. */ if (*newval == NULL || *newval[0] == '\0') return true; @@ -368,3 +389,45 @@ compare_files(const char *file1, const char *file2) return ret; } + +/* + * basic_restore_file + * + * Retrieves one file from the WAL archives. + */ +static bool +basic_restore_file(const char *file, const char *path, + const char *lastRestartPointFileName) +{ + char source[MAXPGPATH]; + struct stat st; + + ereport(DEBUG1, + (errmsg("restoring \"%s\" via basic_archive", file))); + + if (archive_directory == NULL || archive_directory[0] == '\0') + ereport(ERROR, + (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), + errmsg("\"basic_archive.archive_directory\" is not set"))); + + /* + * Check whether the file exists. If not, we return false to indicate that + * there are no more files to restore. + */ + snprintf(source, MAXPGPATH, "%s/%s", archive_directory, file); + if (stat(source, &st) != 0) + { + int elevel = (errno == ENOENT) ? DEBUG1 : ERROR; + + ereport(elevel, + (errcode_for_file_access(), + errmsg("could not stat file \"%s\": %m", source))); + return false; + } + + copy_file(source, path); + + ereport(DEBUG1, + (errmsg("restored \"%s\" via basic_archive", file))); + return true; +} diff --git a/contrib/basic_archive/meson.build b/contrib/basic_archive/meson.build index bc1380e6f6..af4580dea9 100644 --- a/contrib/basic_archive/meson.build +++ b/contrib/basic_archive/meson.build @@ -7,7 +7,7 @@ basic_archive_sources = files( if host_system == 'windows' basic_archive_sources += rc_lib_gen.process(win32ver_rc, extra_args: [ '--NAME', 'basic_archive', - '--FILEDESC', 'basic_archive - basic archive module',]) + '--FILEDESC', 'basic_archive - basic archive and recovery module',]) endif basic_archive = shared_module('basic_archive', @@ -31,4 +31,9 @@ tests += { # which typical runningcheck users do not have (e.g. buildfarm clients). 'runningcheck': false, }, + 'tap': { + 'tests': [ + 't/001_restore.pl', + ], + }, } diff --git a/contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl b/contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ec8767d740 --- /dev/null +++ b/contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl @@ -0,0 +1,44 @@ + +# Copyright (c) 2022, PostgreSQL Global Development Group + +use strict; +use warnings; +use PostgreSQL::Test::Cluster; +use PostgreSQL::Test::Utils; +use Test::More; + +# start a node +my $node = PostgreSQL::Test::Cluster->new('node'); +$node->init(has_archiving => 1, allows_streaming => 1); +my $archive_dir = $node->archive_dir; +$archive_dir =~ s!\\!/!g if $PostgreSQL::Test::Utils::windows_os; +$node->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "archive_command = ''"); +$node->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "archive_library = 'basic_archive'"); +$node->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "basic_archive.archive_directory = '$archive_dir'"); +$node->start; + +# backup the node +my $backup = 'backup'; +$node->backup($backup); + +# generate some new WAL files +$node->safe_psql('postgres', "CREATE TABLE test (a INT);"); +$node->safe_psql('postgres', "SELECT pg_switch_wal();"); +$node->safe_psql('postgres', "INSERT INTO test VALUES (1);"); + +# shut down the node (this should archive all WAL files) +$node->stop; + +# restore from the backup +my $restore = PostgreSQL::Test::Cluster->new('restore'); +$restore->init_from_backup($node, $backup, has_restoring => 1, standby => 0); +$restore->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "restore_command = ''"); +$restore->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "restore_library = 'basic_archive'"); +$restore->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "basic_archive.archive_directory = '$archive_dir'"); +$restore->start; + +# ensure post-backup WAL was replayed +my $result = $restore->safe_psql("postgres", "SELECT count(*) FROM test;"); +is($result, "1", "check restore content"); + +done_testing(); diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml index ef02051f7f..53e657040b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml @@ -1,34 +1,40 @@ <!-- doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml --> <chapter id="archive-modules"> - <title>Archive Modules</title> + <title>Archive and Recovery Modules</title> <indexterm zone="archive-modules"> - <primary>Archive Modules</primary> + <primary>Archive and Recovery Modules</primary> </indexterm> <para> PostgreSQL provides infrastructure to create custom modules for continuous - archiving (see <xref linkend="continuous-archiving"/>). While archiving via - a shell command (i.e., <xref linkend="guc-archive-command"/>) is much - simpler, a custom archive module will often be considerably more robust and - performant. + archiving and recovery (see <xref linkend="continuous-archiving"/>). While + a shell command (e.g., <xref linkend="guc-archive-command"/>, + <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/>) is much simpler, a custom module will + often be considerably more robust and performant. </para> <para> When a custom <xref linkend="guc-archive-library"/> is configured, PostgreSQL will submit completed WAL files to the module, and the server will avoid recycling or removing these WAL files until the module indicates that the files - were successfully archived. It is ultimately up to the module to decide what - to do with each WAL file, but many recommendations are listed at - <xref linkend="backup-archiving-wal"/>. + were successfully archived. When a custom + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> is configured, PostgreSQL will use the + module for recovery actions. It is ultimately up to the module to decide how + to accomplish each task, but some recommendations are listed at + <xref linkend="backup-archiving-wal"/> and + <xref linkend="backup-pitr-recovery"/>. </para> <para> - Archiving modules must at least consist of an initialization function (see - <xref linkend="archive-module-init"/>) and the required callbacks (see - <xref linkend="archive-module-callbacks"/>). However, archive modules are - also permitted to do much more (e.g., declare GUCs and register background - workers). + Archive and recovery modules must at least consist of an initialization + function (see <xref linkend="archive-module-init"/> and + <xref linkend="recovery-module-init"/>) and the required callbacks (see + <xref linkend="archive-module-callbacks"/> and + <xref linkend="recovery-module-callbacks"/>). However, archive and recovery + modules are also permitted to do much more (e.g., declare GUCs and register + background workers). A module may be used for both + <varname>archive_library</varname> and <varname>restore_library</varname>. </para> <para> @@ -37,7 +43,7 @@ </para> <sect1 id="archive-module-init"> - <title>Initialization Functions</title> + <title>Archive Module Initialization Functions</title> <indexterm zone="archive-module-init"> <primary>_PG_archive_module_init</primary> </indexterm> @@ -64,6 +70,12 @@ typedef void (*ArchiveModuleInit) (struct ArchiveModuleCallbacks *cb); Only the <function>archive_file_cb</function> callback is required. The others are optional. </para> + + <note> + <para> + <varname>archive_library</varname> is only loaded in the archiver process. + </para> + </note> </sect1> <sect1 id="archive-module-callbacks"> @@ -129,6 +141,132 @@ typedef bool (*ArchiveFileCB) (const char *file, const char *path); <programlisting> typedef void (*ArchiveShutdownCB) (void); +</programlisting> + </para> + </sect2> + </sect1> + + <sect1 id="recovery-module-init"> + <title>Recovery Module Initialization Functions</title> + <indexterm zone="recovery-module-init"> + <primary>_PG_recovery_module_init</primary> + </indexterm> + <para> + A recovery library is loaded by dynamically loading a shared library with the + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> as the library base name. The normal + library search path is used to locate the library. To provide the required + recovery module callbacks and to indicate that the library is actually a + recovery module, it needs to provide a function named + <function>_PG_recovery_module_init</function>. This function is passed a + struct that needs to be filled with the callback function pointers for + individual actions. + +<programlisting> +typedef struct RecoveryModuleCallbacks +{ + RecoveryRestoreCB restore_cb; + RecoveryArchiveCleanupCB archive_cleanup_cb; + RecoveryEndCB recovery_end_cb; + RecoveryShutdownCB shutdown_cb; +} RecoveryModuleCallbacks; +typedef void (*RecoveryModuleInit) (struct RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb); +</programlisting> + + The <function>restore_cb</function> callback is required for archive + recovery, but it is optional for streaming replication. The others are + always optional. + </para> + + <note> + <para> + <varname>restore_library</varname> is only loaded in the startup and + checkpointer processes and in single-user mode. + </para> + </note> + </sect1> + + <sect1 id="recovery-module-callbacks"> + <title>Recovery Module Callbacks</title> + <para> + The recovery callbacks define the actual behavior of the module. The server + will call them as required to execute recovery actions. + </para> + + <sect2 id="recovery-module-restore"> + <title>Restore Callback</title> + <para> + The <function>restore_cb</function> callback is called to retrieve a single + archived segment of the WAL file series for archive recovery or streaming + replication. + +<programlisting> +typedef bool (*RecoveryRestoreCB) (const char *file, const char *path, const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +</programlisting> + + This callback must return <literal>true</literal> only if the file was + successfully retrieved. If the file is not available in the archives, the + callback must return <literal>false</literal>. + <replaceable>file</replaceable> will contain just the file name + of the WAL file to retrieve, while <replaceable>path</replaceable> contains + the destination's relative path (including the file name). + <replaceable>lastRestartPointFileName</replaceable> will contain the name + of the file containing the last valid restart point. That is the earliest + file that must be kept to allow a restore to be restartable, so this + information can be used to truncate the archive to just the minimum + required to support restarting from the current restore. + <replaceable>lastRestartPointFileName</replaceable> is typically only used + by warm-standby configurations (see <xref linkend="warm-standby"/>). Note + that if multiple standby servers are restoring from the same archive + directory, you will need to ensure that you do not delete WAL files until + they are no longer needed by any of the servers. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="recovery-module-archive-cleanup"> + <title>Archive Cleanup Callback</title> + <para> + The <function>archive_cleanup_cb</function> callback is called at every + restart point and is intended to provide a mechanism for cleaning up old + archived WAL files that are no longer needed by the standby server. + +<programlisting> +typedef void (*RecoveryArchiveCleanupCB) (const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +</programlisting> + + <replaceable>lastRestartPointFileName</replaceable> will contain the name + of the file containing the last valid restart point, like in + <link linkend="recovery-module-restore"><function>restore_cb</function></link>. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="recovery-module-end"> + <title>Recovery End Callback</title> + <para> + The <function>recovery_end_cb</function> callback is called once at the end + of recovery and is intended to provide a mechanism for cleanup following + replication or recovery. + +<programlisting> +typedef void (*RecoveryEndCB) (const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +</programlisting> + + <replaceable>lastRestartPointFileName</replaceable> will contain the name + of the file containing the last valid restart point, like in + <link linkend="recovery-module-restore"><function>restore_cb</function></link>. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="recovery-module-shutdown"> + <title>Shutdown Callback</title> + <para> + The <function>shutdown_cb</function> callback is called when a process that + has loaded the recovery module exits (e.g., after an error) or the value of + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> changes. If no + <function>shutdown_cb</function> is defined, no special action is taken in + these situations. + +<programlisting> +typedef void (*RecoveryShutdownCB) (void); </programlisting> </para> </sect2> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml index be05a33205..f44135061d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml @@ -1180,9 +1180,27 @@ SELECT * FROM pg_backup_stop(wait_for_archive => true); <para> The key part of all this is to set up a recovery configuration that describes how you want to recover and how far the recovery should - run. The one thing that you absolutely must specify is the <varname>restore_command</varname>, - which tells <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> how to retrieve archived - WAL file segments. Like the <varname>archive_command</varname>, this is + run. The one thing that you absolutely must specify is either + <varname>restore_command</varname> or a <varname>restore_library</varname> + that defines a restore callback, which tells + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> how to retrieve archived WAL file + segments. + </para> + + <para> + Like the <varname>archive_library</varname> parameter, + <varname>restore_library</varname> is a shared library. Since such + libraries are written in <literal>C</literal>, creating your own may + require considerably more effort than writing a shell command. However, + recovery modules can be more performant than restoring via shell, and they + will have access to many useful server resources. For more information + about creating a <varname>restore_library</varname>, see + <xref linkend="archive-modules"/>. + </para> + + <para> + Like the <varname>archive_command</varname>, + <varname>restore_command</varname> is a shell command string. It can contain <literal>%f</literal>, which is replaced by the name of the desired WAL file, and <literal>%p</literal>, which is replaced by the path name to copy the WAL file to. @@ -1201,14 +1219,20 @@ restore_command = 'cp /mnt/server/archivedir/%f %p' </para> <para> - It is important that the command return nonzero exit status on failure. - The command <emphasis>will</emphasis> be called requesting files that are not - present in the archive; it must return nonzero when so asked. This is not - an error condition. An exception is that if the command was terminated by + It is important that the <varname>restore_command</varname> return nonzero + exit status on failure, or, if you are using a + <varname>restore_library</varname>, that the restore function returns + <literal>false</literal> on failure. The command or library + <emphasis>will</emphasis> be called requesting files that are not + present in the archive; it must fail when so asked. This is not + an error condition. An exception is that if the + <varname>restore_command</varname> was terminated by a signal (other than <systemitem>SIGTERM</systemitem>, which is used as part of a database server shutdown) or an error by the shell (such as command not found), then recovery will abort and the server will not start - up. + up. Likewise, if the restore function provided by the + <varname>restore_library</varname> emits an <literal>ERROR</literal> or + <literal>FATAL</literal>, recovery will abort and the server won't start. </para> <para> @@ -1232,7 +1256,8 @@ restore_command = 'cp /mnt/server/archivedir/%f %p' close as possible given the available WAL segments). Therefore, a normal recovery will end with a <quote>file not found</quote> message, the exact text of the error message depending upon your choice of - <varname>restore_command</varname>. You may also see an error message + <varname>restore_command</varname> or <varname>restore_library</varname>. + You may also see an error message at the start of recovery for a file named something like <filename>00000001.history</filename>. This is also normal and does not indicate a problem in simple recovery situations; see diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml index 60f23d2855..11fd670dbc 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml @@ -8,17 +8,20 @@ </indexterm> <para> - <filename>basic_archive</filename> is an example of an archive module. This - module copies completed WAL segment files to the specified directory. This - may not be especially useful, but it can serve as a starting point for - developing your own archive module. For more information about archive - modules, see <xref linkend="archive-modules"/>. + <filename>basic_archive</filename> is an example of an archive and recovery + module. This module copies completed WAL segment files to or from the + specified directory. This may not be especially useful, but it can serve as + a starting point for developing your own archive and recovery modules. For + more information about archive and recovery modules, see + see <xref linkend="archive-modules"/>. </para> <para> - In order to function, this module must be loaded via + For use as an archive module, this module must be loaded via <xref linkend="guc-archive-library"/>, and <xref linkend="guc-archive-mode"/> - must be enabled. + must be enabled. For use as a recovery module, this module must be loaded + via <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/>, and recovery must be enabled (see + <xref linkend="runtime-config-wal-archive-recovery"/>). </para> <sect2 id="basic-archive-configuration-parameters"> @@ -34,11 +37,12 @@ </term> <listitem> <para> - The directory where the server should copy WAL segment files. This - directory must already exist. The default is an empty string, which - effectively halts WAL archiving, but if <xref linkend="guc-archive-mode"/> - is enabled, the server will accumulate WAL segment files in the - expectation that a value will soon be provided. + The directory where the server should copy WAL segment files to or from. + This directory must already exist. The default is an empty string, + which, when used for archiving, effectively halts WAL archival, but if + <xref linkend="guc-archive-mode"/> is enabled, the server will accumulate + WAL segment files in the expectation that a value will soon be provided. + When an empty string is used for recovery, restore will fail. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -46,7 +50,7 @@ <para> These parameters must be set in <filename>postgresql.conf</filename>. - Typical usage might be: + Typical usage as an archive module might be: </para> <programlisting> @@ -61,7 +65,8 @@ basic_archive.archive_directory = '/path/to/archive/directory' <title>Notes</title> <para> - Server crashes may leave temporary files with the prefix + When <filename>basic_archive</filename> is used as an archive module, server + crashes may leave temporary files with the prefix <filename>archtemp</filename> in the archive directory. It is recommended to delete such files before restarting the server after a crash. It is safe to remove such files while the server is running as long as they are unrelated diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml index 89d53f2a64..ecdbfd71f7 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml @@ -3773,7 +3773,8 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' recovery when the end of archived WAL is reached, but will keep trying to continue recovery by connecting to the sending server as specified by the <varname>primary_conninfo</varname> setting and/or by fetching new WAL - segments using <varname>restore_command</varname>. For this mode, the + segments using <varname>restore_command</varname> or + <varname>restore_library</varname>. For this mode, the parameters from this section and <xref linkend="runtime-config-replication-standby"/> are of interest. Parameters from <xref linkend="runtime-config-wal-recovery-target"/> will @@ -3801,7 +3802,8 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' <listitem> <para> The local shell command to execute to retrieve an archived segment of - the WAL file series. This parameter is required for archive recovery, + the WAL file series. Either <varname>restore_command</varname> or + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> is required for archive recovery, but optional for streaming replication. Any <literal>%f</literal> in the string is replaced by the name of the file to retrieve from the archive, @@ -3836,7 +3838,42 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows <para> This parameter can only be set in the <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> - file or on the server command line. + file or on the server command line. It is only used if + <varname>restore_library</varname> is set to an empty string. If both + <varname>restore_command</varname> and + <varname>restore_library</varname> are set, an error will be raised. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry id="guc-restore-library" xreflabel="restore_library"> + <term><varname>restore_library</varname> (<type>string</type>) + <indexterm> + <primary><varname>restore_library</varname> configuration parameter</primary> + </indexterm> + </term> + <listitem> + <para> + The library to use for recovery actions, including retrieving archived + segments of the WAL file series and executing tasks at restartpoints + and at recovery end. Either <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> or + <varname>restore_library</varname> is required for archive recovery, + but optional for streaming replication. If this parameter is set to an + empty string (the default), restoring via shell is enabled, and + <varname>restore_command</varname>, + <varname>archive_cleanup_command</varname> and + <varname>recovery_end_command</varname> are used. If both + <varname>restore_library</varname> and any of + <varname>restore_command</varname>, + <varname>archive_cleanup_command</varname> or + <varname>recovery_end_command</varname> are set, an error will be + raised. Otherwise, the specified shared library is used for recovery. + For more information, see <xref linkend="archive-modules"/>. + </para> + + <para> + This parameter can only be set in the + <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> file or on the server command line. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -3881,7 +3918,10 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows </para> <para> This parameter can only be set in the <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> - file or on the server command line. + file or on the server command line. It is only used if + <varname>restore_library</varname> is set to an empty string. If both + <varname>archive_cleanup_command</varname> and + <varname>restore_library</varname> are set, an error will be raised. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -3910,11 +3950,13 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows </para> <para> This parameter can only be set in the <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> - file or on the server command line. + file or on the server command line. It is only used if + <varname>restore_library</varname> is set to an empty string. If both + <varname>recovery_end_command</varname> and + <varname>restore_library</varname> are set, an error will be raised. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> - </variablelist> </sect2> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml index f180607528..6266e2df7f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml @@ -627,7 +627,8 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <para> In standby mode, the server continuously applies WAL received from the primary server. The standby server can read WAL from a WAL archive - (see <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/>) or directly from the primary + (see <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> and + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/>) or directly from the primary over a TCP connection (streaming replication). The standby server will also attempt to restore any WAL found in the standby cluster's <filename>pg_wal</filename> directory. That typically happens after a server @@ -638,9 +639,11 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <para> At startup, the standby begins by restoring all WAL available in the - archive location, calling <varname>restore_command</varname>. Once it - reaches the end of WAL available there and <varname>restore_command</varname> - fails, it tries to restore any WAL available in the <filename>pg_wal</filename> directory. + archive location, either by calling <varname>restore_command</varname> or + by executing the <varname>restore_library</varname>'s restore callback. + Once it reaches the end of WAL available there and + <varname>restore_command</varname> or the restore callback fails, it tries + to restore any WAL available in the <filename>pg_wal</filename> directory. If that fails, and streaming replication has been configured, the standby tries to connect to the primary server and start streaming WAL from the last valid record found in archive or <filename>pg_wal</filename>. If that fails @@ -698,7 +701,8 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. server (see <xref linkend="backup-pitr-recovery"/>). Create a file <link linkend="file-standby-signal"><filename>standby.signal</filename></link><indexterm><primary>standby.signal</primary></indexterm> in the standby's cluster data - directory. Set <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> to a simple command to copy files from + directory. Set <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> or + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> to copy files from the WAL archive. If you plan to have multiple standby servers for high availability purposes, make sure that <varname>recovery_target_timeline</varname> is set to <literal>latest</literal> (the default), to make the standby server follow the timeline change @@ -707,7 +711,8 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <note> <para> - <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> should return immediately + <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> and restore callbacks provided by + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> should return immediately if the file does not exist; the server will retry the command again if necessary. </para> @@ -731,8 +736,10 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <para> If you're using a WAL archive, its size can be minimized using the <xref - linkend="guc-archive-cleanup-command"/> parameter to remove files that are no - longer required by the standby server. + linkend="guc-archive-cleanup-command"/> parameter or the + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/>'s + <function>archive_cleanup_cb</function> callback function to remove files + that are no longer required by the standby server. The <application>pg_archivecleanup</application> utility is designed specifically to be used with <varname>archive_cleanup_command</varname> in typical single-standby configurations, see <xref linkend="pgarchivecleanup"/>. diff --git a/src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c b/src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c index 8458209f49..dfd409905c 100644 --- a/src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c +++ b/src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c @@ -4,7 +4,8 @@ * Recovery functions for a user-specified shell command. * * These recovery functions use a user-specified shell command (e.g. based - * on the GUC restore_command). + * on the GUC restore_command). It is used as the default, but other + * modules may define their own recovery logic. * * Portions Copyright (c) 1996-2023, PostgreSQL Global Development Group * Portions Copyright (c) 1994, Regents of the University of California @@ -24,6 +25,10 @@ #include "storage/ipc.h" #include "utils/wait_event.h" +static bool shell_restore(const char *file, const char *path, + const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +static void shell_archive_cleanup(const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +static void shell_recovery_end(const char *lastRestartPointFileName); static bool ExecuteRecoveryCommand(const char *command, const char *commandName, bool failOnSignal, @@ -31,6 +36,16 @@ static bool ExecuteRecoveryCommand(const char *command, uint32 wait_event_info, int fail_elevel); +void +shell_restore_init(RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb) +{ + AssertVariableIsOfType(&shell_restore_init, RecoveryModuleInit); + + cb->restore_cb = shell_restore; + cb->archive_cleanup_cb = shell_archive_cleanup; + cb->recovery_end_cb = shell_recovery_end; +} + /* * Attempt to execute a shell-based restore command. * @@ -88,7 +103,7 @@ shell_restore(const char *file, const char *path, /* * Attempt to execute a shell-based archive cleanup command. */ -void +static void shell_archive_cleanup(const char *lastRestartPointFileName) { char *cmd; @@ -104,7 +119,7 @@ shell_archive_cleanup(const char *lastRestartPointFileName) /* * Attempt to execute a shell-based end-of-recovery command. */ -void +static void shell_recovery_end(const char *lastRestartPointFileName) { char *cmd; diff --git a/src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c b/src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c index 8f47fb7570..ae537cd87f 100644 --- a/src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c +++ b/src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c @@ -4884,15 +4884,16 @@ static void CleanupAfterArchiveRecovery(TimeLineID EndOfLogTLI, XLogRecPtr EndOfLog, TimeLineID newTLI) { + /* - * Execute the recovery_end_command, if any. + * Execute the recovery-end callback, if any. */ - if (recoveryEndCommand && strcmp(recoveryEndCommand, "") != 0) + if (RecoveryContext.recovery_end_cb) { char lastRestartPointFname[MAXFNAMELEN]; GetOldestRestartPointFileName(lastRestartPointFname); - shell_recovery_end(lastRestartPointFname); + RecoveryContext.recovery_end_cb(lastRestartPointFname); } /* @@ -7307,14 +7308,14 @@ CreateRestartPoint(int flags) timestamptz_to_str(xtime)) : 0)); /* - * Finally, execute archive_cleanup_command, if any. + * Execute the archive-cleanup callback, if any. */ - if (archiveCleanupCommand && strcmp(archiveCleanupCommand, "") != 0) + if (RecoveryContext.archive_cleanup_cb) { char lastRestartPointFname[MAXFNAMELEN]; GetOldestRestartPointFileName(lastRestartPointFname); - shell_archive_cleanup(lastRestartPointFname); + RecoveryContext.archive_cleanup_cb(lastRestartPointFname); } return true; diff --git a/src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c b/src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c index 4b89addf97..4af5689c25 100644 --- a/src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c +++ b/src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c @@ -22,6 +22,8 @@ #include "access/xlog.h" #include "access/xlog_internal.h" #include "access/xlogarchive.h" +#include "access/xlogrecovery.h" +#include "fmgr.h" #include "miscadmin.h" #include "pgstat.h" #include "postmaster/startup.h" @@ -31,6 +33,11 @@ #include "storage/ipc.h" #include "storage/lwlock.h" +/* + * Global context for recovery-related callbacks. + */ +RecoveryModuleCallbacks RecoveryContext; + /* * Attempt to retrieve the specified file from off-line archival storage. * If successful, fill "path" with its complete path (note that this will be @@ -70,7 +77,7 @@ RestoreArchivedFile(char *path, const char *xlogfname, goto not_available; /* In standby mode, restore_command might not be supplied */ - if (recoveryRestoreCommand == NULL || strcmp(recoveryRestoreCommand, "") == 0) + if (RecoveryContext.restore_cb == NULL) goto not_available; /* @@ -148,14 +155,15 @@ RestoreArchivedFile(char *path, const char *xlogfname, XLogFileName(lastRestartPointFname, 0, 0L, wal_segment_size); /* - * Check signals before restore command and reset afterwards. + * Check signals before restore callback and reset afterwards. */ PreRestoreCommand(); /* * Copy xlog from archival storage to XLOGDIR */ - ret = shell_restore(xlogfname, xlogpath, lastRestartPointFname); + ret = RecoveryContext.restore_cb(xlogfname, xlogpath, + lastRestartPointFname); PostRestoreCommand(); @@ -602,3 +610,59 @@ XLogArchiveCleanup(const char *xlog) unlink(archiveStatusPath); /* should we complain about failure? */ } + +/* + * Loads all the recovery callbacks into our global RecoveryContext. The + * caller is responsible for validating the combination of library/command + * parameters that are set (e.g., restore_command and restore_library cannot + * both be set). + */ +void +LoadRecoveryCallbacks(void) +{ + RecoveryModuleInit init; + + /* + * If the shell command is enabled, use our special initialization + * function. Otherwise, load the library and call its + * _PG_recovery_module_init(). + */ + if (restoreLibrary[0] == '\0') + init = shell_restore_init; + else + init = (RecoveryModuleInit) + load_external_function(restoreLibrary, "_PG_recovery_module_init", + false, NULL); + + if (init == NULL) + ereport(ERROR, + (errmsg("recovery modules have to define the symbol " + "_PG_recovery_module_init"))); + + memset(&RecoveryContext, 0, sizeof(RecoveryModuleCallbacks)); + (*init) (&RecoveryContext); + + /* + * If using shell commands, remove callbacks for any commands that are not + * set. + */ + if (restoreLibrary[0] == '\0') + { + if (recoveryRestoreCommand[0] == '\0') + RecoveryContext.restore_cb = NULL; + if (archiveCleanupCommand[0] == '\0') + RecoveryContext.archive_cleanup_cb = NULL; + if (recoveryEndCommand[0] == '\0') + RecoveryContext.recovery_end_cb = NULL; + } +} + +/* + * Call the shutdown callback of the loaded recovery module, if defined. + */ +void +call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb(int code, Datum arg) +{ + if (RecoveryContext.shutdown_cb) + RecoveryContext.shutdown_cb(); +} diff --git a/src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c b/src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c index 5e65785306..db0cd4469a 100644 --- a/src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c +++ b/src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c @@ -80,6 +80,7 @@ const struct config_enum_entry recovery_target_action_options[] = { /* options formerly taken from recovery.conf for archive recovery */ char *recoveryRestoreCommand = NULL; +char *restoreLibrary = NULL; char *recoveryEndCommand = NULL; char *archiveCleanupCommand = NULL; RecoveryTargetType recoveryTarget = RECOVERY_TARGET_UNSET; @@ -1053,24 +1054,37 @@ validateRecoveryParameters(void) if (!ArchiveRecoveryRequested) return; + /* + * Check for invalid combinations of the command/library parameters and + * load the callbacks. + */ + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + recoveryRestoreCommand, "restore_command"); + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + recoveryEndCommand, "recovery_end_command"); + before_shmem_exit(call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb, 0); + LoadRecoveryCallbacks(); + /* * Check for compulsory parameters */ if (StandbyModeRequested) { if ((PrimaryConnInfo == NULL || strcmp(PrimaryConnInfo, "") == 0) && - (recoveryRestoreCommand == NULL || strcmp(recoveryRestoreCommand, "") == 0)) + RecoveryContext.restore_cb == NULL) ereport(WARNING, - (errmsg("specified neither primary_conninfo nor restore_command"), - errhint("The database server will regularly poll the pg_wal subdirectory to check for files placed there."))); + (errmsg("specified neither primary_conninfo nor restore_command " + "nor a restore_library that defines a restore callback"), + errhint("The database server will regularly poll the pg_wal " + "subdirectory to check for files placed there."))); } else { - if (recoveryRestoreCommand == NULL || - strcmp(recoveryRestoreCommand, "") == 0) + if (RecoveryContext.restore_cb == NULL) ereport(FATAL, (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), - errmsg("must specify restore_command when standby mode is not enabled"))); + errmsg("must specify restore_command or a restore_library that defines " + "a restore callback when standby mode is not enabled"))); } /* diff --git a/src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c b/src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c index de0bbbfa79..6350fd0b83 100644 --- a/src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c +++ b/src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c @@ -38,6 +38,7 @@ #include "access/xlog.h" #include "access/xlog_internal.h" +#include "access/xlogarchive.h" #include "access/xlogrecovery.h" #include "libpq/pqsignal.h" #include "miscadmin.h" @@ -222,6 +223,16 @@ CheckpointerMain(void) */ before_shmem_exit(pgstat_before_server_shutdown, 0); + /* + * Check for invalid combinations of the command/library parameters and + * load the callbacks. We do this before setting up the exception handler + * so that any problems result in a server crash shortly after startup. + */ + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + archiveCleanupCommand, "archive_cleanup_command"); + before_shmem_exit(call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb, 0); + LoadRecoveryCallbacks(); + /* * Create a memory context that we will do all our work in. We do this so * that we can reset the context during error recovery and thereby avoid @@ -548,6 +559,9 @@ HandleCheckpointerInterrupts(void) if (ConfigReloadPending) { + char *prevRestoreLibrary = pstrdup(restoreLibrary); + char *prevArchiveCleanupCommand = pstrdup(archiveCleanupCommand); + ConfigReloadPending = false; ProcessConfigFile(PGC_SIGHUP); @@ -563,6 +577,18 @@ HandleCheckpointerInterrupts(void) * because of SIGHUP. */ UpdateSharedMemoryConfig(); + + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + archiveCleanupCommand, "archive_cleanup_command"); + if (strcmp(prevRestoreLibrary, restoreLibrary) != 0 || + strcmp(prevArchiveCleanupCommand, archiveCleanupCommand) != 0) + { + call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb(0, (Datum) 0); + LoadRecoveryCallbacks(); + } + + pfree(prevRestoreLibrary); + pfree(prevArchiveCleanupCommand); } if (ShutdownRequestPending) { diff --git a/src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c b/src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c index 8ecdb9ca23..8e91f2d70f 100644 --- a/src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c +++ b/src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c @@ -831,11 +831,8 @@ LoadArchiveLibrary(void) { ArchiveModuleInit archive_init; - if (XLogArchiveLibrary[0] != '\0' && XLogArchiveCommand[0] != '\0') - ereport(ERROR, - (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), - errmsg("both archive_command and archive_library set"), - errdetail("Only one of archive_command, archive_library may be set."))); + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(XLogArchiveLibrary, "archive_library", + XLogArchiveCommand, "archive_command"); memset(&ArchiveContext, 0, sizeof(ArchiveModuleCallbacks)); diff --git a/src/backend/postmaster/startup.c b/src/backend/postmaster/startup.c index 8786186898..f9ff2b5583 100644 --- a/src/backend/postmaster/startup.c +++ b/src/backend/postmaster/startup.c @@ -20,6 +20,7 @@ #include "postgres.h" #include "access/xlog.h" +#include "access/xlogarchive.h" #include "access/xlogrecovery.h" #include "access/xlogutils.h" #include "libpq/pqsignal.h" @@ -133,13 +134,17 @@ StartupProcShutdownHandler(SIGNAL_ARGS) * Re-read the config file. * * If one of the critical walreceiver options has changed, flag xlog.c - * to restart it. + * to restart it. Also, check for invalid combinations of the command/library + * parameters and reload the recovery callbacks if necessary. */ static void StartupRereadConfig(void) { char *conninfo = pstrdup(PrimaryConnInfo); char *slotname = pstrdup(PrimarySlotName); + char *prevRestoreLibrary = pstrdup(restoreLibrary); + char *prevRestoreCommand = pstrdup(recoveryRestoreCommand); + char *prevRecoveryEndCommand = pstrdup(recoveryEndCommand); bool tempSlot = wal_receiver_create_temp_slot; bool conninfoChanged; bool slotnameChanged; @@ -161,6 +166,22 @@ StartupRereadConfig(void) if (conninfoChanged || slotnameChanged || tempSlotChanged) StartupRequestWalReceiverRestart(); + + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + recoveryRestoreCommand, "restore_command"); + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + recoveryEndCommand, "recovery_end_command"); + if (strcmp(prevRestoreLibrary, restoreLibrary) != 0 || + strcmp(prevRestoreCommand, recoveryRestoreCommand) != 0 || + strcmp(prevRecoveryEndCommand, recoveryEndCommand) != 0) + { + call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb(0, (Datum) 0); + LoadRecoveryCallbacks(); + } + + pfree(prevRestoreLibrary); + pfree(prevRestoreCommand); + pfree(prevRecoveryEndCommand); } /* Handle various signals that might be sent to the startup process */ diff --git a/src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c b/src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c index d52069f446..7858e9a649 100644 --- a/src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c +++ b/src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c @@ -6880,3 +6880,17 @@ call_enum_check_hook(struct config_enum *conf, int *newval, void **extra, return true; } + +/* + * ERROR if both parameters are set. + */ +void +CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(const char *p1val, const char *p1name, + const char *p2val, const char *p2name) +{ + if (p1val[0] != '\0' && p2val[0] != '\0') + ereport(ERROR, + (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), + errmsg("both %s and %s set", p1name, p2name), + errdetail("Only one of %s, %s may be set.", p1name, p2name))); +} diff --git a/src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c b/src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c index 5025e80f89..a8a516b0c6 100644 --- a/src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c +++ b/src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c @@ -3776,6 +3776,16 @@ struct config_string ConfigureNamesString[] = NULL, NULL, NULL }, + { + {"restore_library", PGC_SIGHUP, WAL_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY, + gettext_noop("Sets the library that will be called for recovery actions."), + NULL + }, + &restoreLibrary, + "", + NULL, NULL, NULL + }, + { {"archive_cleanup_command", PGC_SIGHUP, WAL_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY, gettext_noop("Sets the shell command that will be executed at every restart point."), diff --git a/src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample b/src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample index 4cceda4162..38fb3e0823 100644 --- a/src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample +++ b/src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample @@ -269,6 +269,7 @@ # placeholders: %p = path of file to restore # %f = file name only # e.g. 'cp /mnt/server/archivedir/%f %p' +#restore_library = '' # library to use for recovery actions #archive_cleanup_command = '' # command to execute at every restartpoint #recovery_end_command = '' # command to execute at completion of recovery diff --git a/src/include/access/xlog_internal.h b/src/include/access/xlog_internal.h index 59fc7bc105..756f0898b5 100644 --- a/src/include/access/xlog_internal.h +++ b/src/include/access/xlog_internal.h @@ -400,5 +400,6 @@ extern PGDLLIMPORT bool ArchiveRecoveryRequested; extern PGDLLIMPORT bool InArchiveRecovery; extern PGDLLIMPORT bool StandbyMode; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *recoveryRestoreCommand; +extern PGDLLIMPORT char *restoreLibrary; #endif /* XLOG_INTERNAL_H */ diff --git a/src/include/access/xlogarchive.h b/src/include/access/xlogarchive.h index 299304703e..71c9b88165 100644 --- a/src/include/access/xlogarchive.h +++ b/src/include/access/xlogarchive.h @@ -30,9 +30,45 @@ extern bool XLogArchiveIsReady(const char *xlog); extern bool XLogArchiveIsReadyOrDone(const char *xlog); extern void XLogArchiveCleanup(const char *xlog); -extern bool shell_restore(const char *file, const char *path, - const char *lastRestartPointFileName); -extern void shell_archive_cleanup(const char *lastRestartPointFileName); -extern void shell_recovery_end(const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +/* + * Recovery module callbacks + * + * These callback functions should be defined by recovery libraries and + * returned via _PG_recovery_module_init(). For more information about the + * purpose of each callback, refer to the recovery modules documentation. + */ +typedef bool (*RecoveryRestoreCB) (const char *file, const char *path, + const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +typedef void (*RecoveryArchiveCleanupCB) (const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +typedef void (*RecoveryEndCB) (const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +typedef void (*RecoveryShutdownCB) (void); + +typedef struct RecoveryModuleCallbacks +{ + RecoveryRestoreCB restore_cb; + RecoveryArchiveCleanupCB archive_cleanup_cb; + RecoveryEndCB recovery_end_cb; + RecoveryShutdownCB shutdown_cb; +} RecoveryModuleCallbacks; + +extern RecoveryModuleCallbacks RecoveryContext; + +/* + * Type of the shared library symbol _PG_recovery_module_init that is looked up + * when loading a recovery library. + */ +typedef void (*RecoveryModuleInit) (RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb); + +extern PGDLLEXPORT void _PG_recovery_module_init(RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb); + +extern void LoadRecoveryCallbacks(void); +extern void call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb(int code, Datum arg); + +/* + * Since the logic for recovery via a shell command is in the core server and + * does not need to be loaded via a shared library, it has a special + * initialization function. + */ +extern void shell_restore_init(RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb); #endif /* XLOG_ARCHIVE_H */ diff --git a/src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h b/src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h index 47c29350f5..35d1d09374 100644 --- a/src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h +++ b/src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h @@ -55,6 +55,7 @@ extern PGDLLIMPORT int recovery_min_apply_delay; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *PrimaryConnInfo; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *PrimarySlotName; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *recoveryRestoreCommand; +extern PGDLLIMPORT char *restoreLibrary; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *recoveryEndCommand; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *archiveCleanupCommand; diff --git a/src/include/utils/guc.h b/src/include/utils/guc.h index ba89d013e6..947597247f 100644 --- a/src/include/utils/guc.h +++ b/src/include/utils/guc.h @@ -404,6 +404,8 @@ extern void *guc_malloc(int elevel, size_t size); extern pg_nodiscard void *guc_realloc(int elevel, void *old, size_t size); extern char *guc_strdup(int elevel, const char *src); extern void guc_free(void *ptr); +extern void CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(const char *p1val, const char *p1name, + const char *p2val, const char *p2name); #ifdef EXEC_BACKEND extern void write_nondefault_variables(GucContext context); -- 2.25.1 --1yeeQ81UyVL57Vl7-- ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 17+ messages in thread
* [PATCH v1 3/3] Allow recovery via loadable modules. @ 2022-12-10 03:40 Nathan Bossart <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 17+ messages in thread From: Nathan Bossart @ 2022-12-10 03:40 UTC (permalink / raw) This adds the restore_library, archive_cleanup_library, and recovery_end_library parameters to allow archive recovery via a loadable module, rather than running shell commands. --- contrib/basic_archive/Makefile | 4 +- contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c | 69 ++++++- contrib/basic_archive/meson.build | 7 +- contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl | 42 +++++ doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml | 176 ++++++++++++++++-- doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml | 40 +++- doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml | 33 ++-- doc/src/sgml/config.sgml | 99 +++++++++- doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml | 18 +- src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c | 21 ++- src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c | 13 +- src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c | 131 ++++++++++++- src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c | 20 +- src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c | 23 +++ src/backend/postmaster/startup.c | 22 ++- src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c | 30 +++ src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample | 3 + src/include/access/xlog_internal.h | 1 + src/include/access/xlogarchive.h | 43 ++++- src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h | 3 + 20 files changed, 724 insertions(+), 74 deletions(-) create mode 100644 contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl diff --git a/contrib/basic_archive/Makefile b/contrib/basic_archive/Makefile index 55d299d650..487dc563f3 100644 --- a/contrib/basic_archive/Makefile +++ b/contrib/basic_archive/Makefile @@ -1,7 +1,7 @@ # contrib/basic_archive/Makefile MODULES = basic_archive -PGFILEDESC = "basic_archive - basic archive module" +PGFILEDESC = "basic_archive - basic archive and recovery module" REGRESS = basic_archive REGRESS_OPTS = --temp-config $(top_srcdir)/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.conf @@ -9,6 +9,8 @@ REGRESS_OPTS = --temp-config $(top_srcdir)/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c # which typical installcheck users do not have (e.g. buildfarm clients). NO_INSTALLCHECK = 1 +TAP_TESTS = 1 + ifdef USE_PGXS PG_CONFIG = pg_config PGXS := $(shell $(PG_CONFIG) --pgxs) diff --git a/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c b/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c index 9f221816bb..2a702455ca 100644 --- a/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c +++ b/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c @@ -17,6 +17,11 @@ * a file is successfully archived and then the system crashes before * a durable record of the success has been made. * + * This file also demonstrates a basic restore library implementation that + * is roughly equivalent to the following shell command: + * + * cp /path/to/archivedir/%f %p + * * Copyright (c) 2022, PostgreSQL Global Development Group * * IDENTIFICATION @@ -30,6 +35,7 @@ #include <sys/time.h> #include <unistd.h> +#include "access/xlogarchive.h" #include "common/int.h" #include "miscadmin.h" #include "postmaster/pgarch.h" @@ -48,6 +54,8 @@ static bool basic_archive_file(const char *file, const char *path); static void basic_archive_file_internal(const char *file, const char *path); static bool check_archive_directory(char **newval, void **extra, GucSource source); static bool compare_files(const char *file1, const char *file2); +static bool basic_restore_file(const char *file, const char *path, + const char *lastRestartPointFileName); /* * _PG_init @@ -87,6 +95,19 @@ _PG_archive_module_init(ArchiveModuleCallbacks *cb) cb->archive_file_cb = basic_archive_file; } +/* + * _PG_recovery_module_init + * + * Returns the module's restore callback. + */ +void +_PG_recovery_module_init(RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb) +{ + AssertVariableIsOfType(&_PG_recovery_module_init, RecoveryModuleInit); + + cb->restore_cb = basic_restore_file; +} + /* * check_archive_directory * @@ -99,8 +120,8 @@ check_archive_directory(char **newval, void **extra, GucSource source) /* * The default value is an empty string, so we have to accept that value. - * Our check_configured callback also checks for this and prevents - * archiving from proceeding if it is still empty. + * Our check_configured and restore callbacks also check for this and + * prevent archiving or recovery from proceeding if it is still empty. */ if (*newval == NULL || *newval[0] == '\0') return true; @@ -368,3 +389,47 @@ compare_files(const char *file1, const char *file2) return ret; } + +/* + * basic_restore_file + * + * Retrieves one file from the WAL archives. + */ +static bool +basic_restore_file(const char *file, const char *path, + const char *lastRestartPointFileName) +{ + char source[MAXPGPATH]; + struct stat st; + + ereport(DEBUG1, + (errmsg("restoring \"%s\" via basic_archive", file))); + + if (archive_directory == NULL || archive_directory[0] == '\0') + ereport(ERROR, + (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), + errmsg("\"basic_archive.archive_directory\" is not set"))); + + /* + * Check whether the file exists. If not, we return false to indicate that + * there are no more files to restore. + */ + snprintf(source, MAXPGPATH, "%s/%s", archive_directory, file); + if (stat(source, &st) != 0) + { + int elevel = (errno == ENOENT) ? DEBUG1 : ERROR; + + ereport(elevel, + (errcode_for_file_access(), + errmsg("could not stat file \"%s\": %m", source))); + return false; + } + + copy_file(source, unconstify(char *, path)); + fsync_fname(path, false); + fsync_fname(archive_directory, true); + + ereport(DEBUG1, + (errmsg("restored \"%s\" via basic_archive", file))); + return true; +} diff --git a/contrib/basic_archive/meson.build b/contrib/basic_archive/meson.build index b25dce99a3..5b5a6d79e7 100644 --- a/contrib/basic_archive/meson.build +++ b/contrib/basic_archive/meson.build @@ -7,7 +7,7 @@ basic_archive_sources = files( if host_system == 'windows' basic_archive_sources += rc_lib_gen.process(win32ver_rc, extra_args: [ '--NAME', 'basic_archive', - '--FILEDESC', 'basic_archive - basic archive module',]) + '--FILEDESC', 'basic_archive - basic archive and recovery module',]) endif basic_archive = shared_module('basic_archive', @@ -31,4 +31,9 @@ tests += { # which typical runningcheck users do not have (e.g. buildfarm clients). 'runningcheck': false, }, + 'tap': { + 'tests': [ + 't/001_restore.pl', + ], + }, } diff --git a/contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl b/contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..86ff0dc7f5 --- /dev/null +++ b/contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl @@ -0,0 +1,42 @@ + +# Copyright (c) 2022, PostgreSQL Global Development Group + +use strict; +use warnings; +use PostgreSQL::Test::Cluster; +use Test::More; + +# start a node +my $node = PostgreSQL::Test::Cluster->new('node'); +$node->init(has_archiving => 1, allows_streaming => 1); +my $archive_dir = $node->archive_dir; +$node->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "archive_command = ''"); +$node->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "archive_library = 'basic_archive'"); +$node->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "basic_archive.archive_directory = '$archive_dir'"); +$node->start; + +# backup the node +my $backup = 'backup'; +$node->backup($backup); + +# generate some new WAL files +$node->safe_psql('postgres', "CREATE TABLE test (a INT);"); +$node->safe_psql('postgres', "SELECT pg_switch_wal();"); +$node->safe_psql('postgres', "INSERT INTO test VALUES (1);"); + +# shut down the node (this should archive all WAL files) +$node->stop; + +# restore from the backup +my $restore = PostgreSQL::Test::Cluster->new('restore'); +$restore->init_from_backup($node, $backup, has_restoring => 1, standby => 0); +$restore->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "restore_command = ''"); +$restore->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "restore_library = 'basic_archive'"); +$restore->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "basic_archive.archive_directory = '$archive_dir'"); +$restore->start; + +# ensure post-backup WAL was replayed +my $result = $restore->safe_psql("postgres", "SELECT count(*) FROM test;"); +is($result, "1", "check restore content"); + +done_testing(); diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml index ef02051f7f..023f2e047a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml @@ -1,34 +1,43 @@ <!-- doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml --> <chapter id="archive-modules"> - <title>Archive Modules</title> + <title>Archive and Recovery Modules</title> <indexterm zone="archive-modules"> - <primary>Archive Modules</primary> + <primary>Archive and Recovery Modules</primary> </indexterm> <para> PostgreSQL provides infrastructure to create custom modules for continuous - archiving (see <xref linkend="continuous-archiving"/>). While archiving via - a shell command (i.e., <xref linkend="guc-archive-command"/>) is much - simpler, a custom archive module will often be considerably more robust and - performant. + archiving and recovery (see <xref linkend="continuous-archiving"/>). While + a shell command (e.g., <xref linkend="guc-archive-command"/>, + <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/>) is much simpler, a custom module will + often be considerably more robust and performant. </para> <para> When a custom <xref linkend="guc-archive-library"/> is configured, PostgreSQL will submit completed WAL files to the module, and the server will avoid recycling or removing these WAL files until the module indicates that the files - were successfully archived. It is ultimately up to the module to decide what - to do with each WAL file, but many recommendations are listed at - <xref linkend="backup-archiving-wal"/>. + were successfully archived. When a custom + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/>, + <xref linkend="guc-archive-cleanup-library"/>, or + <xref linkend="guc-recovery-end-library"/> is configured, PostgreSQL will use + the module for the corresponding recovery action. It is ultimately up to the + module to decide how to accomplish each task, but some recommendations are + listed at <xref linkend="backup-archiving-wal"/> and + <xref linkend="backup-pitr-recovery"/>. </para> <para> - Archiving modules must at least consist of an initialization function (see - <xref linkend="archive-module-init"/>) and the required callbacks (see - <xref linkend="archive-module-callbacks"/>). However, archive modules are - also permitted to do much more (e.g., declare GUCs and register background - workers). + Archive and recovery modules must at least consist of an initialization + function (see <xref linkend="archive-module-init"/> and + <xref linkend="recovery-module-init"/>) and the required callbacks (see + <xref linkend="archive-module-callbacks"/> and + <xref linkend="recovery-module-callbacks"/>). However, archive and recovery + modules are also permitted to do much more (e.g., declare GUCs and register + background workers). A module may be used for any combination of the + configuration parameters mentioned in the preceding paragraph, or it can be + used for just one. </para> <para> @@ -37,7 +46,7 @@ </para> <sect1 id="archive-module-init"> - <title>Initialization Functions</title> + <title>Archive Module Initialization Functions</title> <indexterm zone="archive-module-init"> <primary>_PG_archive_module_init</primary> </indexterm> @@ -64,6 +73,12 @@ typedef void (*ArchiveModuleInit) (struct ArchiveModuleCallbacks *cb); Only the <function>archive_file_cb</function> callback is required. The others are optional. </para> + + <note> + <para> + <varname>archive_library</varname> is only loaded in the archiver process. + </para> + </note> </sect1> <sect1 id="archive-module-callbacks"> @@ -133,4 +148,135 @@ typedef void (*ArchiveShutdownCB) (void); </para> </sect2> </sect1> + + <sect1 id="recovery-module-init"> + <title>Recovery Module Initialization Functions</title> + <indexterm zone="recovery-module-init"> + <primary>_PG_recovery_module_init</primary> + </indexterm> + <para> + A recovery library is loaded by dynamically loading a shared library with the + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/>, + <xref linkend="guc-archive-cleanup-library"/>, or + <xref linkend="guc-recovery-end-library"/> as the library base name. The + normal library search path is used to locate the library. To provide the + required recovery module callbacks and to indicate that the library is + actually a recovery module, it needs to provide a function named + <function>_PG_recovery_module_init</function>. This function is passed a + struct that needs to be filled with the callback function pointers for + individual actions. + +<programlisting> +typedef struct RecoveryModuleCallbacks +{ + RecoveryRestoreCB restore_cb; + RecoveryArchiveCleanupCB archive_cleanup_cb; + RecoveryEndCB recovery_end_cb; +} RecoveryModuleCallbacks; +typedef void (*RecoveryModuleInit) (struct RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb); +</programlisting> + + If the recovery module is loaded via <varname>restore_library</varname>, the + <function>restore_cb</function> callback is required. If the recovery + module is loaded via <varname>archive_cleanup_library</varname>, the + <function>archive_cleanup_cb</function> callback is required. If the + recovery module is loaded via <varname>recovery_end_library</varname>, the + <function>recovery_end_library</function> callback is required. The same + recovery module may be used for more than one of the aforementioned + parameters if desired. Unused callback functions (e.g., if + <function>restore_cb</function> is defined but the library is only loaded + via <varname>recovery_end_library</varname>) are ignored. + </para> + + <note> + <para> + <varname>restore_library</varname> and + <varname>recovery_end_library</varname> are only loaded in the startup + process and in single-user mode, while + <varname>archive_cleanup_library</varname> is only loaded in the + checkpointer process. + </para> + </note> + + <note> + <para> + A recovery module's <function>_PG_recovery_module_init</function> might be + called multiple times in the same process. If a module uses this function + for anything beyond returning its callback functions, it must be able to cope + with multiple invocations. + </para> + </note> + </sect1> + + <sect1 id="recovery-module-callbacks"> + <title>Recovery Module Callbacks</title> + <para> + The recovery callbacks define the actual behavior of the module. The server + will call them as required to execute recovery actions. + </para> + + <sect2 id="recovery-module-restore"> + <title>Restore Callback</title> + <para> + The <function>restore_cb</function> callback is called to retrieve a single + archived segment of the WAL file series for archive recovery or streaming + replication. + +<programlisting> +typedef bool (*RecoveryRestoreCB) (const char *file, const char *path, const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +</programlisting> + + This callback must return <literal>true</literal> only if the file was + successfully retrieved. If the file is not available in the archives, the + callback must return <literal>false</literal>. + <replaceable>file</replaceable> will contain just the file name + of the WAL file to retrieve, while <replaceable>path</replaceable> contains + the destination's relative path (including the file name). + <replaceable>lastRestartPointFileName</replaceable> will contain the name + of the file containing the last valid restart point. That is the earliest + file that must be kept to allow a restore to be restartable, so this + information can be used to truncate the archive to just the minimum + required to support restarting from the current restore. + <replaceable>lastRestartPointFileName</replaceable> is typically only used + by warm-standby configurations (see <xref linkend="warm-standby"/>). Note + that if multiple standby servers are restoring from the same archive + directory, you will need to ensure that you do not delete WAL files until + they are no longer needed by any of the servers. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="recovery-module-archive-cleanup"> + <title>Archive Cleanup Callback</title> + <para> + The <function>archive_cleanup_cb</function> callback is called at every + restart point and is intended to provide a mechanism for cleaning up old + archived WAL files that are no longer needed by the standby server. + +<programlisting> +typedef void (*RecoveryArchiveCleanupCB) (const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +</programlisting> + + <replaceable>lastRestartPointFileName</replaceable> will contain the name + of the file containing the last valid restart point, like in + <link linkend="recovery-module-restore"><function>restore_cb</function></link>. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="recovery-module-end"> + <title>Recovery End Callback</title> + <para> + The <function>recovery_end_cb</function> callback is called once at the end + of recovery and is intended to provide a mechanism for cleanup following + replication or recovery. + +<programlisting> +typedef void (*RecoveryEndCB) (const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +</programlisting> + + <replaceable>lastRestartPointFileName</replaceable> will contain the name + of the file containing the last valid restart point, like in + <link linkend="recovery-module-restore"><function>restore_cb</function></link>. + </para> + </sect2> + </sect1> </chapter> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml index 8bab521718..8cf3f35649 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml @@ -1181,9 +1181,26 @@ SELECT * FROM pg_backup_stop(wait_for_archive => true); <para> The key part of all this is to set up a recovery configuration that describes how you want to recover and how far the recovery should - run. The one thing that you absolutely must specify is the <varname>restore_command</varname>, + run. The one thing that you absolutely must specify is either + <varname>restore_command</varname> or <varname>restore_library</varname>, which tells <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> how to retrieve archived - WAL file segments. Like the <varname>archive_command</varname>, this is + WAL file segments. + </para> + + <para> + Like the <varname>archive_library</varname> parameter, + <varname>restore_library</varname> is a shared library. Since such + libraries are written in <literal>C</literal>, creating your own may + require considerably more effort than writing a shell command. However, + recovery modules can be more performant than restoring via shell, and they + will have access to many useful server resources. For more information + about creating a <varname>restore_library</varname>, see + <xref linkend="archive-modules"/>. + </para> + + <para> + Like the <varname>archive_command</varname>, + <varname>restore_command</varname> is a shell command string. It can contain <literal>%f</literal>, which is replaced by the name of the desired WAL file, and <literal>%p</literal>, which is replaced by the path name to copy the WAL file to. @@ -1202,14 +1219,20 @@ restore_command = 'cp /mnt/server/archivedir/%f %p' </para> <para> - It is important that the command return nonzero exit status on failure. - The command <emphasis>will</emphasis> be called requesting files that are not - present in the archive; it must return nonzero when so asked. This is not - an error condition. An exception is that if the command was terminated by + It is important that the <varname>restore_command</varname> return nonzero + exit status on failure, or, if you are using a + <varname>restore_library</varname>, that the restore function returns + <literal>false</literal> on failure. The command or library + <emphasis>will</emphasis> be called requesting files that are not + present in the archive; it must fail when so asked. This is not + an error condition. An exception is that if the + <varname>restore_command</varname> was terminated by a signal (other than <systemitem>SIGTERM</systemitem>, which is used as part of a database server shutdown) or an error by the shell (such as command not found), then recovery will abort and the server will not start - up. + up. Likewise, if the restore function provided by the + <varname>restore_library</varname> emits an <literal>ERROR</literal> or + <literal>FATAL</literal>, recovery will abort and the server won't start. </para> <para> @@ -1233,7 +1256,8 @@ restore_command = 'cp /mnt/server/archivedir/%f %p' close as possible given the available WAL segments). Therefore, a normal recovery will end with a <quote>file not found</quote> message, the exact text of the error message depending upon your choice of - <varname>restore_command</varname>. You may also see an error message + <varname>restore_command</varname> or <varname>restore_library</varname>. + You may also see an error message at the start of recovery for a file named something like <filename>00000001.history</filename>. This is also normal and does not indicate a problem in simple recovery situations; see diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml index 0b650f17a8..ac7cd9b967 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml @@ -8,17 +8,20 @@ </indexterm> <para> - <filename>basic_archive</filename> is an example of an archive module. This - module copies completed WAL segment files to the specified directory. This - may not be especially useful, but it can serve as a starting point for - developing your own archive module. For more information about archive - modules, see <xref linkend="archive-modules"/>. + <filename>basic_archive</filename> is an example of an archive and recovery + module. This module copies completed WAL segment files to or from the + specified directory. This may not be especially useful, but it can serve as + a starting point for developing your own archive and recovery modules. For + more information about archive and recovery modules, see + see <xref linkend="archive-modules"/>. </para> <para> - In order to function, this module must be loaded via + For use as an archive module, this module must be loaded via <xref linkend="guc-archive-library"/>, and <xref linkend="guc-archive-mode"/> - must be enabled. + must be enabled. For use as a recovery module, this module must be loaded + via <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/>, and recovery must be enabled (see + <xref linkend="runtime-config-wal-archive-recovery"/>). </para> <sect2> @@ -34,11 +37,12 @@ </term> <listitem> <para> - The directory where the server should copy WAL segment files. This - directory must already exist. The default is an empty string, which - effectively halts WAL archiving, but if <xref linkend="guc-archive-mode"/> - is enabled, the server will accumulate WAL segment files in the - expectation that a value will soon be provided. + The directory where the server should copy WAL segment files to or from. + This directory must already exist. The default is an empty string, + which, when used for archiving, effectively halts WAL archival, but if + <xref linkend="guc-archive-mode"/> is enabled, the server will accumulate + WAL segment files in the expectation that a value will soon be provided. + When an empty string is used for recovery, restore will fail. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -46,7 +50,7 @@ <para> These parameters must be set in <filename>postgresql.conf</filename>. - Typical usage might be: + Typical usage as an archive module might be: </para> <programlisting> @@ -61,7 +65,8 @@ basic_archive.archive_directory = '/path/to/archive/directory' <title>Notes</title> <para> - Server crashes may leave temporary files with the prefix + When <filename>basic_archive</filename> is used as an archive module, server + crashes may leave temporary files with the prefix <filename>archtemp</filename> in the archive directory. It is recommended to delete such files before restarting the server after a crash. It is safe to remove such files while the server is running as long as they are unrelated diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml index 3071c8eace..5cf9d0a42a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml @@ -3773,7 +3773,8 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' recovery when the end of archived WAL is reached, but will keep trying to continue recovery by connecting to the sending server as specified by the <varname>primary_conninfo</varname> setting and/or by fetching new WAL - segments using <varname>restore_command</varname>. For this mode, the + segments using <varname>restore_command</varname> or + <varname>restore_library</varname>. For this mode, the parameters from this section and <xref linkend="runtime-config-replication-standby"/> are of interest. Parameters from <xref linkend="runtime-config-wal-recovery-target"/> will @@ -3801,7 +3802,8 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' <listitem> <para> The local shell command to execute to retrieve an archived segment of - the WAL file series. This parameter is required for archive recovery, + the WAL file series. Either <varname>restore_command</varname> or + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> is required for archive recovery, but optional for streaming replication. Any <literal>%f</literal> in the string is replaced by the name of the file to retrieve from the archive, @@ -3836,7 +3838,36 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows <para> This parameter can only be set in the <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> - file or on the server command line. + file or on the server command line. It is only used if + <varname>restore_library</varname> is set to an empty string. If both + <varname>restore_command</varname> and + <varname>restore_library</varname> are set, an error will be raised. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry id="guc-restore-library" xreflabel="restore_library"> + <term><varname>restore_library</varname> (<type>string</type>) + <indexterm> + <primary><varname>restore_library</varname> configuration parameter</primary> + </indexterm> + </term> + <listitem> + <para> + The library to use for retrieving an archived segment of the WAL file + series. Either <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> or + <varname>restore_library</varname> is required for archive recovery, + but optional for streaming replication. If this parameter is set to an + empty string (the default), restoring via shell is enabled, and + <varname>restore_command</varname> is used. If both + <varname>restore_command</varname> and + <varname>restore_library</varname> are set, an error will be raised. + Otherwise, the specified shared library is used for restoring. For + more information, see <xref linkend="archive-modules"/>. + </para> + + <para> + This parameter can only be set at server start. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -3881,7 +3912,37 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows </para> <para> This parameter can only be set in the <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> - file or on the server command line. + file or on the server command line. It is only used if + <varname>archive_cleanup_library</varname> is set to an empty string. + If both <varname>archive_cleanup_command</varname> and + <varname>archive_cleanup_library</varname> are set, an error will be + raised. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry id="guc-archive-cleanup-library" xreflabel="archive_cleanup_library"> + <term><varname>archive_cleanup_library</varname> (<type>string</type>) + <indexterm> + <primary><varname>archive_cleanup_library</varname> configuration parameter</primary> + </indexterm> + </term> + <listitem> + <para> + This optional parameter specifies a library that will be executed at + every restartpoint. The purpose of this parameter is to provide a + mechanism for cleaning up old archived WAL files that are no longer + needed by the standby server. If this parameter is set to an empty + string (the default), the shell command specified in + <xref linkend="guc-archive-cleanup-command"/> is used. If both + <varname>archive_cleanup_command</varname> and + <varname>archive_cleanup_library</varname> are set, an error will be + raised. Otherwise, the specified shared library is used for cleanup. + For more information, see <xref linkend="archive-modules"/>. + </para> + + <para> + This parameter can only be set at server start. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -3910,11 +3971,39 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows </para> <para> This parameter can only be set in the <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> - file or on the server command line. + file or on the server command line. It is only used if + <varname>recovery_end_library</varname> is set to an empty string. If + both <varname>recovery_end_command</varname> and + <varname>recovery_end_library</varname> are set, an error will be + raised. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> + <varlistentry id="guc-recovery-end-library" xreflabel="recovery_end_library"> + <term><varname>recovery_end_library</varname> (<type>string</type>) + <indexterm> + <primary><varname>recovery_end_library</varname> configuration parameter</primary> + </indexterm> + </term> + <listitem> + <para> + This optional parameter specifies a library that will be executed once + only at the end of recovery. The purpose of this parameter is to + provide a mechanism for cleanup following replication or recovery. If + this parameter is set to an empty string (the default), the shell + command specified in <xref linkend="guc-recovery-end-command"/> is + used. If both <varname>recovery_end_command</varname> and + <varname>recovery_end_library</varname> are set, an error will be + raised. Otherwise, the specified shared library is used for cleanup. + For more information, see <xref linkend="archive-modules"/>. + </para> + + <para> + This parameter can only be set at server start. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> </variablelist> </sect2> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml index f180607528..963d12e02a 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml @@ -627,7 +627,8 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <para> In standby mode, the server continuously applies WAL received from the primary server. The standby server can read WAL from a WAL archive - (see <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/>) or directly from the primary + (see <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> and + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/>) or directly from the primary over a TCP connection (streaming replication). The standby server will also attempt to restore any WAL found in the standby cluster's <filename>pg_wal</filename> directory. That typically happens after a server @@ -638,8 +639,10 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <para> At startup, the standby begins by restoring all WAL available in the - archive location, calling <varname>restore_command</varname>. Once it + archive location, either by calling <varname>restore_command</varname> or + by executing the <varname>restore_library</varname>. Once it reaches the end of WAL available there and <varname>restore_command</varname> + or <varname>restore_library</varname> fails, it tries to restore any WAL available in the <filename>pg_wal</filename> directory. If that fails, and streaming replication has been configured, the standby tries to connect to the primary server and start streaming WAL @@ -698,7 +701,8 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. server (see <xref linkend="backup-pitr-recovery"/>). Create a file <link linkend="file-standby-signal"><filename>standby.signal</filename></link><indexterm><primary>standby.signal</primary></indexterm> in the standby's cluster data - directory. Set <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> to a simple command to copy files from + directory. Set <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> or + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> to copy files from the WAL archive. If you plan to have multiple standby servers for high availability purposes, make sure that <varname>recovery_target_timeline</varname> is set to <literal>latest</literal> (the default), to make the standby server follow the timeline change @@ -707,7 +711,8 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <note> <para> - <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> should return immediately + <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> and + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> should return immediately if the file does not exist; the server will retry the command again if necessary. </para> @@ -731,8 +736,9 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <para> If you're using a WAL archive, its size can be minimized using the <xref - linkend="guc-archive-cleanup-command"/> parameter to remove files that are no - longer required by the standby server. + linkend="guc-archive-cleanup-command"/> or + <xref linkend="guc-archive-cleanup-library"/> parameter to remove files + that are no longer required by the standby server. The <application>pg_archivecleanup</application> utility is designed specifically to be used with <varname>archive_cleanup_command</varname> in typical single-standby configurations, see <xref linkend="pgarchivecleanup"/>. diff --git a/src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c b/src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c index 073e709e06..124a0bbdb6 100644 --- a/src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c +++ b/src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c @@ -3,7 +3,8 @@ * shell_restore.c * * These recovery functions use a user-specified shell command (e.g., the - * restore_command GUC). + * restore_command GUC). It is used as the default, but other modules may + * define their own recovery logic. * * Copyright (c) 2022, PostgreSQL Global Development Group * @@ -22,6 +23,10 @@ #include "storage/ipc.h" #include "utils/wait_event.h" +static bool shell_restore(const char *file, const char *path, + const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +static void shell_archive_cleanup(const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +static void shell_recovery_end(const char *lastRestartPointFileName); static char *BuildCleanupCommand(const char *command, const char *lastRestartPointFileName); static bool ExecuteRecoveryCommand(const char *command, @@ -29,6 +34,16 @@ static bool ExecuteRecoveryCommand(const char *command, bool exitOnSigterm, uint32 wait_event_info, int fail_elevel); +void +shell_restore_init(RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb) +{ + AssertVariableIsOfType(&shell_restore_init, RecoveryModuleInit); + + cb->restore_cb = shell_restore; + cb->archive_cleanup_cb = shell_archive_cleanup; + cb->recovery_end_cb = shell_recovery_end; +} + bool shell_restore(const char *file, const char *path, const char *lastRestartPointFileName) @@ -73,7 +88,7 @@ shell_restore(const char *file, const char *path, return ret; } -void +static void shell_archive_cleanup(const char *lastRestartPointFileName) { char *cmd = BuildCleanupCommand(archiveCleanupCommand, @@ -84,7 +99,7 @@ shell_archive_cleanup(const char *lastRestartPointFileName) pfree(cmd); } -void +static void shell_recovery_end(const char *lastRestartPointFileName) { char *cmd = BuildCleanupCommand(recoveryEndCommand, diff --git a/src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c b/src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c index 32225be4a5..6365635180 100644 --- a/src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c +++ b/src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c @@ -4883,10 +4883,11 @@ static void CleanupAfterArchiveRecovery(TimeLineID EndOfLogTLI, XLogRecPtr EndOfLog, TimeLineID newTLI) { + /* - * Execute the recovery_end_command, if any. + * Execute the recovery-end library, if any. */ - if (recoveryEndCommand && strcmp(recoveryEndCommand, "") != 0) + if (recoveryEndCommand[0] != '\0' || recoveryEndLibrary[0] != '\0') { char lastRestartPointFname[MAXPGPATH]; XLogSegNo restartSegNo; @@ -4903,7 +4904,7 @@ CleanupAfterArchiveRecovery(TimeLineID EndOfLogTLI, XLogRecPtr EndOfLog, XLogFileName(lastRestartPointFname, restartTli, restartSegNo, wal_segment_size); - shell_recovery_end(lastRestartPointFname); + RecoveryContext.recovery_end_cb(lastRestartPointFname); } /* @@ -7318,9 +7319,9 @@ CreateRestartPoint(int flags) timestamptz_to_str(xtime)) : 0)); /* - * Finally, execute archive_cleanup_command, if any. + * Execute the archive-cleanup library, if any. */ - if (archiveCleanupCommand && strcmp(archiveCleanupCommand, "") != 0) + if (archiveCleanupCommand[0] != '\0' || archiveCleanupLibrary[0] != '\0') { char lastRestartPointFname[MAXPGPATH]; XLogSegNo restartSegNo; @@ -7337,7 +7338,7 @@ CreateRestartPoint(int flags) XLogFileName(lastRestartPointFname, restartTli, restartSegNo, wal_segment_size); - shell_archive_cleanup(lastRestartPointFname); + RecoveryContext.archive_cleanup_cb(lastRestartPointFname); } return true; diff --git a/src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c b/src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c index 50b0d1105d..574af1494e 100644 --- a/src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c +++ b/src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c @@ -22,7 +22,9 @@ #include "access/xlog.h" #include "access/xlog_internal.h" #include "access/xlogarchive.h" +#include "access/xlogrecovery.h" #include "common/archive.h" +#include "fmgr.h" #include "miscadmin.h" #include "pgstat.h" #include "postmaster/startup.h" @@ -32,6 +34,15 @@ #include "storage/ipc.h" #include "storage/lwlock.h" +/* + * Global context for recovery-related callbacks. + */ +RecoveryModuleCallbacks RecoveryContext; + +static void LoadRecoveryCallbacks(const char *cmd, const char *cmd_name, + const char *lib, const char *lib_name, + RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb); + /* * Attempt to retrieve the specified file from off-line archival storage. * If successful, fill "path" with its complete path (note that this will be @@ -71,7 +82,7 @@ RestoreArchivedFile(char *path, const char *xlogfname, goto not_available; /* In standby mode, restore_command might not be supplied */ - if (recoveryRestoreCommand == NULL || strcmp(recoveryRestoreCommand, "") == 0) + if (recoveryRestoreCommand[0] == '\0' && recoveryRestoreLibrary[0] == '\0') goto not_available; /* @@ -149,14 +160,15 @@ RestoreArchivedFile(char *path, const char *xlogfname, XLogFileName(lastRestartPointFname, 0, 0L, wal_segment_size); /* - * Check signals before restore command and reset afterwards. + * Check signals before restore command/library and reset afterwards. */ PreRestoreCommand(); /* * Copy xlog from archival storage to XLOGDIR */ - ret = shell_restore(xlogfname, xlogpath, lastRestartPointFname); + ret = RecoveryContext.restore_cb(xlogfname, xlogpath, + lastRestartPointFname); PostRestoreCommand(); @@ -603,3 +615,116 @@ XLogArchiveCleanup(const char *xlog) unlink(archiveStatusPath); /* should we complain about failure? */ } + +/* + * Functions for loading recovery callbacks into the global RecoveryContext. + * + * To ensure that we only copy the necessary callbacks into the global context, + * we first copy them into a local context before copying the relevant one. + * This means that a recovery module's initialization function might be called + * multiple times in the same process. If a module uses this function for + * anything beyond returning its callback functions, it must be able to cope + * with multiple invocations. + */ + +/* + * Loads all the recovery callbacks for the command/library into cb. This is + * intended for use by the functions below to load individual callbacks into + * the global RecoveryContext. + * + * If both the command and library are nonempty, an ERROR will be raised. + * cmd_name and lib_name are the GUC names to be used for the corresponding + * ERROR message. + */ +static void +LoadRecoveryCallbacks(const char *cmd, const char *cmd_name, const char *lib, + const char *lib_name, RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb) +{ + RecoveryModuleInit init; + + if (cmd[0] != '\0' && lib[0] != '\0') + ereport(ERROR, + (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), + errmsg("both %s and %s set", cmd_name, lib_name), + errdetail("Only one of %s, %s may be set.", + cmd_name, lib_name))); + + /* + * If the shell command is enabled, use our special initialization + * function. Otherwise, load the library and call its + * _PG_recovery_module_init(). + */ + if (lib[0] == '\0') + init = shell_restore_init; + else + init = (RecoveryModuleInit) + load_external_function(lib, "_PG_recovery_module_init", + false, NULL); + + if (init == NULL) + ereport(ERROR, + (errmsg("recovery modules have to define the symbol " + "_PG_recovery_module_init"))); + + (*init) (cb); +} + +/* + * Loads only the restore callback into the global RecoveryContext. + */ +void +LoadRestoreLibrary(void) +{ + RecoveryModuleCallbacks tmp = {0}; + + LoadRecoveryCallbacks(recoveryRestoreCommand, "restore_command", + recoveryRestoreLibrary, "restore_library", + &tmp); + + if (tmp.restore_cb == NULL) + ereport(ERROR, + (errmsg("recovery modules used for \"restore_library\" must " + "register a restore callback"))); + else + RecoveryContext.restore_cb = tmp.restore_cb; +} + +/* + * Loads only the archive-cleanup callback into the global RecoveryContext. + */ +void +LoadArchiveCleanupLibrary(void) +{ + RecoveryModuleCallbacks tmp = {0}; + + LoadRecoveryCallbacks(archiveCleanupCommand, "archive_cleanup_command", + archiveCleanupLibrary, "archive_cleanup_library", + &tmp); + + if (tmp.archive_cleanup_cb == NULL) + ereport(ERROR, + (errmsg("recovery modules used for \"archive_cleanup_library\" " + "must register an archive cleanup callback"))); + else + RecoveryContext.archive_cleanup_cb = tmp.archive_cleanup_cb; +} + +/* + * Loads only the recovery-end callback into the global RecoveryContext. + */ +void +LoadRecoveryEndLibrary(void) +{ + RecoveryModuleCallbacks tmp = {0}; + + LoadRecoveryCallbacks(recoveryEndCommand, "recovery_end_command", + recoveryEndLibrary, "recovery_end_library", + &tmp); + + if (tmp.recovery_end_cb == NULL) + ereport(ERROR, + (errmsg("recovery modules used for \"recovery_end_library\" " + "must register a recovery end callback"))); + else + RecoveryContext.recovery_end_cb = tmp.recovery_end_cb; +} diff --git a/src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c b/src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c index d5a81f9d83..d140054627 100644 --- a/src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c +++ b/src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c @@ -80,8 +80,11 @@ const struct config_enum_entry recovery_target_action_options[] = { /* options formerly taken from recovery.conf for archive recovery */ char *recoveryRestoreCommand = NULL; +char *recoveryRestoreLibrary = NULL; char *recoveryEndCommand = NULL; +char *recoveryEndLibrary = NULL; char *archiveCleanupCommand = NULL; +char *archiveCleanupLibrary = NULL; RecoveryTargetType recoveryTarget = RECOVERY_TARGET_UNSET; bool recoveryTargetInclusive = true; int recoveryTargetAction = RECOVERY_TARGET_ACTION_PAUSE; @@ -1059,20 +1062,27 @@ validateRecoveryParameters(void) if (StandbyModeRequested) { if ((PrimaryConnInfo == NULL || strcmp(PrimaryConnInfo, "") == 0) && - (recoveryRestoreCommand == NULL || strcmp(recoveryRestoreCommand, "") == 0)) + recoveryRestoreCommand[0] == '\0' && recoveryRestoreLibrary[0] == '\0') ereport(WARNING, - (errmsg("specified neither primary_conninfo nor restore_command"), + (errmsg("specified neither primary_conninfo nor restore_command nor restore_library"), errhint("The database server will regularly poll the pg_wal subdirectory to check for files placed there."))); } else { - if (recoveryRestoreCommand == NULL || - strcmp(recoveryRestoreCommand, "") == 0) + if (recoveryRestoreCommand[0] == '\0' && recoveryRestoreLibrary[0] == '\0') ereport(FATAL, (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), - errmsg("must specify restore_command when standby mode is not enabled"))); + errmsg("must specify restore_command or restore_library when standby mode is not enabled"))); } + /* + * Load the restore and recovery end libraries. This also checks for + * invalid combinations of the command/library parameters. + */ + memset(&RecoveryContext, 0, sizeof(RecoveryModuleCallbacks)); + LoadRestoreLibrary(); + LoadRecoveryEndLibrary(); + /* * Override any inconsistent requests. Note that this is a change of * behaviour in 9.5; prior to this we simply ignored a request to pause if diff --git a/src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c b/src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c index 5fc076fc14..9b479b41b4 100644 --- a/src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c +++ b/src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c @@ -38,6 +38,7 @@ #include "access/xlog.h" #include "access/xlog_internal.h" +#include "access/xlogarchive.h" #include "access/xlogrecovery.h" #include "libpq/pqsignal.h" #include "miscadmin.h" @@ -222,6 +223,15 @@ CheckpointerMain(void) */ before_shmem_exit(pgstat_before_server_shutdown, 0); + /* + * Load the archive cleanup library. This also checks that at most one of + * archive_cleanup_command, archive_cleanup_library is set. We do this + * before setting up the exception handler so that any problems result in a + * server crash shortly after startup. + */ + memset(&RecoveryContext, 0, sizeof(RecoveryModuleCallbacks)); + LoadArchiveCleanupLibrary(); + /* * Create a memory context that we will do all our work in. We do this so * that we can reset the context during error recovery and thereby avoid @@ -563,6 +573,19 @@ HandleCheckpointerInterrupts(void) * because of SIGHUP. */ UpdateSharedMemoryConfig(); + + /* + * Since archive_cleanup_command can be changed at runtime, we have to + * validate that only one of the library/command is set after every + * SIGHUP. Failing recovery seems harsh, so we just warn that the + * shell command will be ignored. + */ + if (archiveCleanupCommand[0] != '\0' && archiveCleanupLibrary[0] != '\0') + ereport(WARNING, + (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), + errmsg("both archive_cleanup_command and archive_cleanup_library set"), + errdetail("The value of archive_cleanup_command will be ignored."), + errhint("Only one of archive_cleanup_command, archive_cleanup_library may be set."))); } if (ShutdownRequestPending) { diff --git a/src/backend/postmaster/startup.c b/src/backend/postmaster/startup.c index f99186eab7..5dc830e6c0 100644 --- a/src/backend/postmaster/startup.c +++ b/src/backend/postmaster/startup.c @@ -133,7 +133,8 @@ StartupProcShutdownHandler(SIGNAL_ARGS) * Re-read the config file. * * If one of the critical walreceiver options has changed, flag xlog.c - * to restart it. + * to restart it. Also, check restore_command/library and + * recovery_end_command/library. */ static void StartupRereadConfig(void) @@ -161,6 +162,25 @@ StartupRereadConfig(void) if (conninfoChanged || slotnameChanged || tempSlotChanged) StartupRequestWalReceiverRestart(); + + /* + * Since restore_command and recovery_end_command can be changed at runtime, + * we have to validate that only one of the library/command is set after + * every SIGHUP. Failing recovery seems harsh, so we just warn that the + * shell command will be ignored. + */ + if (recoveryRestoreCommand[0] != '\0' && recoveryRestoreLibrary[0] != '\0') + ereport(WARNING, + (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), + errmsg("both restore_command and restore_library set"), + errdetail("The value of restore_command will be ignored."), + errhint("Only one of restore_command, restore_library may be set."))); + if (recoveryEndCommand[0] != '\0' && recoveryEndLibrary[0] != '\0') + ereport(WARNING, + (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), + errmsg("both recovery_end_command and recovery_end_library set"), + errdetail("The value of recovery_end_command will be ignored."), + errhint("Only one of recovery_end_command, recovery_end_library may be set."))); } /* Handle various signals that might be sent to the startup process */ diff --git a/src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c b/src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c index a37c9f9844..9aacb584f9 100644 --- a/src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c +++ b/src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c @@ -3764,6 +3764,16 @@ struct config_string ConfigureNamesString[] = NULL, NULL, NULL }, + { + {"restore_library", PGC_POSTMASTER, WAL_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY, + gettext_noop("Sets the library that will be called to retrieve an archived WAL file."), + gettext_noop("An empty string indicates that \"restore_command\" should be used.") + }, + &recoveryRestoreLibrary, + "", + NULL, NULL, NULL + }, + { {"archive_cleanup_command", PGC_SIGHUP, WAL_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY, gettext_noop("Sets the shell command that will be executed at every restart point."), @@ -3774,6 +3784,16 @@ struct config_string ConfigureNamesString[] = NULL, NULL, NULL }, + { + {"archive_cleanup_library", PGC_POSTMASTER, WAL_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY, + gettext_noop("Sets the library that will be executed at every restart point."), + gettext_noop("An empty string indicates that \"archive_cleanup_command\" should be used.") + }, + &archiveCleanupLibrary, + "", + NULL, NULL, NULL + }, + { {"recovery_end_command", PGC_SIGHUP, WAL_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY, gettext_noop("Sets the shell command that will be executed once at the end of recovery."), @@ -3784,6 +3804,16 @@ struct config_string ConfigureNamesString[] = NULL, NULL, NULL }, + { + {"recovery_end_library", PGC_POSTMASTER, WAL_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY, + gettext_noop("Sets the library that will be executed once at the end of recovery."), + gettext_noop("An empty string indicates that \"recovery_end_command\" should be used.") + }, + &recoveryEndLibrary, + "", + NULL, NULL, NULL + }, + { {"recovery_target_timeline", PGC_POSTMASTER, WAL_RECOVERY_TARGET, gettext_noop("Specifies the timeline to recover into."), diff --git a/src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample b/src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample index 5afdeb04de..13aa10b87e 100644 --- a/src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample +++ b/src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample @@ -269,8 +269,11 @@ # placeholders: %p = path of file to restore # %f = file name only # e.g. 'cp /mnt/server/archivedir/%f %p' +#restore_library = '' # library to use to restore an archived WAL file #archive_cleanup_command = '' # command to execute at every restartpoint +#archive_cleanup_library = '' # library to execute at every restartpoint #recovery_end_command = '' # command to execute at completion of recovery +#recovery_end_library = '' # library to execute at completion of recovery # - Recovery Target - diff --git a/src/include/access/xlog_internal.h b/src/include/access/xlog_internal.h index e5fc66966b..467f95962b 100644 --- a/src/include/access/xlog_internal.h +++ b/src/include/access/xlog_internal.h @@ -400,5 +400,6 @@ extern PGDLLIMPORT bool ArchiveRecoveryRequested; extern PGDLLIMPORT bool InArchiveRecovery; extern PGDLLIMPORT bool StandbyMode; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *recoveryRestoreCommand; +extern PGDLLIMPORT char *recoveryRestoreLibrary; #endif /* XLOG_INTERNAL_H */ diff --git a/src/include/access/xlogarchive.h b/src/include/access/xlogarchive.h index 69d002cdeb..c693d200c1 100644 --- a/src/include/access/xlogarchive.h +++ b/src/include/access/xlogarchive.h @@ -30,9 +30,44 @@ extern bool XLogArchiveIsReady(const char *xlog); extern bool XLogArchiveIsReadyOrDone(const char *xlog); extern void XLogArchiveCleanup(const char *xlog); -extern bool shell_restore(const char *file, const char *path, - const char *lastRestartPointFileName); -extern void shell_archive_cleanup(const char *lastRestartPointFileName); -extern void shell_recovery_end(const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +/* + * Recovery module callbacks + * + * These callback functions should be defined by recovery libraries and + * returned via _PG_recovery_module_init(). For more information about the + * purpose of each callback, refer to the recovery modules documentation. + */ +typedef bool (*RecoveryRestoreCB) (const char *file, const char *path, + const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +typedef void (*RecoveryArchiveCleanupCB) (const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +typedef void (*RecoveryEndCB) (const char *lastRestartPointFileName); + +typedef struct RecoveryModuleCallbacks +{ + RecoveryRestoreCB restore_cb; + RecoveryArchiveCleanupCB archive_cleanup_cb; + RecoveryEndCB recovery_end_cb; +} RecoveryModuleCallbacks; + +extern RecoveryModuleCallbacks RecoveryContext; + +/* + * Type of the shared library symbol _PG_recovery_module_init that is looked up + * when loading a recovery library. + */ +typedef void (*RecoveryModuleInit) (RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb); + +extern PGDLLEXPORT void _PG_recovery_module_init(RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb); + +extern void LoadRestoreLibrary(void); +extern void LoadArchiveCleanupLibrary(void); +extern void LoadRecoveryEndLibrary(void); + +/* + * Since the logic for recovery via a shell command is in the core server and + * does not need to be loaded via a shared library, it has a special + * initialization function. + */ +extern void shell_restore_init(RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb); #endif /* XLOG_ARCHIVE_H */ diff --git a/src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h b/src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h index f3398425d8..f73fb12605 100644 --- a/src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h +++ b/src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h @@ -55,8 +55,11 @@ extern PGDLLIMPORT int recovery_min_apply_delay; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *PrimaryConnInfo; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *PrimarySlotName; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *recoveryRestoreCommand; +extern PGDLLIMPORT char *recoveryRestoreLibrary; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *recoveryEndCommand; +extern PGDLLIMPORT char *recoveryEndLibrary; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *archiveCleanupCommand; +extern PGDLLIMPORT char *archiveCleanupLibrary; /* indirectly set via GUC system */ extern PGDLLIMPORT TransactionId recoveryTargetXid; -- 2.25.1 --Qxx1br4bt0+wmkIi-- ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 17+ messages in thread
* [PATCH v2 3/3] Allow recovery via loadable modules. @ 2022-12-10 03:40 Nathan Bossart <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 17+ messages in thread From: Nathan Bossart @ 2022-12-10 03:40 UTC (permalink / raw) This adds the restore_library parameter to allow archive recovery via a loadable module, rather than running shell commands. --- contrib/basic_archive/Makefile | 4 +- contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c | 67 ++++++- contrib/basic_archive/meson.build | 7 +- contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl | 42 +++++ doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml | 168 ++++++++++++++++-- doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml | 43 ++++- doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml | 33 ++-- doc/src/sgml/config.sgml | 54 +++++- doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml | 23 ++- src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c | 21 ++- src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c | 13 +- src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c | 70 +++++++- src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c | 26 ++- src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c | 26 +++ src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c | 7 +- src/backend/postmaster/startup.c | 23 ++- src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c | 14 ++ src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c | 10 ++ src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample | 1 + src/include/access/xlog_internal.h | 1 + src/include/access/xlogarchive.h | 44 ++++- src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h | 1 + src/include/utils/guc.h | 2 + 23 files changed, 616 insertions(+), 84 deletions(-) create mode 100644 contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl diff --git a/contrib/basic_archive/Makefile b/contrib/basic_archive/Makefile index 55d299d650..487dc563f3 100644 --- a/contrib/basic_archive/Makefile +++ b/contrib/basic_archive/Makefile @@ -1,7 +1,7 @@ # contrib/basic_archive/Makefile MODULES = basic_archive -PGFILEDESC = "basic_archive - basic archive module" +PGFILEDESC = "basic_archive - basic archive and recovery module" REGRESS = basic_archive REGRESS_OPTS = --temp-config $(top_srcdir)/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.conf @@ -9,6 +9,8 @@ REGRESS_OPTS = --temp-config $(top_srcdir)/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c # which typical installcheck users do not have (e.g. buildfarm clients). NO_INSTALLCHECK = 1 +TAP_TESTS = 1 + ifdef USE_PGXS PG_CONFIG = pg_config PGXS := $(shell $(PG_CONFIG) --pgxs) diff --git a/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c b/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c index 9f221816bb..d6ed996f6c 100644 --- a/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c +++ b/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c @@ -17,6 +17,11 @@ * a file is successfully archived and then the system crashes before * a durable record of the success has been made. * + * This file also demonstrates a basic restore library implementation that + * is roughly equivalent to the following shell command: + * + * cp /path/to/archivedir/%f %p + * * Copyright (c) 2022, PostgreSQL Global Development Group * * IDENTIFICATION @@ -30,6 +35,7 @@ #include <sys/time.h> #include <unistd.h> +#include "access/xlogarchive.h" #include "common/int.h" #include "miscadmin.h" #include "postmaster/pgarch.h" @@ -48,6 +54,8 @@ static bool basic_archive_file(const char *file, const char *path); static void basic_archive_file_internal(const char *file, const char *path); static bool check_archive_directory(char **newval, void **extra, GucSource source); static bool compare_files(const char *file1, const char *file2); +static bool basic_restore_file(const char *file, const char *path, + const char *lastRestartPointFileName); /* * _PG_init @@ -87,6 +95,19 @@ _PG_archive_module_init(ArchiveModuleCallbacks *cb) cb->archive_file_cb = basic_archive_file; } +/* + * _PG_recovery_module_init + * + * Returns the module's restore callback. + */ +void +_PG_recovery_module_init(RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb) +{ + AssertVariableIsOfType(&_PG_recovery_module_init, RecoveryModuleInit); + + cb->restore_cb = basic_restore_file; +} + /* * check_archive_directory * @@ -99,8 +120,8 @@ check_archive_directory(char **newval, void **extra, GucSource source) /* * The default value is an empty string, so we have to accept that value. - * Our check_configured callback also checks for this and prevents - * archiving from proceeding if it is still empty. + * Our check_configured and restore callbacks also check for this and + * prevent archiving or recovery from proceeding if it is still empty. */ if (*newval == NULL || *newval[0] == '\0') return true; @@ -368,3 +389,45 @@ compare_files(const char *file1, const char *file2) return ret; } + +/* + * basic_restore_file + * + * Retrieves one file from the WAL archives. + */ +static bool +basic_restore_file(const char *file, const char *path, + const char *lastRestartPointFileName) +{ + char source[MAXPGPATH]; + struct stat st; + + ereport(DEBUG1, + (errmsg("restoring \"%s\" via basic_archive", file))); + + if (archive_directory == NULL || archive_directory[0] == '\0') + ereport(ERROR, + (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), + errmsg("\"basic_archive.archive_directory\" is not set"))); + + /* + * Check whether the file exists. If not, we return false to indicate that + * there are no more files to restore. + */ + snprintf(source, MAXPGPATH, "%s/%s", archive_directory, file); + if (stat(source, &st) != 0) + { + int elevel = (errno == ENOENT) ? DEBUG1 : ERROR; + + ereport(elevel, + (errcode_for_file_access(), + errmsg("could not stat file \"%s\": %m", source))); + return false; + } + + copy_file(source, unconstify(char *, path)); + + ereport(DEBUG1, + (errmsg("restored \"%s\" via basic_archive", file))); + return true; +} diff --git a/contrib/basic_archive/meson.build b/contrib/basic_archive/meson.build index b25dce99a3..5b5a6d79e7 100644 --- a/contrib/basic_archive/meson.build +++ b/contrib/basic_archive/meson.build @@ -7,7 +7,7 @@ basic_archive_sources = files( if host_system == 'windows' basic_archive_sources += rc_lib_gen.process(win32ver_rc, extra_args: [ '--NAME', 'basic_archive', - '--FILEDESC', 'basic_archive - basic archive module',]) + '--FILEDESC', 'basic_archive - basic archive and recovery module',]) endif basic_archive = shared_module('basic_archive', @@ -31,4 +31,9 @@ tests += { # which typical runningcheck users do not have (e.g. buildfarm clients). 'runningcheck': false, }, + 'tap': { + 'tests': [ + 't/001_restore.pl', + ], + }, } diff --git a/contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl b/contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..86ff0dc7f5 --- /dev/null +++ b/contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl @@ -0,0 +1,42 @@ + +# Copyright (c) 2022, PostgreSQL Global Development Group + +use strict; +use warnings; +use PostgreSQL::Test::Cluster; +use Test::More; + +# start a node +my $node = PostgreSQL::Test::Cluster->new('node'); +$node->init(has_archiving => 1, allows_streaming => 1); +my $archive_dir = $node->archive_dir; +$node->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "archive_command = ''"); +$node->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "archive_library = 'basic_archive'"); +$node->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "basic_archive.archive_directory = '$archive_dir'"); +$node->start; + +# backup the node +my $backup = 'backup'; +$node->backup($backup); + +# generate some new WAL files +$node->safe_psql('postgres', "CREATE TABLE test (a INT);"); +$node->safe_psql('postgres', "SELECT pg_switch_wal();"); +$node->safe_psql('postgres', "INSERT INTO test VALUES (1);"); + +# shut down the node (this should archive all WAL files) +$node->stop; + +# restore from the backup +my $restore = PostgreSQL::Test::Cluster->new('restore'); +$restore->init_from_backup($node, $backup, has_restoring => 1, standby => 0); +$restore->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "restore_command = ''"); +$restore->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "restore_library = 'basic_archive'"); +$restore->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "basic_archive.archive_directory = '$archive_dir'"); +$restore->start; + +# ensure post-backup WAL was replayed +my $result = $restore->safe_psql("postgres", "SELECT count(*) FROM test;"); +is($result, "1", "check restore content"); + +done_testing(); diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml index ef02051f7f..53e657040b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml @@ -1,34 +1,40 @@ <!-- doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml --> <chapter id="archive-modules"> - <title>Archive Modules</title> + <title>Archive and Recovery Modules</title> <indexterm zone="archive-modules"> - <primary>Archive Modules</primary> + <primary>Archive and Recovery Modules</primary> </indexterm> <para> PostgreSQL provides infrastructure to create custom modules for continuous - archiving (see <xref linkend="continuous-archiving"/>). While archiving via - a shell command (i.e., <xref linkend="guc-archive-command"/>) is much - simpler, a custom archive module will often be considerably more robust and - performant. + archiving and recovery (see <xref linkend="continuous-archiving"/>). While + a shell command (e.g., <xref linkend="guc-archive-command"/>, + <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/>) is much simpler, a custom module will + often be considerably more robust and performant. </para> <para> When a custom <xref linkend="guc-archive-library"/> is configured, PostgreSQL will submit completed WAL files to the module, and the server will avoid recycling or removing these WAL files until the module indicates that the files - were successfully archived. It is ultimately up to the module to decide what - to do with each WAL file, but many recommendations are listed at - <xref linkend="backup-archiving-wal"/>. + were successfully archived. When a custom + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> is configured, PostgreSQL will use the + module for recovery actions. It is ultimately up to the module to decide how + to accomplish each task, but some recommendations are listed at + <xref linkend="backup-archiving-wal"/> and + <xref linkend="backup-pitr-recovery"/>. </para> <para> - Archiving modules must at least consist of an initialization function (see - <xref linkend="archive-module-init"/>) and the required callbacks (see - <xref linkend="archive-module-callbacks"/>). However, archive modules are - also permitted to do much more (e.g., declare GUCs and register background - workers). + Archive and recovery modules must at least consist of an initialization + function (see <xref linkend="archive-module-init"/> and + <xref linkend="recovery-module-init"/>) and the required callbacks (see + <xref linkend="archive-module-callbacks"/> and + <xref linkend="recovery-module-callbacks"/>). However, archive and recovery + modules are also permitted to do much more (e.g., declare GUCs and register + background workers). A module may be used for both + <varname>archive_library</varname> and <varname>restore_library</varname>. </para> <para> @@ -37,7 +43,7 @@ </para> <sect1 id="archive-module-init"> - <title>Initialization Functions</title> + <title>Archive Module Initialization Functions</title> <indexterm zone="archive-module-init"> <primary>_PG_archive_module_init</primary> </indexterm> @@ -64,6 +70,12 @@ typedef void (*ArchiveModuleInit) (struct ArchiveModuleCallbacks *cb); Only the <function>archive_file_cb</function> callback is required. The others are optional. </para> + + <note> + <para> + <varname>archive_library</varname> is only loaded in the archiver process. + </para> + </note> </sect1> <sect1 id="archive-module-callbacks"> @@ -129,6 +141,132 @@ typedef bool (*ArchiveFileCB) (const char *file, const char *path); <programlisting> typedef void (*ArchiveShutdownCB) (void); +</programlisting> + </para> + </sect2> + </sect1> + + <sect1 id="recovery-module-init"> + <title>Recovery Module Initialization Functions</title> + <indexterm zone="recovery-module-init"> + <primary>_PG_recovery_module_init</primary> + </indexterm> + <para> + A recovery library is loaded by dynamically loading a shared library with the + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> as the library base name. The normal + library search path is used to locate the library. To provide the required + recovery module callbacks and to indicate that the library is actually a + recovery module, it needs to provide a function named + <function>_PG_recovery_module_init</function>. This function is passed a + struct that needs to be filled with the callback function pointers for + individual actions. + +<programlisting> +typedef struct RecoveryModuleCallbacks +{ + RecoveryRestoreCB restore_cb; + RecoveryArchiveCleanupCB archive_cleanup_cb; + RecoveryEndCB recovery_end_cb; + RecoveryShutdownCB shutdown_cb; +} RecoveryModuleCallbacks; +typedef void (*RecoveryModuleInit) (struct RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb); +</programlisting> + + The <function>restore_cb</function> callback is required for archive + recovery, but it is optional for streaming replication. The others are + always optional. + </para> + + <note> + <para> + <varname>restore_library</varname> is only loaded in the startup and + checkpointer processes and in single-user mode. + </para> + </note> + </sect1> + + <sect1 id="recovery-module-callbacks"> + <title>Recovery Module Callbacks</title> + <para> + The recovery callbacks define the actual behavior of the module. The server + will call them as required to execute recovery actions. + </para> + + <sect2 id="recovery-module-restore"> + <title>Restore Callback</title> + <para> + The <function>restore_cb</function> callback is called to retrieve a single + archived segment of the WAL file series for archive recovery or streaming + replication. + +<programlisting> +typedef bool (*RecoveryRestoreCB) (const char *file, const char *path, const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +</programlisting> + + This callback must return <literal>true</literal> only if the file was + successfully retrieved. If the file is not available in the archives, the + callback must return <literal>false</literal>. + <replaceable>file</replaceable> will contain just the file name + of the WAL file to retrieve, while <replaceable>path</replaceable> contains + the destination's relative path (including the file name). + <replaceable>lastRestartPointFileName</replaceable> will contain the name + of the file containing the last valid restart point. That is the earliest + file that must be kept to allow a restore to be restartable, so this + information can be used to truncate the archive to just the minimum + required to support restarting from the current restore. + <replaceable>lastRestartPointFileName</replaceable> is typically only used + by warm-standby configurations (see <xref linkend="warm-standby"/>). Note + that if multiple standby servers are restoring from the same archive + directory, you will need to ensure that you do not delete WAL files until + they are no longer needed by any of the servers. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="recovery-module-archive-cleanup"> + <title>Archive Cleanup Callback</title> + <para> + The <function>archive_cleanup_cb</function> callback is called at every + restart point and is intended to provide a mechanism for cleaning up old + archived WAL files that are no longer needed by the standby server. + +<programlisting> +typedef void (*RecoveryArchiveCleanupCB) (const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +</programlisting> + + <replaceable>lastRestartPointFileName</replaceable> will contain the name + of the file containing the last valid restart point, like in + <link linkend="recovery-module-restore"><function>restore_cb</function></link>. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="recovery-module-end"> + <title>Recovery End Callback</title> + <para> + The <function>recovery_end_cb</function> callback is called once at the end + of recovery and is intended to provide a mechanism for cleanup following + replication or recovery. + +<programlisting> +typedef void (*RecoveryEndCB) (const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +</programlisting> + + <replaceable>lastRestartPointFileName</replaceable> will contain the name + of the file containing the last valid restart point, like in + <link linkend="recovery-module-restore"><function>restore_cb</function></link>. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="recovery-module-shutdown"> + <title>Shutdown Callback</title> + <para> + The <function>shutdown_cb</function> callback is called when a process that + has loaded the recovery module exits (e.g., after an error) or the value of + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> changes. If no + <function>shutdown_cb</function> is defined, no special action is taken in + these situations. + +<programlisting> +typedef void (*RecoveryShutdownCB) (void); </programlisting> </para> </sect2> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml index 8bab521718..d6d34078fc 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml @@ -1181,9 +1181,27 @@ SELECT * FROM pg_backup_stop(wait_for_archive => true); <para> The key part of all this is to set up a recovery configuration that describes how you want to recover and how far the recovery should - run. The one thing that you absolutely must specify is the <varname>restore_command</varname>, - which tells <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> how to retrieve archived - WAL file segments. Like the <varname>archive_command</varname>, this is + run. The one thing that you absolutely must specify is either + <varname>restore_command</varname> or a <varname>restore_library</varname> + that defines a restore callback, which tells + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> how to retrieve archived WAL file + segments. + </para> + + <para> + Like the <varname>archive_library</varname> parameter, + <varname>restore_library</varname> is a shared library. Since such + libraries are written in <literal>C</literal>, creating your own may + require considerably more effort than writing a shell command. However, + recovery modules can be more performant than restoring via shell, and they + will have access to many useful server resources. For more information + about creating a <varname>restore_library</varname>, see + <xref linkend="archive-modules"/>. + </para> + + <para> + Like the <varname>archive_command</varname>, + <varname>restore_command</varname> is a shell command string. It can contain <literal>%f</literal>, which is replaced by the name of the desired WAL file, and <literal>%p</literal>, which is replaced by the path name to copy the WAL file to. @@ -1202,14 +1220,20 @@ restore_command = 'cp /mnt/server/archivedir/%f %p' </para> <para> - It is important that the command return nonzero exit status on failure. - The command <emphasis>will</emphasis> be called requesting files that are not - present in the archive; it must return nonzero when so asked. This is not - an error condition. An exception is that if the command was terminated by + It is important that the <varname>restore_command</varname> return nonzero + exit status on failure, or, if you are using a + <varname>restore_library</varname>, that the restore function returns + <literal>false</literal> on failure. The command or library + <emphasis>will</emphasis> be called requesting files that are not + present in the archive; it must fail when so asked. This is not + an error condition. An exception is that if the + <varname>restore_command</varname> was terminated by a signal (other than <systemitem>SIGTERM</systemitem>, which is used as part of a database server shutdown) or an error by the shell (such as command not found), then recovery will abort and the server will not start - up. + up. Likewise, if the restore function provided by the + <varname>restore_library</varname> emits an <literal>ERROR</literal> or + <literal>FATAL</literal>, recovery will abort and the server won't start. </para> <para> @@ -1233,7 +1257,8 @@ restore_command = 'cp /mnt/server/archivedir/%f %p' close as possible given the available WAL segments). Therefore, a normal recovery will end with a <quote>file not found</quote> message, the exact text of the error message depending upon your choice of - <varname>restore_command</varname>. You may also see an error message + <varname>restore_command</varname> or <varname>restore_library</varname>. + You may also see an error message at the start of recovery for a file named something like <filename>00000001.history</filename>. This is also normal and does not indicate a problem in simple recovery situations; see diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml index 0b650f17a8..ac7cd9b967 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml @@ -8,17 +8,20 @@ </indexterm> <para> - <filename>basic_archive</filename> is an example of an archive module. This - module copies completed WAL segment files to the specified directory. This - may not be especially useful, but it can serve as a starting point for - developing your own archive module. For more information about archive - modules, see <xref linkend="archive-modules"/>. + <filename>basic_archive</filename> is an example of an archive and recovery + module. This module copies completed WAL segment files to or from the + specified directory. This may not be especially useful, but it can serve as + a starting point for developing your own archive and recovery modules. For + more information about archive and recovery modules, see + see <xref linkend="archive-modules"/>. </para> <para> - In order to function, this module must be loaded via + For use as an archive module, this module must be loaded via <xref linkend="guc-archive-library"/>, and <xref linkend="guc-archive-mode"/> - must be enabled. + must be enabled. For use as a recovery module, this module must be loaded + via <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/>, and recovery must be enabled (see + <xref linkend="runtime-config-wal-archive-recovery"/>). </para> <sect2> @@ -34,11 +37,12 @@ </term> <listitem> <para> - The directory where the server should copy WAL segment files. This - directory must already exist. The default is an empty string, which - effectively halts WAL archiving, but if <xref linkend="guc-archive-mode"/> - is enabled, the server will accumulate WAL segment files in the - expectation that a value will soon be provided. + The directory where the server should copy WAL segment files to or from. + This directory must already exist. The default is an empty string, + which, when used for archiving, effectively halts WAL archival, but if + <xref linkend="guc-archive-mode"/> is enabled, the server will accumulate + WAL segment files in the expectation that a value will soon be provided. + When an empty string is used for recovery, restore will fail. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -46,7 +50,7 @@ <para> These parameters must be set in <filename>postgresql.conf</filename>. - Typical usage might be: + Typical usage as an archive module might be: </para> <programlisting> @@ -61,7 +65,8 @@ basic_archive.archive_directory = '/path/to/archive/directory' <title>Notes</title> <para> - Server crashes may leave temporary files with the prefix + When <filename>basic_archive</filename> is used as an archive module, server + crashes may leave temporary files with the prefix <filename>archtemp</filename> in the archive directory. It is recommended to delete such files before restarting the server after a crash. It is safe to remove such files while the server is running as long as they are unrelated diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml index 05b3862d09..899d2b5fdb 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml @@ -3773,7 +3773,8 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' recovery when the end of archived WAL is reached, but will keep trying to continue recovery by connecting to the sending server as specified by the <varname>primary_conninfo</varname> setting and/or by fetching new WAL - segments using <varname>restore_command</varname>. For this mode, the + segments using <varname>restore_command</varname> or + <varname>restore_library</varname>. For this mode, the parameters from this section and <xref linkend="runtime-config-replication-standby"/> are of interest. Parameters from <xref linkend="runtime-config-wal-recovery-target"/> will @@ -3801,7 +3802,8 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' <listitem> <para> The local shell command to execute to retrieve an archived segment of - the WAL file series. This parameter is required for archive recovery, + the WAL file series. Either <varname>restore_command</varname> or + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> is required for archive recovery, but optional for streaming replication. Any <literal>%f</literal> in the string is replaced by the name of the file to retrieve from the archive, @@ -3836,7 +3838,42 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows <para> This parameter can only be set in the <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> - file or on the server command line. + file or on the server command line. It is only used if + <varname>restore_library</varname> is set to an empty string. If both + <varname>restore_command</varname> and + <varname>restore_library</varname> are set, an error will be raised. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry id="guc-restore-library" xreflabel="restore_library"> + <term><varname>restore_library</varname> (<type>string</type>) + <indexterm> + <primary><varname>restore_library</varname> configuration parameter</primary> + </indexterm> + </term> + <listitem> + <para> + The library to use for recovery actions, including retrieving archived + segments of the WAL file series and executing tasks at restartpoints + and at recovery end. Either <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> or + <varname>restore_library</varname> is required for archive recovery, + but optional for streaming replication. If this parameter is set to an + empty string (the default), restoring via shell is enabled, and + <varname>restore_command</varname>, + <varname>archive_cleanup_command</varname> and + <varname>recovery_end_command</varname> are used. If both + <varname>restore_library</varname> and any of + <varname>restore_command</varname>, + <varname>archive_cleanup_command</varname> or + <varname>recovery_end_command</varname> are set, an error will be + raised. Otherwise, the specified shared library is used for recovery. + For more information, see <xref linkend="archive-modules"/>. + </para> + + <para> + This parameter can only be set in the + <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> file or on the server command line. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -3881,7 +3918,10 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows </para> <para> This parameter can only be set in the <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> - file or on the server command line. + file or on the server command line. It is only used if + <varname>restore_library</varname> is set to an empty string. If both + <varname>archive_cleanup_command</varname> and + <varname>restore_library</varname> are set, an error will be raised. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -3910,11 +3950,13 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows </para> <para> This parameter can only be set in the <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> - file or on the server command line. + file or on the server command line. It is only used if + <varname>restore_library</varname> is set to an empty string. If both + <varname>recovery_end_command</varname> and + <varname>restore_library</varname> are set, an error will be raised. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> - </variablelist> </sect2> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml index f180607528..6266e2df7f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml @@ -627,7 +627,8 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <para> In standby mode, the server continuously applies WAL received from the primary server. The standby server can read WAL from a WAL archive - (see <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/>) or directly from the primary + (see <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> and + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/>) or directly from the primary over a TCP connection (streaming replication). The standby server will also attempt to restore any WAL found in the standby cluster's <filename>pg_wal</filename> directory. That typically happens after a server @@ -638,9 +639,11 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <para> At startup, the standby begins by restoring all WAL available in the - archive location, calling <varname>restore_command</varname>. Once it - reaches the end of WAL available there and <varname>restore_command</varname> - fails, it tries to restore any WAL available in the <filename>pg_wal</filename> directory. + archive location, either by calling <varname>restore_command</varname> or + by executing the <varname>restore_library</varname>'s restore callback. + Once it reaches the end of WAL available there and + <varname>restore_command</varname> or the restore callback fails, it tries + to restore any WAL available in the <filename>pg_wal</filename> directory. If that fails, and streaming replication has been configured, the standby tries to connect to the primary server and start streaming WAL from the last valid record found in archive or <filename>pg_wal</filename>. If that fails @@ -698,7 +701,8 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. server (see <xref linkend="backup-pitr-recovery"/>). Create a file <link linkend="file-standby-signal"><filename>standby.signal</filename></link><indexterm><primary>standby.signal</primary></indexterm> in the standby's cluster data - directory. Set <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> to a simple command to copy files from + directory. Set <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> or + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> to copy files from the WAL archive. If you plan to have multiple standby servers for high availability purposes, make sure that <varname>recovery_target_timeline</varname> is set to <literal>latest</literal> (the default), to make the standby server follow the timeline change @@ -707,7 +711,8 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <note> <para> - <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> should return immediately + <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> and restore callbacks provided by + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> should return immediately if the file does not exist; the server will retry the command again if necessary. </para> @@ -731,8 +736,10 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <para> If you're using a WAL archive, its size can be minimized using the <xref - linkend="guc-archive-cleanup-command"/> parameter to remove files that are no - longer required by the standby server. + linkend="guc-archive-cleanup-command"/> parameter or the + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/>'s + <function>archive_cleanup_cb</function> callback function to remove files + that are no longer required by the standby server. The <application>pg_archivecleanup</application> utility is designed specifically to be used with <varname>archive_cleanup_command</varname> in typical single-standby configurations, see <xref linkend="pgarchivecleanup"/>. diff --git a/src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c b/src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c index 073e709e06..124a0bbdb6 100644 --- a/src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c +++ b/src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c @@ -3,7 +3,8 @@ * shell_restore.c * * These recovery functions use a user-specified shell command (e.g., the - * restore_command GUC). + * restore_command GUC). It is used as the default, but other modules may + * define their own recovery logic. * * Copyright (c) 2022, PostgreSQL Global Development Group * @@ -22,6 +23,10 @@ #include "storage/ipc.h" #include "utils/wait_event.h" +static bool shell_restore(const char *file, const char *path, + const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +static void shell_archive_cleanup(const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +static void shell_recovery_end(const char *lastRestartPointFileName); static char *BuildCleanupCommand(const char *command, const char *lastRestartPointFileName); static bool ExecuteRecoveryCommand(const char *command, @@ -29,6 +34,16 @@ static bool ExecuteRecoveryCommand(const char *command, bool exitOnSigterm, uint32 wait_event_info, int fail_elevel); +void +shell_restore_init(RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb) +{ + AssertVariableIsOfType(&shell_restore_init, RecoveryModuleInit); + + cb->restore_cb = shell_restore; + cb->archive_cleanup_cb = shell_archive_cleanup; + cb->recovery_end_cb = shell_recovery_end; +} + bool shell_restore(const char *file, const char *path, const char *lastRestartPointFileName) @@ -73,7 +88,7 @@ shell_restore(const char *file, const char *path, return ret; } -void +static void shell_archive_cleanup(const char *lastRestartPointFileName) { char *cmd = BuildCleanupCommand(archiveCleanupCommand, @@ -84,7 +99,7 @@ shell_archive_cleanup(const char *lastRestartPointFileName) pfree(cmd); } -void +static void shell_recovery_end(const char *lastRestartPointFileName) { char *cmd = BuildCleanupCommand(recoveryEndCommand, diff --git a/src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c b/src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c index 32225be4a5..2179e44386 100644 --- a/src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c +++ b/src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c @@ -4883,10 +4883,11 @@ static void CleanupAfterArchiveRecovery(TimeLineID EndOfLogTLI, XLogRecPtr EndOfLog, TimeLineID newTLI) { + /* - * Execute the recovery_end_command, if any. + * Execute the recovery-end callback, if any. */ - if (recoveryEndCommand && strcmp(recoveryEndCommand, "") != 0) + if (RecoveryContext.recovery_end_cb) { char lastRestartPointFname[MAXPGPATH]; XLogSegNo restartSegNo; @@ -4903,7 +4904,7 @@ CleanupAfterArchiveRecovery(TimeLineID EndOfLogTLI, XLogRecPtr EndOfLog, XLogFileName(lastRestartPointFname, restartTli, restartSegNo, wal_segment_size); - shell_recovery_end(lastRestartPointFname); + RecoveryContext.recovery_end_cb(lastRestartPointFname); } /* @@ -7318,9 +7319,9 @@ CreateRestartPoint(int flags) timestamptz_to_str(xtime)) : 0)); /* - * Finally, execute archive_cleanup_command, if any. + * Execute the archive-cleanup callback, if any. */ - if (archiveCleanupCommand && strcmp(archiveCleanupCommand, "") != 0) + if (RecoveryContext.archive_cleanup_cb) { char lastRestartPointFname[MAXPGPATH]; XLogSegNo restartSegNo; @@ -7337,7 +7338,7 @@ CreateRestartPoint(int flags) XLogFileName(lastRestartPointFname, restartTli, restartSegNo, wal_segment_size); - shell_archive_cleanup(lastRestartPointFname); + RecoveryContext.archive_cleanup_cb(lastRestartPointFname); } return true; diff --git a/src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c b/src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c index 50b0d1105d..4caecfaea0 100644 --- a/src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c +++ b/src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c @@ -22,7 +22,9 @@ #include "access/xlog.h" #include "access/xlog_internal.h" #include "access/xlogarchive.h" +#include "access/xlogrecovery.h" #include "common/archive.h" +#include "fmgr.h" #include "miscadmin.h" #include "pgstat.h" #include "postmaster/startup.h" @@ -32,6 +34,11 @@ #include "storage/ipc.h" #include "storage/lwlock.h" +/* + * Global context for recovery-related callbacks. + */ +RecoveryModuleCallbacks RecoveryContext; + /* * Attempt to retrieve the specified file from off-line archival storage. * If successful, fill "path" with its complete path (note that this will be @@ -71,7 +78,7 @@ RestoreArchivedFile(char *path, const char *xlogfname, goto not_available; /* In standby mode, restore_command might not be supplied */ - if (recoveryRestoreCommand == NULL || strcmp(recoveryRestoreCommand, "") == 0) + if (RecoveryContext.restore_cb == NULL) goto not_available; /* @@ -149,14 +156,15 @@ RestoreArchivedFile(char *path, const char *xlogfname, XLogFileName(lastRestartPointFname, 0, 0L, wal_segment_size); /* - * Check signals before restore command and reset afterwards. + * Check signals before restore callback and reset afterwards. */ PreRestoreCommand(); /* * Copy xlog from archival storage to XLOGDIR */ - ret = shell_restore(xlogfname, xlogpath, lastRestartPointFname); + ret = RecoveryContext.restore_cb(xlogfname, xlogpath, + lastRestartPointFname); PostRestoreCommand(); @@ -603,3 +611,59 @@ XLogArchiveCleanup(const char *xlog) unlink(archiveStatusPath); /* should we complain about failure? */ } + +/* + * Loads all the recovery callbacks into our global RecoveryContext. The + * caller is responsible for validating the combination of library/command + * parameters that are set (e.g., restore_command and restore_library cannot + * both be set). + */ +void +LoadRecoveryCallbacks(void) +{ + RecoveryModuleInit init; + + /* + * If the shell command is enabled, use our special initialization + * function. Otherwise, load the library and call its + * _PG_recovery_module_init(). + */ + if (restoreLibrary[0] == '\0') + init = shell_restore_init; + else + init = (RecoveryModuleInit) + load_external_function(restoreLibrary, "_PG_recovery_module_init", + false, NULL); + + if (init == NULL) + ereport(ERROR, + (errmsg("recovery modules have to define the symbol " + "_PG_recovery_module_init"))); + + memset(&RecoveryContext, 0, sizeof(RecoveryModuleCallbacks)); + (*init) (&RecoveryContext); + + /* + * If using shell commands, remove callbacks for any commands that are not + * set. + */ + if (restoreLibrary[0] == '\0') + { + if (recoveryRestoreCommand[0] == '\0') + RecoveryContext.restore_cb = NULL; + if (archiveCleanupCommand[0] == '\0') + RecoveryContext.archive_cleanup_cb = NULL; + if (recoveryEndCommand[0] == '\0') + RecoveryContext.recovery_end_cb = NULL; + } +} + +/* + * Call the shutdown callback of the loaded recovery module, if defined. + */ +void +call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb(int code, Datum arg) +{ + if (RecoveryContext.shutdown_cb) + RecoveryContext.shutdown_cb(); +} diff --git a/src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c b/src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c index d5a81f9d83..f1c0a4ffad 100644 --- a/src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c +++ b/src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c @@ -80,6 +80,7 @@ const struct config_enum_entry recovery_target_action_options[] = { /* options formerly taken from recovery.conf for archive recovery */ char *recoveryRestoreCommand = NULL; +char *restoreLibrary = NULL; char *recoveryEndCommand = NULL; char *archiveCleanupCommand = NULL; RecoveryTargetType recoveryTarget = RECOVERY_TARGET_UNSET; @@ -1053,24 +1054,37 @@ validateRecoveryParameters(void) if (!ArchiveRecoveryRequested) return; + /* + * Check for invalid combinations of the command/library parameters and + * load the callbacks. + */ + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + recoveryRestoreCommand, "restore_command"); + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + recoveryEndCommand, "recovery_end_command"); + before_shmem_exit(call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb, 0); + LoadRecoveryCallbacks(); + /* * Check for compulsory parameters */ if (StandbyModeRequested) { if ((PrimaryConnInfo == NULL || strcmp(PrimaryConnInfo, "") == 0) && - (recoveryRestoreCommand == NULL || strcmp(recoveryRestoreCommand, "") == 0)) + RecoveryContext.restore_cb == NULL) ereport(WARNING, - (errmsg("specified neither primary_conninfo nor restore_command"), - errhint("The database server will regularly poll the pg_wal subdirectory to check for files placed there."))); + (errmsg("specified neither primary_conninfo nor restore_command " + "nor a restore_library that defines a restore callback"), + errhint("The database server will regularly poll the pg_wal " + "subdirectory to check for files placed there."))); } else { - if (recoveryRestoreCommand == NULL || - strcmp(recoveryRestoreCommand, "") == 0) + if (RecoveryContext.restore_cb == NULL) ereport(FATAL, (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), - errmsg("must specify restore_command when standby mode is not enabled"))); + errmsg("must specify restore_command or a restore_library that defines " + "a restore callback when standby mode is not enabled"))); } /* diff --git a/src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c b/src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c index 5fc076fc14..bfa6e4f0d0 100644 --- a/src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c +++ b/src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c @@ -38,6 +38,7 @@ #include "access/xlog.h" #include "access/xlog_internal.h" +#include "access/xlogarchive.h" #include "access/xlogrecovery.h" #include "libpq/pqsignal.h" #include "miscadmin.h" @@ -222,6 +223,16 @@ CheckpointerMain(void) */ before_shmem_exit(pgstat_before_server_shutdown, 0); + /* + * Check for invalid combinations of the command/library parameters and + * load the callbacks. We do this before setting up the exception handler + * so that any problems result in a server crash shortly after startup. + */ + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + archiveCleanupCommand, "archive_cleanup_command"); + before_shmem_exit(call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb, 0); + LoadRecoveryCallbacks(); + /* * Create a memory context that we will do all our work in. We do this so * that we can reset the context during error recovery and thereby avoid @@ -548,6 +559,9 @@ HandleCheckpointerInterrupts(void) if (ConfigReloadPending) { + char *prevRestoreLibrary = pstrdup(restoreLibrary); + char *prevArchiveCleanupCommand = pstrdup(archiveCleanupCommand); + ConfigReloadPending = false; ProcessConfigFile(PGC_SIGHUP); @@ -563,6 +577,18 @@ HandleCheckpointerInterrupts(void) * because of SIGHUP. */ UpdateSharedMemoryConfig(); + + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + archiveCleanupCommand, "archive_cleanup_command"); + if (strcmp(prevRestoreLibrary, restoreLibrary) != 0 || + strcmp(prevArchiveCleanupCommand, archiveCleanupCommand) != 0) + { + call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb(0, (Datum) 0); + LoadRecoveryCallbacks(); + } + + pfree(prevRestoreLibrary); + pfree(prevArchiveCleanupCommand); } if (ShutdownRequestPending) { diff --git a/src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c b/src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c index fffb6a599c..623637d8e1 100644 --- a/src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c +++ b/src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c @@ -831,11 +831,8 @@ LoadArchiveLibrary(void) { ArchiveModuleInit archive_init; - if (XLogArchiveLibrary[0] != '\0' && XLogArchiveCommand[0] != '\0') - ereport(ERROR, - (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), - errmsg("both archive_command and archive_library set"), - errdetail("Only one of archive_command, archive_library may be set."))); + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(XLogArchiveLibrary, "archive_library", + XLogArchiveCommand, "archive_command"); memset(&ArchiveContext, 0, sizeof(ArchiveModuleCallbacks)); diff --git a/src/backend/postmaster/startup.c b/src/backend/postmaster/startup.c index f99186eab7..14701b2b85 100644 --- a/src/backend/postmaster/startup.c +++ b/src/backend/postmaster/startup.c @@ -20,6 +20,7 @@ #include "postgres.h" #include "access/xlog.h" +#include "access/xlogarchive.h" #include "access/xlogrecovery.h" #include "access/xlogutils.h" #include "libpq/pqsignal.h" @@ -133,13 +134,17 @@ StartupProcShutdownHandler(SIGNAL_ARGS) * Re-read the config file. * * If one of the critical walreceiver options has changed, flag xlog.c - * to restart it. + * to restart it. Also, check for invalid combinations of the command/library + * parameters and reload the recovery callbacks if necessary. */ static void StartupRereadConfig(void) { char *conninfo = pstrdup(PrimaryConnInfo); char *slotname = pstrdup(PrimarySlotName); + char *prevRestoreLibrary = pstrdup(restoreLibrary); + char *prevRestoreCommand = pstrdup(recoveryRestoreCommand); + char *prevRecoveryEndCommand = pstrdup(recoveryEndCommand); bool tempSlot = wal_receiver_create_temp_slot; bool conninfoChanged; bool slotnameChanged; @@ -161,6 +166,22 @@ StartupRereadConfig(void) if (conninfoChanged || slotnameChanged || tempSlotChanged) StartupRequestWalReceiverRestart(); + + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + recoveryRestoreCommand, "restore_command"); + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + recoveryEndCommand, "recovery_end_command"); + if (strcmp(prevRestoreLibrary, restoreLibrary) != 0 || + strcmp(prevRestoreCommand, recoveryRestoreCommand) != 0 || + strcmp(prevRecoveryEndCommand, recoveryEndCommand) != 0) + { + call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb(0, (Datum) 0); + LoadRecoveryCallbacks(); + } + + pfree(prevRestoreLibrary); + pfree(prevRestoreCommand); + pfree(prevRecoveryEndCommand); } /* Handle various signals that might be sent to the startup process */ diff --git a/src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c b/src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c index c6326d5053..5213b2b0b1 100644 --- a/src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c +++ b/src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c @@ -6880,3 +6880,17 @@ call_enum_check_hook(struct config_enum *conf, int *newval, void **extra, return true; } + +/* + * ERROR if both parameters are set. + */ +void +CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(const char *p1val, const char *p1name, + const char *p2val, const char *p2name) +{ + if (p1val[0] != '\0' && p2val[0] != '\0') + ereport(ERROR, + (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), + errmsg("both %s and %s set", p1name, p2name), + errdetail("Only one of %s, %s may be set.", p1name, p2name))); +} diff --git a/src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c b/src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c index a37c9f9844..8796bcf7ca 100644 --- a/src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c +++ b/src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c @@ -3764,6 +3764,16 @@ struct config_string ConfigureNamesString[] = NULL, NULL, NULL }, + { + {"restore_library", PGC_SIGHUP, WAL_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY, + gettext_noop("Sets the library that will be called for recovery actions."), + NULL + }, + &restoreLibrary, + "", + NULL, NULL, NULL + }, + { {"archive_cleanup_command", PGC_SIGHUP, WAL_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY, gettext_noop("Sets the shell command that will be executed at every restart point."), diff --git a/src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample b/src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample index 5afdeb04de..e71e79271a 100644 --- a/src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample +++ b/src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample @@ -269,6 +269,7 @@ # placeholders: %p = path of file to restore # %f = file name only # e.g. 'cp /mnt/server/archivedir/%f %p' +#restore_library = '' # library to use for recovery actions #archive_cleanup_command = '' # command to execute at every restartpoint #recovery_end_command = '' # command to execute at completion of recovery diff --git a/src/include/access/xlog_internal.h b/src/include/access/xlog_internal.h index e5fc66966b..133a614133 100644 --- a/src/include/access/xlog_internal.h +++ b/src/include/access/xlog_internal.h @@ -400,5 +400,6 @@ extern PGDLLIMPORT bool ArchiveRecoveryRequested; extern PGDLLIMPORT bool InArchiveRecovery; extern PGDLLIMPORT bool StandbyMode; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *recoveryRestoreCommand; +extern PGDLLIMPORT char *restoreLibrary; #endif /* XLOG_INTERNAL_H */ diff --git a/src/include/access/xlogarchive.h b/src/include/access/xlogarchive.h index 69d002cdeb..090e92e554 100644 --- a/src/include/access/xlogarchive.h +++ b/src/include/access/xlogarchive.h @@ -30,9 +30,45 @@ extern bool XLogArchiveIsReady(const char *xlog); extern bool XLogArchiveIsReadyOrDone(const char *xlog); extern void XLogArchiveCleanup(const char *xlog); -extern bool shell_restore(const char *file, const char *path, - const char *lastRestartPointFileName); -extern void shell_archive_cleanup(const char *lastRestartPointFileName); -extern void shell_recovery_end(const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +/* + * Recovery module callbacks + * + * These callback functions should be defined by recovery libraries and + * returned via _PG_recovery_module_init(). For more information about the + * purpose of each callback, refer to the recovery modules documentation. + */ +typedef bool (*RecoveryRestoreCB) (const char *file, const char *path, + const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +typedef void (*RecoveryArchiveCleanupCB) (const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +typedef void (*RecoveryEndCB) (const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +typedef void (*RecoveryShutdownCB) (void); + +typedef struct RecoveryModuleCallbacks +{ + RecoveryRestoreCB restore_cb; + RecoveryArchiveCleanupCB archive_cleanup_cb; + RecoveryEndCB recovery_end_cb; + RecoveryShutdownCB shutdown_cb; +} RecoveryModuleCallbacks; + +extern RecoveryModuleCallbacks RecoveryContext; + +/* + * Type of the shared library symbol _PG_recovery_module_init that is looked up + * when loading a recovery library. + */ +typedef void (*RecoveryModuleInit) (RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb); + +extern PGDLLEXPORT void _PG_recovery_module_init(RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb); + +extern void LoadRecoveryCallbacks(void); +extern void call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb(int code, Datum arg); + +/* + * Since the logic for recovery via a shell command is in the core server and + * does not need to be loaded via a shared library, it has a special + * initialization function. + */ +extern void shell_restore_init(RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb); #endif /* XLOG_ARCHIVE_H */ diff --git a/src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h b/src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h index f3398425d8..86a41ff35d 100644 --- a/src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h +++ b/src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h @@ -55,6 +55,7 @@ extern PGDLLIMPORT int recovery_min_apply_delay; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *PrimaryConnInfo; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *PrimarySlotName; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *recoveryRestoreCommand; +extern PGDLLIMPORT char *restoreLibrary; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *recoveryEndCommand; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *archiveCleanupCommand; diff --git a/src/include/utils/guc.h b/src/include/utils/guc.h index 91cc341854..d1445cdfcb 100644 --- a/src/include/utils/guc.h +++ b/src/include/utils/guc.h @@ -404,6 +404,8 @@ extern void *guc_malloc(int elevel, size_t size); extern pg_nodiscard void *guc_realloc(int elevel, void *old, size_t size); extern char *guc_strdup(int elevel, const char *src); extern void guc_free(void *ptr); +extern void CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(const char *p1val, const char *p1name, + const char *p2val, const char *p2name); #ifdef EXEC_BACKEND extern void write_nondefault_variables(GucContext context); -- 2.25.1 --vkogqOf2sHV7VnPd-- ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 17+ messages in thread
* [PATCH v3 3/3] Allow recovery via loadable modules. @ 2022-12-10 03:40 Nathan Bossart <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 17+ messages in thread From: Nathan Bossart @ 2022-12-10 03:40 UTC (permalink / raw) This adds the restore_library parameter to allow archive recovery via a loadable module, rather than running shell commands. --- contrib/basic_archive/Makefile | 4 +- contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c | 67 ++++++- contrib/basic_archive/meson.build | 7 +- contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl | 42 +++++ doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml | 168 ++++++++++++++++-- doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml | 43 ++++- doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml | 33 ++-- doc/src/sgml/config.sgml | 54 +++++- doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml | 23 ++- src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c | 21 ++- src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c | 13 +- src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c | 70 +++++++- src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c | 26 ++- src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c | 26 +++ src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c | 7 +- src/backend/postmaster/startup.c | 23 ++- src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c | 14 ++ src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c | 10 ++ src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample | 1 + src/include/access/xlog_internal.h | 1 + src/include/access/xlogarchive.h | 44 ++++- src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h | 1 + src/include/utils/guc.h | 2 + 23 files changed, 616 insertions(+), 84 deletions(-) create mode 100644 contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl diff --git a/contrib/basic_archive/Makefile b/contrib/basic_archive/Makefile index 55d299d650..487dc563f3 100644 --- a/contrib/basic_archive/Makefile +++ b/contrib/basic_archive/Makefile @@ -1,7 +1,7 @@ # contrib/basic_archive/Makefile MODULES = basic_archive -PGFILEDESC = "basic_archive - basic archive module" +PGFILEDESC = "basic_archive - basic archive and recovery module" REGRESS = basic_archive REGRESS_OPTS = --temp-config $(top_srcdir)/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.conf @@ -9,6 +9,8 @@ REGRESS_OPTS = --temp-config $(top_srcdir)/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c # which typical installcheck users do not have (e.g. buildfarm clients). NO_INSTALLCHECK = 1 +TAP_TESTS = 1 + ifdef USE_PGXS PG_CONFIG = pg_config PGXS := $(shell $(PG_CONFIG) --pgxs) diff --git a/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c b/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c index 28cbb6cce0..8c333c8f99 100644 --- a/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c +++ b/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c @@ -17,6 +17,11 @@ * a file is successfully archived and then the system crashes before * a durable record of the success has been made. * + * This file also demonstrates a basic restore library implementation that + * is roughly equivalent to the following shell command: + * + * cp /path/to/archivedir/%f %p + * * Copyright (c) 2022-2023, PostgreSQL Global Development Group * * IDENTIFICATION @@ -30,6 +35,7 @@ #include <sys/time.h> #include <unistd.h> +#include "access/xlogarchive.h" #include "common/int.h" #include "miscadmin.h" #include "postmaster/pgarch.h" @@ -48,6 +54,8 @@ static bool basic_archive_file(const char *file, const char *path); static void basic_archive_file_internal(const char *file, const char *path); static bool check_archive_directory(char **newval, void **extra, GucSource source); static bool compare_files(const char *file1, const char *file2); +static bool basic_restore_file(const char *file, const char *path, + const char *lastRestartPointFileName); /* * _PG_init @@ -87,6 +95,19 @@ _PG_archive_module_init(ArchiveModuleCallbacks *cb) cb->archive_file_cb = basic_archive_file; } +/* + * _PG_recovery_module_init + * + * Returns the module's restore callback. + */ +void +_PG_recovery_module_init(RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb) +{ + AssertVariableIsOfType(&_PG_recovery_module_init, RecoveryModuleInit); + + cb->restore_cb = basic_restore_file; +} + /* * check_archive_directory * @@ -99,8 +120,8 @@ check_archive_directory(char **newval, void **extra, GucSource source) /* * The default value is an empty string, so we have to accept that value. - * Our check_configured callback also checks for this and prevents - * archiving from proceeding if it is still empty. + * Our check_configured and restore callbacks also check for this and + * prevent archiving or recovery from proceeding if it is still empty. */ if (*newval == NULL || *newval[0] == '\0') return true; @@ -368,3 +389,45 @@ compare_files(const char *file1, const char *file2) return ret; } + +/* + * basic_restore_file + * + * Retrieves one file from the WAL archives. + */ +static bool +basic_restore_file(const char *file, const char *path, + const char *lastRestartPointFileName) +{ + char source[MAXPGPATH]; + struct stat st; + + ereport(DEBUG1, + (errmsg("restoring \"%s\" via basic_archive", file))); + + if (archive_directory == NULL || archive_directory[0] == '\0') + ereport(ERROR, + (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), + errmsg("\"basic_archive.archive_directory\" is not set"))); + + /* + * Check whether the file exists. If not, we return false to indicate that + * there are no more files to restore. + */ + snprintf(source, MAXPGPATH, "%s/%s", archive_directory, file); + if (stat(source, &st) != 0) + { + int elevel = (errno == ENOENT) ? DEBUG1 : ERROR; + + ereport(elevel, + (errcode_for_file_access(), + errmsg("could not stat file \"%s\": %m", source))); + return false; + } + + copy_file(source, unconstify(char *, path)); + + ereport(DEBUG1, + (errmsg("restored \"%s\" via basic_archive", file))); + return true; +} diff --git a/contrib/basic_archive/meson.build b/contrib/basic_archive/meson.build index bc1380e6f6..af4580dea9 100644 --- a/contrib/basic_archive/meson.build +++ b/contrib/basic_archive/meson.build @@ -7,7 +7,7 @@ basic_archive_sources = files( if host_system == 'windows' basic_archive_sources += rc_lib_gen.process(win32ver_rc, extra_args: [ '--NAME', 'basic_archive', - '--FILEDESC', 'basic_archive - basic archive module',]) + '--FILEDESC', 'basic_archive - basic archive and recovery module',]) endif basic_archive = shared_module('basic_archive', @@ -31,4 +31,9 @@ tests += { # which typical runningcheck users do not have (e.g. buildfarm clients). 'runningcheck': false, }, + 'tap': { + 'tests': [ + 't/001_restore.pl', + ], + }, } diff --git a/contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl b/contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..86ff0dc7f5 --- /dev/null +++ b/contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl @@ -0,0 +1,42 @@ + +# Copyright (c) 2022, PostgreSQL Global Development Group + +use strict; +use warnings; +use PostgreSQL::Test::Cluster; +use Test::More; + +# start a node +my $node = PostgreSQL::Test::Cluster->new('node'); +$node->init(has_archiving => 1, allows_streaming => 1); +my $archive_dir = $node->archive_dir; +$node->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "archive_command = ''"); +$node->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "archive_library = 'basic_archive'"); +$node->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "basic_archive.archive_directory = '$archive_dir'"); +$node->start; + +# backup the node +my $backup = 'backup'; +$node->backup($backup); + +# generate some new WAL files +$node->safe_psql('postgres', "CREATE TABLE test (a INT);"); +$node->safe_psql('postgres', "SELECT pg_switch_wal();"); +$node->safe_psql('postgres', "INSERT INTO test VALUES (1);"); + +# shut down the node (this should archive all WAL files) +$node->stop; + +# restore from the backup +my $restore = PostgreSQL::Test::Cluster->new('restore'); +$restore->init_from_backup($node, $backup, has_restoring => 1, standby => 0); +$restore->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "restore_command = ''"); +$restore->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "restore_library = 'basic_archive'"); +$restore->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "basic_archive.archive_directory = '$archive_dir'"); +$restore->start; + +# ensure post-backup WAL was replayed +my $result = $restore->safe_psql("postgres", "SELECT count(*) FROM test;"); +is($result, "1", "check restore content"); + +done_testing(); diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml index ef02051f7f..53e657040b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml @@ -1,34 +1,40 @@ <!-- doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml --> <chapter id="archive-modules"> - <title>Archive Modules</title> + <title>Archive and Recovery Modules</title> <indexterm zone="archive-modules"> - <primary>Archive Modules</primary> + <primary>Archive and Recovery Modules</primary> </indexterm> <para> PostgreSQL provides infrastructure to create custom modules for continuous - archiving (see <xref linkend="continuous-archiving"/>). While archiving via - a shell command (i.e., <xref linkend="guc-archive-command"/>) is much - simpler, a custom archive module will often be considerably more robust and - performant. + archiving and recovery (see <xref linkend="continuous-archiving"/>). While + a shell command (e.g., <xref linkend="guc-archive-command"/>, + <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/>) is much simpler, a custom module will + often be considerably more robust and performant. </para> <para> When a custom <xref linkend="guc-archive-library"/> is configured, PostgreSQL will submit completed WAL files to the module, and the server will avoid recycling or removing these WAL files until the module indicates that the files - were successfully archived. It is ultimately up to the module to decide what - to do with each WAL file, but many recommendations are listed at - <xref linkend="backup-archiving-wal"/>. + were successfully archived. When a custom + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> is configured, PostgreSQL will use the + module for recovery actions. It is ultimately up to the module to decide how + to accomplish each task, but some recommendations are listed at + <xref linkend="backup-archiving-wal"/> and + <xref linkend="backup-pitr-recovery"/>. </para> <para> - Archiving modules must at least consist of an initialization function (see - <xref linkend="archive-module-init"/>) and the required callbacks (see - <xref linkend="archive-module-callbacks"/>). However, archive modules are - also permitted to do much more (e.g., declare GUCs and register background - workers). + Archive and recovery modules must at least consist of an initialization + function (see <xref linkend="archive-module-init"/> and + <xref linkend="recovery-module-init"/>) and the required callbacks (see + <xref linkend="archive-module-callbacks"/> and + <xref linkend="recovery-module-callbacks"/>). However, archive and recovery + modules are also permitted to do much more (e.g., declare GUCs and register + background workers). A module may be used for both + <varname>archive_library</varname> and <varname>restore_library</varname>. </para> <para> @@ -37,7 +43,7 @@ </para> <sect1 id="archive-module-init"> - <title>Initialization Functions</title> + <title>Archive Module Initialization Functions</title> <indexterm zone="archive-module-init"> <primary>_PG_archive_module_init</primary> </indexterm> @@ -64,6 +70,12 @@ typedef void (*ArchiveModuleInit) (struct ArchiveModuleCallbacks *cb); Only the <function>archive_file_cb</function> callback is required. The others are optional. </para> + + <note> + <para> + <varname>archive_library</varname> is only loaded in the archiver process. + </para> + </note> </sect1> <sect1 id="archive-module-callbacks"> @@ -129,6 +141,132 @@ typedef bool (*ArchiveFileCB) (const char *file, const char *path); <programlisting> typedef void (*ArchiveShutdownCB) (void); +</programlisting> + </para> + </sect2> + </sect1> + + <sect1 id="recovery-module-init"> + <title>Recovery Module Initialization Functions</title> + <indexterm zone="recovery-module-init"> + <primary>_PG_recovery_module_init</primary> + </indexterm> + <para> + A recovery library is loaded by dynamically loading a shared library with the + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> as the library base name. The normal + library search path is used to locate the library. To provide the required + recovery module callbacks and to indicate that the library is actually a + recovery module, it needs to provide a function named + <function>_PG_recovery_module_init</function>. This function is passed a + struct that needs to be filled with the callback function pointers for + individual actions. + +<programlisting> +typedef struct RecoveryModuleCallbacks +{ + RecoveryRestoreCB restore_cb; + RecoveryArchiveCleanupCB archive_cleanup_cb; + RecoveryEndCB recovery_end_cb; + RecoveryShutdownCB shutdown_cb; +} RecoveryModuleCallbacks; +typedef void (*RecoveryModuleInit) (struct RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb); +</programlisting> + + The <function>restore_cb</function> callback is required for archive + recovery, but it is optional for streaming replication. The others are + always optional. + </para> + + <note> + <para> + <varname>restore_library</varname> is only loaded in the startup and + checkpointer processes and in single-user mode. + </para> + </note> + </sect1> + + <sect1 id="recovery-module-callbacks"> + <title>Recovery Module Callbacks</title> + <para> + The recovery callbacks define the actual behavior of the module. The server + will call them as required to execute recovery actions. + </para> + + <sect2 id="recovery-module-restore"> + <title>Restore Callback</title> + <para> + The <function>restore_cb</function> callback is called to retrieve a single + archived segment of the WAL file series for archive recovery or streaming + replication. + +<programlisting> +typedef bool (*RecoveryRestoreCB) (const char *file, const char *path, const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +</programlisting> + + This callback must return <literal>true</literal> only if the file was + successfully retrieved. If the file is not available in the archives, the + callback must return <literal>false</literal>. + <replaceable>file</replaceable> will contain just the file name + of the WAL file to retrieve, while <replaceable>path</replaceable> contains + the destination's relative path (including the file name). + <replaceable>lastRestartPointFileName</replaceable> will contain the name + of the file containing the last valid restart point. That is the earliest + file that must be kept to allow a restore to be restartable, so this + information can be used to truncate the archive to just the minimum + required to support restarting from the current restore. + <replaceable>lastRestartPointFileName</replaceable> is typically only used + by warm-standby configurations (see <xref linkend="warm-standby"/>). Note + that if multiple standby servers are restoring from the same archive + directory, you will need to ensure that you do not delete WAL files until + they are no longer needed by any of the servers. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="recovery-module-archive-cleanup"> + <title>Archive Cleanup Callback</title> + <para> + The <function>archive_cleanup_cb</function> callback is called at every + restart point and is intended to provide a mechanism for cleaning up old + archived WAL files that are no longer needed by the standby server. + +<programlisting> +typedef void (*RecoveryArchiveCleanupCB) (const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +</programlisting> + + <replaceable>lastRestartPointFileName</replaceable> will contain the name + of the file containing the last valid restart point, like in + <link linkend="recovery-module-restore"><function>restore_cb</function></link>. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="recovery-module-end"> + <title>Recovery End Callback</title> + <para> + The <function>recovery_end_cb</function> callback is called once at the end + of recovery and is intended to provide a mechanism for cleanup following + replication or recovery. + +<programlisting> +typedef void (*RecoveryEndCB) (const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +</programlisting> + + <replaceable>lastRestartPointFileName</replaceable> will contain the name + of the file containing the last valid restart point, like in + <link linkend="recovery-module-restore"><function>restore_cb</function></link>. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="recovery-module-shutdown"> + <title>Shutdown Callback</title> + <para> + The <function>shutdown_cb</function> callback is called when a process that + has loaded the recovery module exits (e.g., after an error) or the value of + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> changes. If no + <function>shutdown_cb</function> is defined, no special action is taken in + these situations. + +<programlisting> +typedef void (*RecoveryShutdownCB) (void); </programlisting> </para> </sect2> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml index 8bab521718..d6d34078fc 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml @@ -1181,9 +1181,27 @@ SELECT * FROM pg_backup_stop(wait_for_archive => true); <para> The key part of all this is to set up a recovery configuration that describes how you want to recover and how far the recovery should - run. The one thing that you absolutely must specify is the <varname>restore_command</varname>, - which tells <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> how to retrieve archived - WAL file segments. Like the <varname>archive_command</varname>, this is + run. The one thing that you absolutely must specify is either + <varname>restore_command</varname> or a <varname>restore_library</varname> + that defines a restore callback, which tells + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> how to retrieve archived WAL file + segments. + </para> + + <para> + Like the <varname>archive_library</varname> parameter, + <varname>restore_library</varname> is a shared library. Since such + libraries are written in <literal>C</literal>, creating your own may + require considerably more effort than writing a shell command. However, + recovery modules can be more performant than restoring via shell, and they + will have access to many useful server resources. For more information + about creating a <varname>restore_library</varname>, see + <xref linkend="archive-modules"/>. + </para> + + <para> + Like the <varname>archive_command</varname>, + <varname>restore_command</varname> is a shell command string. It can contain <literal>%f</literal>, which is replaced by the name of the desired WAL file, and <literal>%p</literal>, which is replaced by the path name to copy the WAL file to. @@ -1202,14 +1220,20 @@ restore_command = 'cp /mnt/server/archivedir/%f %p' </para> <para> - It is important that the command return nonzero exit status on failure. - The command <emphasis>will</emphasis> be called requesting files that are not - present in the archive; it must return nonzero when so asked. This is not - an error condition. An exception is that if the command was terminated by + It is important that the <varname>restore_command</varname> return nonzero + exit status on failure, or, if you are using a + <varname>restore_library</varname>, that the restore function returns + <literal>false</literal> on failure. The command or library + <emphasis>will</emphasis> be called requesting files that are not + present in the archive; it must fail when so asked. This is not + an error condition. An exception is that if the + <varname>restore_command</varname> was terminated by a signal (other than <systemitem>SIGTERM</systemitem>, which is used as part of a database server shutdown) or an error by the shell (such as command not found), then recovery will abort and the server will not start - up. + up. Likewise, if the restore function provided by the + <varname>restore_library</varname> emits an <literal>ERROR</literal> or + <literal>FATAL</literal>, recovery will abort and the server won't start. </para> <para> @@ -1233,7 +1257,8 @@ restore_command = 'cp /mnt/server/archivedir/%f %p' close as possible given the available WAL segments). Therefore, a normal recovery will end with a <quote>file not found</quote> message, the exact text of the error message depending upon your choice of - <varname>restore_command</varname>. You may also see an error message + <varname>restore_command</varname> or <varname>restore_library</varname>. + You may also see an error message at the start of recovery for a file named something like <filename>00000001.history</filename>. This is also normal and does not indicate a problem in simple recovery situations; see diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml index 0b650f17a8..ac7cd9b967 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml @@ -8,17 +8,20 @@ </indexterm> <para> - <filename>basic_archive</filename> is an example of an archive module. This - module copies completed WAL segment files to the specified directory. This - may not be especially useful, but it can serve as a starting point for - developing your own archive module. For more information about archive - modules, see <xref linkend="archive-modules"/>. + <filename>basic_archive</filename> is an example of an archive and recovery + module. This module copies completed WAL segment files to or from the + specified directory. This may not be especially useful, but it can serve as + a starting point for developing your own archive and recovery modules. For + more information about archive and recovery modules, see + see <xref linkend="archive-modules"/>. </para> <para> - In order to function, this module must be loaded via + For use as an archive module, this module must be loaded via <xref linkend="guc-archive-library"/>, and <xref linkend="guc-archive-mode"/> - must be enabled. + must be enabled. For use as a recovery module, this module must be loaded + via <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/>, and recovery must be enabled (see + <xref linkend="runtime-config-wal-archive-recovery"/>). </para> <sect2> @@ -34,11 +37,12 @@ </term> <listitem> <para> - The directory where the server should copy WAL segment files. This - directory must already exist. The default is an empty string, which - effectively halts WAL archiving, but if <xref linkend="guc-archive-mode"/> - is enabled, the server will accumulate WAL segment files in the - expectation that a value will soon be provided. + The directory where the server should copy WAL segment files to or from. + This directory must already exist. The default is an empty string, + which, when used for archiving, effectively halts WAL archival, but if + <xref linkend="guc-archive-mode"/> is enabled, the server will accumulate + WAL segment files in the expectation that a value will soon be provided. + When an empty string is used for recovery, restore will fail. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -46,7 +50,7 @@ <para> These parameters must be set in <filename>postgresql.conf</filename>. - Typical usage might be: + Typical usage as an archive module might be: </para> <programlisting> @@ -61,7 +65,8 @@ basic_archive.archive_directory = '/path/to/archive/directory' <title>Notes</title> <para> - Server crashes may leave temporary files with the prefix + When <filename>basic_archive</filename> is used as an archive module, server + crashes may leave temporary files with the prefix <filename>archtemp</filename> in the archive directory. It is recommended to delete such files before restarting the server after a crash. It is safe to remove such files while the server is running as long as they are unrelated diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml index 05b3862d09..899d2b5fdb 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml @@ -3773,7 +3773,8 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' recovery when the end of archived WAL is reached, but will keep trying to continue recovery by connecting to the sending server as specified by the <varname>primary_conninfo</varname> setting and/or by fetching new WAL - segments using <varname>restore_command</varname>. For this mode, the + segments using <varname>restore_command</varname> or + <varname>restore_library</varname>. For this mode, the parameters from this section and <xref linkend="runtime-config-replication-standby"/> are of interest. Parameters from <xref linkend="runtime-config-wal-recovery-target"/> will @@ -3801,7 +3802,8 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' <listitem> <para> The local shell command to execute to retrieve an archived segment of - the WAL file series. This parameter is required for archive recovery, + the WAL file series. Either <varname>restore_command</varname> or + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> is required for archive recovery, but optional for streaming replication. Any <literal>%f</literal> in the string is replaced by the name of the file to retrieve from the archive, @@ -3836,7 +3838,42 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows <para> This parameter can only be set in the <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> - file or on the server command line. + file or on the server command line. It is only used if + <varname>restore_library</varname> is set to an empty string. If both + <varname>restore_command</varname> and + <varname>restore_library</varname> are set, an error will be raised. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry id="guc-restore-library" xreflabel="restore_library"> + <term><varname>restore_library</varname> (<type>string</type>) + <indexterm> + <primary><varname>restore_library</varname> configuration parameter</primary> + </indexterm> + </term> + <listitem> + <para> + The library to use for recovery actions, including retrieving archived + segments of the WAL file series and executing tasks at restartpoints + and at recovery end. Either <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> or + <varname>restore_library</varname> is required for archive recovery, + but optional for streaming replication. If this parameter is set to an + empty string (the default), restoring via shell is enabled, and + <varname>restore_command</varname>, + <varname>archive_cleanup_command</varname> and + <varname>recovery_end_command</varname> are used. If both + <varname>restore_library</varname> and any of + <varname>restore_command</varname>, + <varname>archive_cleanup_command</varname> or + <varname>recovery_end_command</varname> are set, an error will be + raised. Otherwise, the specified shared library is used for recovery. + For more information, see <xref linkend="archive-modules"/>. + </para> + + <para> + This parameter can only be set in the + <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> file or on the server command line. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -3881,7 +3918,10 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows </para> <para> This parameter can only be set in the <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> - file or on the server command line. + file or on the server command line. It is only used if + <varname>restore_library</varname> is set to an empty string. If both + <varname>archive_cleanup_command</varname> and + <varname>restore_library</varname> are set, an error will be raised. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -3910,11 +3950,13 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows </para> <para> This parameter can only be set in the <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> - file or on the server command line. + file or on the server command line. It is only used if + <varname>restore_library</varname> is set to an empty string. If both + <varname>recovery_end_command</varname> and + <varname>restore_library</varname> are set, an error will be raised. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> - </variablelist> </sect2> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml index f180607528..6266e2df7f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml @@ -627,7 +627,8 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <para> In standby mode, the server continuously applies WAL received from the primary server. The standby server can read WAL from a WAL archive - (see <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/>) or directly from the primary + (see <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> and + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/>) or directly from the primary over a TCP connection (streaming replication). The standby server will also attempt to restore any WAL found in the standby cluster's <filename>pg_wal</filename> directory. That typically happens after a server @@ -638,9 +639,11 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <para> At startup, the standby begins by restoring all WAL available in the - archive location, calling <varname>restore_command</varname>. Once it - reaches the end of WAL available there and <varname>restore_command</varname> - fails, it tries to restore any WAL available in the <filename>pg_wal</filename> directory. + archive location, either by calling <varname>restore_command</varname> or + by executing the <varname>restore_library</varname>'s restore callback. + Once it reaches the end of WAL available there and + <varname>restore_command</varname> or the restore callback fails, it tries + to restore any WAL available in the <filename>pg_wal</filename> directory. If that fails, and streaming replication has been configured, the standby tries to connect to the primary server and start streaming WAL from the last valid record found in archive or <filename>pg_wal</filename>. If that fails @@ -698,7 +701,8 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. server (see <xref linkend="backup-pitr-recovery"/>). Create a file <link linkend="file-standby-signal"><filename>standby.signal</filename></link><indexterm><primary>standby.signal</primary></indexterm> in the standby's cluster data - directory. Set <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> to a simple command to copy files from + directory. Set <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> or + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> to copy files from the WAL archive. If you plan to have multiple standby servers for high availability purposes, make sure that <varname>recovery_target_timeline</varname> is set to <literal>latest</literal> (the default), to make the standby server follow the timeline change @@ -707,7 +711,8 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <note> <para> - <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> should return immediately + <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> and restore callbacks provided by + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> should return immediately if the file does not exist; the server will retry the command again if necessary. </para> @@ -731,8 +736,10 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <para> If you're using a WAL archive, its size can be minimized using the <xref - linkend="guc-archive-cleanup-command"/> parameter to remove files that are no - longer required by the standby server. + linkend="guc-archive-cleanup-command"/> parameter or the + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/>'s + <function>archive_cleanup_cb</function> callback function to remove files + that are no longer required by the standby server. The <application>pg_archivecleanup</application> utility is designed specifically to be used with <varname>archive_cleanup_command</varname> in typical single-standby configurations, see <xref linkend="pgarchivecleanup"/>. diff --git a/src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c b/src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c index 073e709e06..124a0bbdb6 100644 --- a/src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c +++ b/src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c @@ -3,7 +3,8 @@ * shell_restore.c * * These recovery functions use a user-specified shell command (e.g., the - * restore_command GUC). + * restore_command GUC). It is used as the default, but other modules may + * define their own recovery logic. * * Copyright (c) 2022, PostgreSQL Global Development Group * @@ -22,6 +23,10 @@ #include "storage/ipc.h" #include "utils/wait_event.h" +static bool shell_restore(const char *file, const char *path, + const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +static void shell_archive_cleanup(const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +static void shell_recovery_end(const char *lastRestartPointFileName); static char *BuildCleanupCommand(const char *command, const char *lastRestartPointFileName); static bool ExecuteRecoveryCommand(const char *command, @@ -29,6 +34,16 @@ static bool ExecuteRecoveryCommand(const char *command, bool exitOnSigterm, uint32 wait_event_info, int fail_elevel); +void +shell_restore_init(RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb) +{ + AssertVariableIsOfType(&shell_restore_init, RecoveryModuleInit); + + cb->restore_cb = shell_restore; + cb->archive_cleanup_cb = shell_archive_cleanup; + cb->recovery_end_cb = shell_recovery_end; +} + bool shell_restore(const char *file, const char *path, const char *lastRestartPointFileName) @@ -73,7 +88,7 @@ shell_restore(const char *file, const char *path, return ret; } -void +static void shell_archive_cleanup(const char *lastRestartPointFileName) { char *cmd = BuildCleanupCommand(archiveCleanupCommand, @@ -84,7 +99,7 @@ shell_archive_cleanup(const char *lastRestartPointFileName) pfree(cmd); } -void +static void shell_recovery_end(const char *lastRestartPointFileName) { char *cmd = BuildCleanupCommand(recoveryEndCommand, diff --git a/src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c b/src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c index fdce12614a..c4ad571327 100644 --- a/src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c +++ b/src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c @@ -4883,10 +4883,11 @@ static void CleanupAfterArchiveRecovery(TimeLineID EndOfLogTLI, XLogRecPtr EndOfLog, TimeLineID newTLI) { + /* - * Execute the recovery_end_command, if any. + * Execute the recovery-end callback, if any. */ - if (recoveryEndCommand && strcmp(recoveryEndCommand, "") != 0) + if (RecoveryContext.recovery_end_cb) { char lastRestartPointFname[MAXPGPATH]; XLogSegNo restartSegNo; @@ -4903,7 +4904,7 @@ CleanupAfterArchiveRecovery(TimeLineID EndOfLogTLI, XLogRecPtr EndOfLog, XLogFileName(lastRestartPointFname, restartTli, restartSegNo, wal_segment_size); - shell_recovery_end(lastRestartPointFname); + RecoveryContext.recovery_end_cb(lastRestartPointFname); } /* @@ -7318,9 +7319,9 @@ CreateRestartPoint(int flags) timestamptz_to_str(xtime)) : 0)); /* - * Finally, execute archive_cleanup_command, if any. + * Execute the archive-cleanup callback, if any. */ - if (archiveCleanupCommand && strcmp(archiveCleanupCommand, "") != 0) + if (RecoveryContext.archive_cleanup_cb) { char lastRestartPointFname[MAXPGPATH]; XLogSegNo restartSegNo; @@ -7337,7 +7338,7 @@ CreateRestartPoint(int flags) XLogFileName(lastRestartPointFname, restartTli, restartSegNo, wal_segment_size); - shell_archive_cleanup(lastRestartPointFname); + RecoveryContext.archive_cleanup_cb(lastRestartPointFname); } return true; diff --git a/src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c b/src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c index b5cb060d55..fdab7dad43 100644 --- a/src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c +++ b/src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c @@ -22,7 +22,9 @@ #include "access/xlog.h" #include "access/xlog_internal.h" #include "access/xlogarchive.h" +#include "access/xlogrecovery.h" #include "common/archive.h" +#include "fmgr.h" #include "miscadmin.h" #include "pgstat.h" #include "postmaster/startup.h" @@ -32,6 +34,11 @@ #include "storage/ipc.h" #include "storage/lwlock.h" +/* + * Global context for recovery-related callbacks. + */ +RecoveryModuleCallbacks RecoveryContext; + /* * Attempt to retrieve the specified file from off-line archival storage. * If successful, fill "path" with its complete path (note that this will be @@ -71,7 +78,7 @@ RestoreArchivedFile(char *path, const char *xlogfname, goto not_available; /* In standby mode, restore_command might not be supplied */ - if (recoveryRestoreCommand == NULL || strcmp(recoveryRestoreCommand, "") == 0) + if (RecoveryContext.restore_cb == NULL) goto not_available; /* @@ -149,14 +156,15 @@ RestoreArchivedFile(char *path, const char *xlogfname, XLogFileName(lastRestartPointFname, 0, 0L, wal_segment_size); /* - * Check signals before restore command and reset afterwards. + * Check signals before restore callback and reset afterwards. */ PreRestoreCommand(); /* * Copy xlog from archival storage to XLOGDIR */ - ret = shell_restore(xlogfname, xlogpath, lastRestartPointFname); + ret = RecoveryContext.restore_cb(xlogfname, xlogpath, + lastRestartPointFname); PostRestoreCommand(); @@ -603,3 +611,59 @@ XLogArchiveCleanup(const char *xlog) unlink(archiveStatusPath); /* should we complain about failure? */ } + +/* + * Loads all the recovery callbacks into our global RecoveryContext. The + * caller is responsible for validating the combination of library/command + * parameters that are set (e.g., restore_command and restore_library cannot + * both be set). + */ +void +LoadRecoveryCallbacks(void) +{ + RecoveryModuleInit init; + + /* + * If the shell command is enabled, use our special initialization + * function. Otherwise, load the library and call its + * _PG_recovery_module_init(). + */ + if (restoreLibrary[0] == '\0') + init = shell_restore_init; + else + init = (RecoveryModuleInit) + load_external_function(restoreLibrary, "_PG_recovery_module_init", + false, NULL); + + if (init == NULL) + ereport(ERROR, + (errmsg("recovery modules have to define the symbol " + "_PG_recovery_module_init"))); + + memset(&RecoveryContext, 0, sizeof(RecoveryModuleCallbacks)); + (*init) (&RecoveryContext); + + /* + * If using shell commands, remove callbacks for any commands that are not + * set. + */ + if (restoreLibrary[0] == '\0') + { + if (recoveryRestoreCommand[0] == '\0') + RecoveryContext.restore_cb = NULL; + if (archiveCleanupCommand[0] == '\0') + RecoveryContext.archive_cleanup_cb = NULL; + if (recoveryEndCommand[0] == '\0') + RecoveryContext.recovery_end_cb = NULL; + } +} + +/* + * Call the shutdown callback of the loaded recovery module, if defined. + */ +void +call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb(int code, Datum arg) +{ + if (RecoveryContext.shutdown_cb) + RecoveryContext.shutdown_cb(); +} diff --git a/src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c b/src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c index bc3c3eb3e7..95bcc3a0b7 100644 --- a/src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c +++ b/src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c @@ -80,6 +80,7 @@ const struct config_enum_entry recovery_target_action_options[] = { /* options formerly taken from recovery.conf for archive recovery */ char *recoveryRestoreCommand = NULL; +char *restoreLibrary = NULL; char *recoveryEndCommand = NULL; char *archiveCleanupCommand = NULL; RecoveryTargetType recoveryTarget = RECOVERY_TARGET_UNSET; @@ -1053,24 +1054,37 @@ validateRecoveryParameters(void) if (!ArchiveRecoveryRequested) return; + /* + * Check for invalid combinations of the command/library parameters and + * load the callbacks. + */ + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + recoveryRestoreCommand, "restore_command"); + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + recoveryEndCommand, "recovery_end_command"); + before_shmem_exit(call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb, 0); + LoadRecoveryCallbacks(); + /* * Check for compulsory parameters */ if (StandbyModeRequested) { if ((PrimaryConnInfo == NULL || strcmp(PrimaryConnInfo, "") == 0) && - (recoveryRestoreCommand == NULL || strcmp(recoveryRestoreCommand, "") == 0)) + RecoveryContext.restore_cb == NULL) ereport(WARNING, - (errmsg("specified neither primary_conninfo nor restore_command"), - errhint("The database server will regularly poll the pg_wal subdirectory to check for files placed there."))); + (errmsg("specified neither primary_conninfo nor restore_command " + "nor a restore_library that defines a restore callback"), + errhint("The database server will regularly poll the pg_wal " + "subdirectory to check for files placed there."))); } else { - if (recoveryRestoreCommand == NULL || - strcmp(recoveryRestoreCommand, "") == 0) + if (RecoveryContext.restore_cb == NULL) ereport(FATAL, (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), - errmsg("must specify restore_command when standby mode is not enabled"))); + errmsg("must specify restore_command or a restore_library that defines " + "a restore callback when standby mode is not enabled"))); } /* diff --git a/src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c b/src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c index de0bbbfa79..6350fd0b83 100644 --- a/src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c +++ b/src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c @@ -38,6 +38,7 @@ #include "access/xlog.h" #include "access/xlog_internal.h" +#include "access/xlogarchive.h" #include "access/xlogrecovery.h" #include "libpq/pqsignal.h" #include "miscadmin.h" @@ -222,6 +223,16 @@ CheckpointerMain(void) */ before_shmem_exit(pgstat_before_server_shutdown, 0); + /* + * Check for invalid combinations of the command/library parameters and + * load the callbacks. We do this before setting up the exception handler + * so that any problems result in a server crash shortly after startup. + */ + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + archiveCleanupCommand, "archive_cleanup_command"); + before_shmem_exit(call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb, 0); + LoadRecoveryCallbacks(); + /* * Create a memory context that we will do all our work in. We do this so * that we can reset the context during error recovery and thereby avoid @@ -548,6 +559,9 @@ HandleCheckpointerInterrupts(void) if (ConfigReloadPending) { + char *prevRestoreLibrary = pstrdup(restoreLibrary); + char *prevArchiveCleanupCommand = pstrdup(archiveCleanupCommand); + ConfigReloadPending = false; ProcessConfigFile(PGC_SIGHUP); @@ -563,6 +577,18 @@ HandleCheckpointerInterrupts(void) * because of SIGHUP. */ UpdateSharedMemoryConfig(); + + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + archiveCleanupCommand, "archive_cleanup_command"); + if (strcmp(prevRestoreLibrary, restoreLibrary) != 0 || + strcmp(prevArchiveCleanupCommand, archiveCleanupCommand) != 0) + { + call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb(0, (Datum) 0); + LoadRecoveryCallbacks(); + } + + pfree(prevRestoreLibrary); + pfree(prevArchiveCleanupCommand); } if (ShutdownRequestPending) { diff --git a/src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c b/src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c index 8ecdb9ca23..8e91f2d70f 100644 --- a/src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c +++ b/src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c @@ -831,11 +831,8 @@ LoadArchiveLibrary(void) { ArchiveModuleInit archive_init; - if (XLogArchiveLibrary[0] != '\0' && XLogArchiveCommand[0] != '\0') - ereport(ERROR, - (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), - errmsg("both archive_command and archive_library set"), - errdetail("Only one of archive_command, archive_library may be set."))); + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(XLogArchiveLibrary, "archive_library", + XLogArchiveCommand, "archive_command"); memset(&ArchiveContext, 0, sizeof(ArchiveModuleCallbacks)); diff --git a/src/backend/postmaster/startup.c b/src/backend/postmaster/startup.c index 8786186898..f9ff2b5583 100644 --- a/src/backend/postmaster/startup.c +++ b/src/backend/postmaster/startup.c @@ -20,6 +20,7 @@ #include "postgres.h" #include "access/xlog.h" +#include "access/xlogarchive.h" #include "access/xlogrecovery.h" #include "access/xlogutils.h" #include "libpq/pqsignal.h" @@ -133,13 +134,17 @@ StartupProcShutdownHandler(SIGNAL_ARGS) * Re-read the config file. * * If one of the critical walreceiver options has changed, flag xlog.c - * to restart it. + * to restart it. Also, check for invalid combinations of the command/library + * parameters and reload the recovery callbacks if necessary. */ static void StartupRereadConfig(void) { char *conninfo = pstrdup(PrimaryConnInfo); char *slotname = pstrdup(PrimarySlotName); + char *prevRestoreLibrary = pstrdup(restoreLibrary); + char *prevRestoreCommand = pstrdup(recoveryRestoreCommand); + char *prevRecoveryEndCommand = pstrdup(recoveryEndCommand); bool tempSlot = wal_receiver_create_temp_slot; bool conninfoChanged; bool slotnameChanged; @@ -161,6 +166,22 @@ StartupRereadConfig(void) if (conninfoChanged || slotnameChanged || tempSlotChanged) StartupRequestWalReceiverRestart(); + + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + recoveryRestoreCommand, "restore_command"); + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + recoveryEndCommand, "recovery_end_command"); + if (strcmp(prevRestoreLibrary, restoreLibrary) != 0 || + strcmp(prevRestoreCommand, recoveryRestoreCommand) != 0 || + strcmp(prevRecoveryEndCommand, recoveryEndCommand) != 0) + { + call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb(0, (Datum) 0); + LoadRecoveryCallbacks(); + } + + pfree(prevRestoreLibrary); + pfree(prevRestoreCommand); + pfree(prevRecoveryEndCommand); } /* Handle various signals that might be sent to the startup process */ diff --git a/src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c b/src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c index d52069f446..7858e9a649 100644 --- a/src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c +++ b/src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c @@ -6880,3 +6880,17 @@ call_enum_check_hook(struct config_enum *conf, int *newval, void **extra, return true; } + +/* + * ERROR if both parameters are set. + */ +void +CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(const char *p1val, const char *p1name, + const char *p2val, const char *p2name) +{ + if (p1val[0] != '\0' && p2val[0] != '\0') + ereport(ERROR, + (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), + errmsg("both %s and %s set", p1name, p2name), + errdetail("Only one of %s, %s may be set.", p1name, p2name))); +} diff --git a/src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c b/src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c index 68328b1402..19746e2489 100644 --- a/src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c +++ b/src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c @@ -3764,6 +3764,16 @@ struct config_string ConfigureNamesString[] = NULL, NULL, NULL }, + { + {"restore_library", PGC_SIGHUP, WAL_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY, + gettext_noop("Sets the library that will be called for recovery actions."), + NULL + }, + &restoreLibrary, + "", + NULL, NULL, NULL + }, + { {"archive_cleanup_command", PGC_SIGHUP, WAL_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY, gettext_noop("Sets the shell command that will be executed at every restart point."), diff --git a/src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample b/src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample index 5afdeb04de..e71e79271a 100644 --- a/src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample +++ b/src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample @@ -269,6 +269,7 @@ # placeholders: %p = path of file to restore # %f = file name only # e.g. 'cp /mnt/server/archivedir/%f %p' +#restore_library = '' # library to use for recovery actions #archive_cleanup_command = '' # command to execute at every restartpoint #recovery_end_command = '' # command to execute at completion of recovery diff --git a/src/include/access/xlog_internal.h b/src/include/access/xlog_internal.h index 59fc7bc105..756f0898b5 100644 --- a/src/include/access/xlog_internal.h +++ b/src/include/access/xlog_internal.h @@ -400,5 +400,6 @@ extern PGDLLIMPORT bool ArchiveRecoveryRequested; extern PGDLLIMPORT bool InArchiveRecovery; extern PGDLLIMPORT bool StandbyMode; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *recoveryRestoreCommand; +extern PGDLLIMPORT char *restoreLibrary; #endif /* XLOG_INTERNAL_H */ diff --git a/src/include/access/xlogarchive.h b/src/include/access/xlogarchive.h index 299304703e..71c9b88165 100644 --- a/src/include/access/xlogarchive.h +++ b/src/include/access/xlogarchive.h @@ -30,9 +30,45 @@ extern bool XLogArchiveIsReady(const char *xlog); extern bool XLogArchiveIsReadyOrDone(const char *xlog); extern void XLogArchiveCleanup(const char *xlog); -extern bool shell_restore(const char *file, const char *path, - const char *lastRestartPointFileName); -extern void shell_archive_cleanup(const char *lastRestartPointFileName); -extern void shell_recovery_end(const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +/* + * Recovery module callbacks + * + * These callback functions should be defined by recovery libraries and + * returned via _PG_recovery_module_init(). For more information about the + * purpose of each callback, refer to the recovery modules documentation. + */ +typedef bool (*RecoveryRestoreCB) (const char *file, const char *path, + const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +typedef void (*RecoveryArchiveCleanupCB) (const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +typedef void (*RecoveryEndCB) (const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +typedef void (*RecoveryShutdownCB) (void); + +typedef struct RecoveryModuleCallbacks +{ + RecoveryRestoreCB restore_cb; + RecoveryArchiveCleanupCB archive_cleanup_cb; + RecoveryEndCB recovery_end_cb; + RecoveryShutdownCB shutdown_cb; +} RecoveryModuleCallbacks; + +extern RecoveryModuleCallbacks RecoveryContext; + +/* + * Type of the shared library symbol _PG_recovery_module_init that is looked up + * when loading a recovery library. + */ +typedef void (*RecoveryModuleInit) (RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb); + +extern PGDLLEXPORT void _PG_recovery_module_init(RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb); + +extern void LoadRecoveryCallbacks(void); +extern void call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb(int code, Datum arg); + +/* + * Since the logic for recovery via a shell command is in the core server and + * does not need to be loaded via a shared library, it has a special + * initialization function. + */ +extern void shell_restore_init(RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb); #endif /* XLOG_ARCHIVE_H */ diff --git a/src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h b/src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h index 47c29350f5..35d1d09374 100644 --- a/src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h +++ b/src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h @@ -55,6 +55,7 @@ extern PGDLLIMPORT int recovery_min_apply_delay; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *PrimaryConnInfo; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *PrimarySlotName; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *recoveryRestoreCommand; +extern PGDLLIMPORT char *restoreLibrary; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *recoveryEndCommand; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *archiveCleanupCommand; diff --git a/src/include/utils/guc.h b/src/include/utils/guc.h index ba89d013e6..947597247f 100644 --- a/src/include/utils/guc.h +++ b/src/include/utils/guc.h @@ -404,6 +404,8 @@ extern void *guc_malloc(int elevel, size_t size); extern pg_nodiscard void *guc_realloc(int elevel, void *old, size_t size); extern char *guc_strdup(int elevel, const char *src); extern void guc_free(void *ptr); +extern void CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(const char *p1val, const char *p1name, + const char *p2val, const char *p2name); #ifdef EXEC_BACKEND extern void write_nondefault_variables(GucContext context); -- 2.25.1 --KsGdsel6WgEHnImy-- ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 17+ messages in thread
* [PATCH v4 3/3] Allow recovery via loadable modules. @ 2022-12-10 03:40 Nathan Bossart <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 17+ messages in thread From: Nathan Bossart @ 2022-12-10 03:40 UTC (permalink / raw) This adds the restore_library parameter to allow archive recovery via a loadable module, rather than running shell commands. --- contrib/basic_archive/Makefile | 4 +- contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c | 67 ++++++- contrib/basic_archive/meson.build | 7 +- contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl | 44 +++++ doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml | 168 ++++++++++++++++-- doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml | 43 ++++- doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml | 33 ++-- doc/src/sgml/config.sgml | 54 +++++- doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml | 23 ++- src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c | 21 ++- src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c | 13 +- src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c | 70 +++++++- src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c | 26 ++- src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c | 26 +++ src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c | 7 +- src/backend/postmaster/startup.c | 23 ++- src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c | 14 ++ src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c | 10 ++ src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample | 1 + src/include/access/xlog_internal.h | 1 + src/include/access/xlogarchive.h | 44 ++++- src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h | 1 + src/include/utils/guc.h | 2 + 23 files changed, 618 insertions(+), 84 deletions(-) create mode 100644 contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl diff --git a/contrib/basic_archive/Makefile b/contrib/basic_archive/Makefile index 55d299d650..487dc563f3 100644 --- a/contrib/basic_archive/Makefile +++ b/contrib/basic_archive/Makefile @@ -1,7 +1,7 @@ # contrib/basic_archive/Makefile MODULES = basic_archive -PGFILEDESC = "basic_archive - basic archive module" +PGFILEDESC = "basic_archive - basic archive and recovery module" REGRESS = basic_archive REGRESS_OPTS = --temp-config $(top_srcdir)/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.conf @@ -9,6 +9,8 @@ REGRESS_OPTS = --temp-config $(top_srcdir)/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c # which typical installcheck users do not have (e.g. buildfarm clients). NO_INSTALLCHECK = 1 +TAP_TESTS = 1 + ifdef USE_PGXS PG_CONFIG = pg_config PGXS := $(shell $(PG_CONFIG) --pgxs) diff --git a/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c b/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c index 28cbb6cce0..8c333c8f99 100644 --- a/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c +++ b/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c @@ -17,6 +17,11 @@ * a file is successfully archived and then the system crashes before * a durable record of the success has been made. * + * This file also demonstrates a basic restore library implementation that + * is roughly equivalent to the following shell command: + * + * cp /path/to/archivedir/%f %p + * * Copyright (c) 2022-2023, PostgreSQL Global Development Group * * IDENTIFICATION @@ -30,6 +35,7 @@ #include <sys/time.h> #include <unistd.h> +#include "access/xlogarchive.h" #include "common/int.h" #include "miscadmin.h" #include "postmaster/pgarch.h" @@ -48,6 +54,8 @@ static bool basic_archive_file(const char *file, const char *path); static void basic_archive_file_internal(const char *file, const char *path); static bool check_archive_directory(char **newval, void **extra, GucSource source); static bool compare_files(const char *file1, const char *file2); +static bool basic_restore_file(const char *file, const char *path, + const char *lastRestartPointFileName); /* * _PG_init @@ -87,6 +95,19 @@ _PG_archive_module_init(ArchiveModuleCallbacks *cb) cb->archive_file_cb = basic_archive_file; } +/* + * _PG_recovery_module_init + * + * Returns the module's restore callback. + */ +void +_PG_recovery_module_init(RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb) +{ + AssertVariableIsOfType(&_PG_recovery_module_init, RecoveryModuleInit); + + cb->restore_cb = basic_restore_file; +} + /* * check_archive_directory * @@ -99,8 +120,8 @@ check_archive_directory(char **newval, void **extra, GucSource source) /* * The default value is an empty string, so we have to accept that value. - * Our check_configured callback also checks for this and prevents - * archiving from proceeding if it is still empty. + * Our check_configured and restore callbacks also check for this and + * prevent archiving or recovery from proceeding if it is still empty. */ if (*newval == NULL || *newval[0] == '\0') return true; @@ -368,3 +389,45 @@ compare_files(const char *file1, const char *file2) return ret; } + +/* + * basic_restore_file + * + * Retrieves one file from the WAL archives. + */ +static bool +basic_restore_file(const char *file, const char *path, + const char *lastRestartPointFileName) +{ + char source[MAXPGPATH]; + struct stat st; + + ereport(DEBUG1, + (errmsg("restoring \"%s\" via basic_archive", file))); + + if (archive_directory == NULL || archive_directory[0] == '\0') + ereport(ERROR, + (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), + errmsg("\"basic_archive.archive_directory\" is not set"))); + + /* + * Check whether the file exists. If not, we return false to indicate that + * there are no more files to restore. + */ + snprintf(source, MAXPGPATH, "%s/%s", archive_directory, file); + if (stat(source, &st) != 0) + { + int elevel = (errno == ENOENT) ? DEBUG1 : ERROR; + + ereport(elevel, + (errcode_for_file_access(), + errmsg("could not stat file \"%s\": %m", source))); + return false; + } + + copy_file(source, unconstify(char *, path)); + + ereport(DEBUG1, + (errmsg("restored \"%s\" via basic_archive", file))); + return true; +} diff --git a/contrib/basic_archive/meson.build b/contrib/basic_archive/meson.build index bc1380e6f6..af4580dea9 100644 --- a/contrib/basic_archive/meson.build +++ b/contrib/basic_archive/meson.build @@ -7,7 +7,7 @@ basic_archive_sources = files( if host_system == 'windows' basic_archive_sources += rc_lib_gen.process(win32ver_rc, extra_args: [ '--NAME', 'basic_archive', - '--FILEDESC', 'basic_archive - basic archive module',]) + '--FILEDESC', 'basic_archive - basic archive and recovery module',]) endif basic_archive = shared_module('basic_archive', @@ -31,4 +31,9 @@ tests += { # which typical runningcheck users do not have (e.g. buildfarm clients). 'runningcheck': false, }, + 'tap': { + 'tests': [ + 't/001_restore.pl', + ], + }, } diff --git a/contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl b/contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ec8767d740 --- /dev/null +++ b/contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl @@ -0,0 +1,44 @@ + +# Copyright (c) 2022, PostgreSQL Global Development Group + +use strict; +use warnings; +use PostgreSQL::Test::Cluster; +use PostgreSQL::Test::Utils; +use Test::More; + +# start a node +my $node = PostgreSQL::Test::Cluster->new('node'); +$node->init(has_archiving => 1, allows_streaming => 1); +my $archive_dir = $node->archive_dir; +$archive_dir =~ s!\\!/!g if $PostgreSQL::Test::Utils::windows_os; +$node->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "archive_command = ''"); +$node->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "archive_library = 'basic_archive'"); +$node->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "basic_archive.archive_directory = '$archive_dir'"); +$node->start; + +# backup the node +my $backup = 'backup'; +$node->backup($backup); + +# generate some new WAL files +$node->safe_psql('postgres', "CREATE TABLE test (a INT);"); +$node->safe_psql('postgres', "SELECT pg_switch_wal();"); +$node->safe_psql('postgres', "INSERT INTO test VALUES (1);"); + +# shut down the node (this should archive all WAL files) +$node->stop; + +# restore from the backup +my $restore = PostgreSQL::Test::Cluster->new('restore'); +$restore->init_from_backup($node, $backup, has_restoring => 1, standby => 0); +$restore->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "restore_command = ''"); +$restore->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "restore_library = 'basic_archive'"); +$restore->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "basic_archive.archive_directory = '$archive_dir'"); +$restore->start; + +# ensure post-backup WAL was replayed +my $result = $restore->safe_psql("postgres", "SELECT count(*) FROM test;"); +is($result, "1", "check restore content"); + +done_testing(); diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml index ef02051f7f..53e657040b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml @@ -1,34 +1,40 @@ <!-- doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml --> <chapter id="archive-modules"> - <title>Archive Modules</title> + <title>Archive and Recovery Modules</title> <indexterm zone="archive-modules"> - <primary>Archive Modules</primary> + <primary>Archive and Recovery Modules</primary> </indexterm> <para> PostgreSQL provides infrastructure to create custom modules for continuous - archiving (see <xref linkend="continuous-archiving"/>). While archiving via - a shell command (i.e., <xref linkend="guc-archive-command"/>) is much - simpler, a custom archive module will often be considerably more robust and - performant. + archiving and recovery (see <xref linkend="continuous-archiving"/>). While + a shell command (e.g., <xref linkend="guc-archive-command"/>, + <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/>) is much simpler, a custom module will + often be considerably more robust and performant. </para> <para> When a custom <xref linkend="guc-archive-library"/> is configured, PostgreSQL will submit completed WAL files to the module, and the server will avoid recycling or removing these WAL files until the module indicates that the files - were successfully archived. It is ultimately up to the module to decide what - to do with each WAL file, but many recommendations are listed at - <xref linkend="backup-archiving-wal"/>. + were successfully archived. When a custom + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> is configured, PostgreSQL will use the + module for recovery actions. It is ultimately up to the module to decide how + to accomplish each task, but some recommendations are listed at + <xref linkend="backup-archiving-wal"/> and + <xref linkend="backup-pitr-recovery"/>. </para> <para> - Archiving modules must at least consist of an initialization function (see - <xref linkend="archive-module-init"/>) and the required callbacks (see - <xref linkend="archive-module-callbacks"/>). However, archive modules are - also permitted to do much more (e.g., declare GUCs and register background - workers). + Archive and recovery modules must at least consist of an initialization + function (see <xref linkend="archive-module-init"/> and + <xref linkend="recovery-module-init"/>) and the required callbacks (see + <xref linkend="archive-module-callbacks"/> and + <xref linkend="recovery-module-callbacks"/>). However, archive and recovery + modules are also permitted to do much more (e.g., declare GUCs and register + background workers). A module may be used for both + <varname>archive_library</varname> and <varname>restore_library</varname>. </para> <para> @@ -37,7 +43,7 @@ </para> <sect1 id="archive-module-init"> - <title>Initialization Functions</title> + <title>Archive Module Initialization Functions</title> <indexterm zone="archive-module-init"> <primary>_PG_archive_module_init</primary> </indexterm> @@ -64,6 +70,12 @@ typedef void (*ArchiveModuleInit) (struct ArchiveModuleCallbacks *cb); Only the <function>archive_file_cb</function> callback is required. The others are optional. </para> + + <note> + <para> + <varname>archive_library</varname> is only loaded in the archiver process. + </para> + </note> </sect1> <sect1 id="archive-module-callbacks"> @@ -129,6 +141,132 @@ typedef bool (*ArchiveFileCB) (const char *file, const char *path); <programlisting> typedef void (*ArchiveShutdownCB) (void); +</programlisting> + </para> + </sect2> + </sect1> + + <sect1 id="recovery-module-init"> + <title>Recovery Module Initialization Functions</title> + <indexterm zone="recovery-module-init"> + <primary>_PG_recovery_module_init</primary> + </indexterm> + <para> + A recovery library is loaded by dynamically loading a shared library with the + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> as the library base name. The normal + library search path is used to locate the library. To provide the required + recovery module callbacks and to indicate that the library is actually a + recovery module, it needs to provide a function named + <function>_PG_recovery_module_init</function>. This function is passed a + struct that needs to be filled with the callback function pointers for + individual actions. + +<programlisting> +typedef struct RecoveryModuleCallbacks +{ + RecoveryRestoreCB restore_cb; + RecoveryArchiveCleanupCB archive_cleanup_cb; + RecoveryEndCB recovery_end_cb; + RecoveryShutdownCB shutdown_cb; +} RecoveryModuleCallbacks; +typedef void (*RecoveryModuleInit) (struct RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb); +</programlisting> + + The <function>restore_cb</function> callback is required for archive + recovery, but it is optional for streaming replication. The others are + always optional. + </para> + + <note> + <para> + <varname>restore_library</varname> is only loaded in the startup and + checkpointer processes and in single-user mode. + </para> + </note> + </sect1> + + <sect1 id="recovery-module-callbacks"> + <title>Recovery Module Callbacks</title> + <para> + The recovery callbacks define the actual behavior of the module. The server + will call them as required to execute recovery actions. + </para> + + <sect2 id="recovery-module-restore"> + <title>Restore Callback</title> + <para> + The <function>restore_cb</function> callback is called to retrieve a single + archived segment of the WAL file series for archive recovery or streaming + replication. + +<programlisting> +typedef bool (*RecoveryRestoreCB) (const char *file, const char *path, const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +</programlisting> + + This callback must return <literal>true</literal> only if the file was + successfully retrieved. If the file is not available in the archives, the + callback must return <literal>false</literal>. + <replaceable>file</replaceable> will contain just the file name + of the WAL file to retrieve, while <replaceable>path</replaceable> contains + the destination's relative path (including the file name). + <replaceable>lastRestartPointFileName</replaceable> will contain the name + of the file containing the last valid restart point. That is the earliest + file that must be kept to allow a restore to be restartable, so this + information can be used to truncate the archive to just the minimum + required to support restarting from the current restore. + <replaceable>lastRestartPointFileName</replaceable> is typically only used + by warm-standby configurations (see <xref linkend="warm-standby"/>). Note + that if multiple standby servers are restoring from the same archive + directory, you will need to ensure that you do not delete WAL files until + they are no longer needed by any of the servers. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="recovery-module-archive-cleanup"> + <title>Archive Cleanup Callback</title> + <para> + The <function>archive_cleanup_cb</function> callback is called at every + restart point and is intended to provide a mechanism for cleaning up old + archived WAL files that are no longer needed by the standby server. + +<programlisting> +typedef void (*RecoveryArchiveCleanupCB) (const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +</programlisting> + + <replaceable>lastRestartPointFileName</replaceable> will contain the name + of the file containing the last valid restart point, like in + <link linkend="recovery-module-restore"><function>restore_cb</function></link>. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="recovery-module-end"> + <title>Recovery End Callback</title> + <para> + The <function>recovery_end_cb</function> callback is called once at the end + of recovery and is intended to provide a mechanism for cleanup following + replication or recovery. + +<programlisting> +typedef void (*RecoveryEndCB) (const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +</programlisting> + + <replaceable>lastRestartPointFileName</replaceable> will contain the name + of the file containing the last valid restart point, like in + <link linkend="recovery-module-restore"><function>restore_cb</function></link>. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="recovery-module-shutdown"> + <title>Shutdown Callback</title> + <para> + The <function>shutdown_cb</function> callback is called when a process that + has loaded the recovery module exits (e.g., after an error) or the value of + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> changes. If no + <function>shutdown_cb</function> is defined, no special action is taken in + these situations. + +<programlisting> +typedef void (*RecoveryShutdownCB) (void); </programlisting> </para> </sect2> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml index 8bab521718..d6d34078fc 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml @@ -1181,9 +1181,27 @@ SELECT * FROM pg_backup_stop(wait_for_archive => true); <para> The key part of all this is to set up a recovery configuration that describes how you want to recover and how far the recovery should - run. The one thing that you absolutely must specify is the <varname>restore_command</varname>, - which tells <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> how to retrieve archived - WAL file segments. Like the <varname>archive_command</varname>, this is + run. The one thing that you absolutely must specify is either + <varname>restore_command</varname> or a <varname>restore_library</varname> + that defines a restore callback, which tells + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> how to retrieve archived WAL file + segments. + </para> + + <para> + Like the <varname>archive_library</varname> parameter, + <varname>restore_library</varname> is a shared library. Since such + libraries are written in <literal>C</literal>, creating your own may + require considerably more effort than writing a shell command. However, + recovery modules can be more performant than restoring via shell, and they + will have access to many useful server resources. For more information + about creating a <varname>restore_library</varname>, see + <xref linkend="archive-modules"/>. + </para> + + <para> + Like the <varname>archive_command</varname>, + <varname>restore_command</varname> is a shell command string. It can contain <literal>%f</literal>, which is replaced by the name of the desired WAL file, and <literal>%p</literal>, which is replaced by the path name to copy the WAL file to. @@ -1202,14 +1220,20 @@ restore_command = 'cp /mnt/server/archivedir/%f %p' </para> <para> - It is important that the command return nonzero exit status on failure. - The command <emphasis>will</emphasis> be called requesting files that are not - present in the archive; it must return nonzero when so asked. This is not - an error condition. An exception is that if the command was terminated by + It is important that the <varname>restore_command</varname> return nonzero + exit status on failure, or, if you are using a + <varname>restore_library</varname>, that the restore function returns + <literal>false</literal> on failure. The command or library + <emphasis>will</emphasis> be called requesting files that are not + present in the archive; it must fail when so asked. This is not + an error condition. An exception is that if the + <varname>restore_command</varname> was terminated by a signal (other than <systemitem>SIGTERM</systemitem>, which is used as part of a database server shutdown) or an error by the shell (such as command not found), then recovery will abort and the server will not start - up. + up. Likewise, if the restore function provided by the + <varname>restore_library</varname> emits an <literal>ERROR</literal> or + <literal>FATAL</literal>, recovery will abort and the server won't start. </para> <para> @@ -1233,7 +1257,8 @@ restore_command = 'cp /mnt/server/archivedir/%f %p' close as possible given the available WAL segments). Therefore, a normal recovery will end with a <quote>file not found</quote> message, the exact text of the error message depending upon your choice of - <varname>restore_command</varname>. You may also see an error message + <varname>restore_command</varname> or <varname>restore_library</varname>. + You may also see an error message at the start of recovery for a file named something like <filename>00000001.history</filename>. This is also normal and does not indicate a problem in simple recovery situations; see diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml index 0b650f17a8..ac7cd9b967 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml @@ -8,17 +8,20 @@ </indexterm> <para> - <filename>basic_archive</filename> is an example of an archive module. This - module copies completed WAL segment files to the specified directory. This - may not be especially useful, but it can serve as a starting point for - developing your own archive module. For more information about archive - modules, see <xref linkend="archive-modules"/>. + <filename>basic_archive</filename> is an example of an archive and recovery + module. This module copies completed WAL segment files to or from the + specified directory. This may not be especially useful, but it can serve as + a starting point for developing your own archive and recovery modules. For + more information about archive and recovery modules, see + see <xref linkend="archive-modules"/>. </para> <para> - In order to function, this module must be loaded via + For use as an archive module, this module must be loaded via <xref linkend="guc-archive-library"/>, and <xref linkend="guc-archive-mode"/> - must be enabled. + must be enabled. For use as a recovery module, this module must be loaded + via <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/>, and recovery must be enabled (see + <xref linkend="runtime-config-wal-archive-recovery"/>). </para> <sect2> @@ -34,11 +37,12 @@ </term> <listitem> <para> - The directory where the server should copy WAL segment files. This - directory must already exist. The default is an empty string, which - effectively halts WAL archiving, but if <xref linkend="guc-archive-mode"/> - is enabled, the server will accumulate WAL segment files in the - expectation that a value will soon be provided. + The directory where the server should copy WAL segment files to or from. + This directory must already exist. The default is an empty string, + which, when used for archiving, effectively halts WAL archival, but if + <xref linkend="guc-archive-mode"/> is enabled, the server will accumulate + WAL segment files in the expectation that a value will soon be provided. + When an empty string is used for recovery, restore will fail. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -46,7 +50,7 @@ <para> These parameters must be set in <filename>postgresql.conf</filename>. - Typical usage might be: + Typical usage as an archive module might be: </para> <programlisting> @@ -61,7 +65,8 @@ basic_archive.archive_directory = '/path/to/archive/directory' <title>Notes</title> <para> - Server crashes may leave temporary files with the prefix + When <filename>basic_archive</filename> is used as an archive module, server + crashes may leave temporary files with the prefix <filename>archtemp</filename> in the archive directory. It is recommended to delete such files before restarting the server after a crash. It is safe to remove such files while the server is running as long as they are unrelated diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml index 05b3862d09..899d2b5fdb 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml @@ -3773,7 +3773,8 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' recovery when the end of archived WAL is reached, but will keep trying to continue recovery by connecting to the sending server as specified by the <varname>primary_conninfo</varname> setting and/or by fetching new WAL - segments using <varname>restore_command</varname>. For this mode, the + segments using <varname>restore_command</varname> or + <varname>restore_library</varname>. For this mode, the parameters from this section and <xref linkend="runtime-config-replication-standby"/> are of interest. Parameters from <xref linkend="runtime-config-wal-recovery-target"/> will @@ -3801,7 +3802,8 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' <listitem> <para> The local shell command to execute to retrieve an archived segment of - the WAL file series. This parameter is required for archive recovery, + the WAL file series. Either <varname>restore_command</varname> or + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> is required for archive recovery, but optional for streaming replication. Any <literal>%f</literal> in the string is replaced by the name of the file to retrieve from the archive, @@ -3836,7 +3838,42 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows <para> This parameter can only be set in the <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> - file or on the server command line. + file or on the server command line. It is only used if + <varname>restore_library</varname> is set to an empty string. If both + <varname>restore_command</varname> and + <varname>restore_library</varname> are set, an error will be raised. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry id="guc-restore-library" xreflabel="restore_library"> + <term><varname>restore_library</varname> (<type>string</type>) + <indexterm> + <primary><varname>restore_library</varname> configuration parameter</primary> + </indexterm> + </term> + <listitem> + <para> + The library to use for recovery actions, including retrieving archived + segments of the WAL file series and executing tasks at restartpoints + and at recovery end. Either <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> or + <varname>restore_library</varname> is required for archive recovery, + but optional for streaming replication. If this parameter is set to an + empty string (the default), restoring via shell is enabled, and + <varname>restore_command</varname>, + <varname>archive_cleanup_command</varname> and + <varname>recovery_end_command</varname> are used. If both + <varname>restore_library</varname> and any of + <varname>restore_command</varname>, + <varname>archive_cleanup_command</varname> or + <varname>recovery_end_command</varname> are set, an error will be + raised. Otherwise, the specified shared library is used for recovery. + For more information, see <xref linkend="archive-modules"/>. + </para> + + <para> + This parameter can only be set in the + <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> file or on the server command line. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -3881,7 +3918,10 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows </para> <para> This parameter can only be set in the <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> - file or on the server command line. + file or on the server command line. It is only used if + <varname>restore_library</varname> is set to an empty string. If both + <varname>archive_cleanup_command</varname> and + <varname>restore_library</varname> are set, an error will be raised. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -3910,11 +3950,13 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows </para> <para> This parameter can only be set in the <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> - file or on the server command line. + file or on the server command line. It is only used if + <varname>restore_library</varname> is set to an empty string. If both + <varname>recovery_end_command</varname> and + <varname>restore_library</varname> are set, an error will be raised. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> - </variablelist> </sect2> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml index f180607528..6266e2df7f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml @@ -627,7 +627,8 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <para> In standby mode, the server continuously applies WAL received from the primary server. The standby server can read WAL from a WAL archive - (see <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/>) or directly from the primary + (see <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> and + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/>) or directly from the primary over a TCP connection (streaming replication). The standby server will also attempt to restore any WAL found in the standby cluster's <filename>pg_wal</filename> directory. That typically happens after a server @@ -638,9 +639,11 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <para> At startup, the standby begins by restoring all WAL available in the - archive location, calling <varname>restore_command</varname>. Once it - reaches the end of WAL available there and <varname>restore_command</varname> - fails, it tries to restore any WAL available in the <filename>pg_wal</filename> directory. + archive location, either by calling <varname>restore_command</varname> or + by executing the <varname>restore_library</varname>'s restore callback. + Once it reaches the end of WAL available there and + <varname>restore_command</varname> or the restore callback fails, it tries + to restore any WAL available in the <filename>pg_wal</filename> directory. If that fails, and streaming replication has been configured, the standby tries to connect to the primary server and start streaming WAL from the last valid record found in archive or <filename>pg_wal</filename>. If that fails @@ -698,7 +701,8 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. server (see <xref linkend="backup-pitr-recovery"/>). Create a file <link linkend="file-standby-signal"><filename>standby.signal</filename></link><indexterm><primary>standby.signal</primary></indexterm> in the standby's cluster data - directory. Set <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> to a simple command to copy files from + directory. Set <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> or + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> to copy files from the WAL archive. If you plan to have multiple standby servers for high availability purposes, make sure that <varname>recovery_target_timeline</varname> is set to <literal>latest</literal> (the default), to make the standby server follow the timeline change @@ -707,7 +711,8 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <note> <para> - <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> should return immediately + <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> and restore callbacks provided by + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> should return immediately if the file does not exist; the server will retry the command again if necessary. </para> @@ -731,8 +736,10 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <para> If you're using a WAL archive, its size can be minimized using the <xref - linkend="guc-archive-cleanup-command"/> parameter to remove files that are no - longer required by the standby server. + linkend="guc-archive-cleanup-command"/> parameter or the + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/>'s + <function>archive_cleanup_cb</function> callback function to remove files + that are no longer required by the standby server. The <application>pg_archivecleanup</application> utility is designed specifically to be used with <varname>archive_cleanup_command</varname> in typical single-standby configurations, see <xref linkend="pgarchivecleanup"/>. diff --git a/src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c b/src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c index 073e709e06..124a0bbdb6 100644 --- a/src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c +++ b/src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c @@ -3,7 +3,8 @@ * shell_restore.c * * These recovery functions use a user-specified shell command (e.g., the - * restore_command GUC). + * restore_command GUC). It is used as the default, but other modules may + * define their own recovery logic. * * Copyright (c) 2022, PostgreSQL Global Development Group * @@ -22,6 +23,10 @@ #include "storage/ipc.h" #include "utils/wait_event.h" +static bool shell_restore(const char *file, const char *path, + const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +static void shell_archive_cleanup(const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +static void shell_recovery_end(const char *lastRestartPointFileName); static char *BuildCleanupCommand(const char *command, const char *lastRestartPointFileName); static bool ExecuteRecoveryCommand(const char *command, @@ -29,6 +34,16 @@ static bool ExecuteRecoveryCommand(const char *command, bool exitOnSigterm, uint32 wait_event_info, int fail_elevel); +void +shell_restore_init(RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb) +{ + AssertVariableIsOfType(&shell_restore_init, RecoveryModuleInit); + + cb->restore_cb = shell_restore; + cb->archive_cleanup_cb = shell_archive_cleanup; + cb->recovery_end_cb = shell_recovery_end; +} + bool shell_restore(const char *file, const char *path, const char *lastRestartPointFileName) @@ -73,7 +88,7 @@ shell_restore(const char *file, const char *path, return ret; } -void +static void shell_archive_cleanup(const char *lastRestartPointFileName) { char *cmd = BuildCleanupCommand(archiveCleanupCommand, @@ -84,7 +99,7 @@ shell_archive_cleanup(const char *lastRestartPointFileName) pfree(cmd); } -void +static void shell_recovery_end(const char *lastRestartPointFileName) { char *cmd = BuildCleanupCommand(recoveryEndCommand, diff --git a/src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c b/src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c index fdce12614a..c4ad571327 100644 --- a/src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c +++ b/src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c @@ -4883,10 +4883,11 @@ static void CleanupAfterArchiveRecovery(TimeLineID EndOfLogTLI, XLogRecPtr EndOfLog, TimeLineID newTLI) { + /* - * Execute the recovery_end_command, if any. + * Execute the recovery-end callback, if any. */ - if (recoveryEndCommand && strcmp(recoveryEndCommand, "") != 0) + if (RecoveryContext.recovery_end_cb) { char lastRestartPointFname[MAXPGPATH]; XLogSegNo restartSegNo; @@ -4903,7 +4904,7 @@ CleanupAfterArchiveRecovery(TimeLineID EndOfLogTLI, XLogRecPtr EndOfLog, XLogFileName(lastRestartPointFname, restartTli, restartSegNo, wal_segment_size); - shell_recovery_end(lastRestartPointFname); + RecoveryContext.recovery_end_cb(lastRestartPointFname); } /* @@ -7318,9 +7319,9 @@ CreateRestartPoint(int flags) timestamptz_to_str(xtime)) : 0)); /* - * Finally, execute archive_cleanup_command, if any. + * Execute the archive-cleanup callback, if any. */ - if (archiveCleanupCommand && strcmp(archiveCleanupCommand, "") != 0) + if (RecoveryContext.archive_cleanup_cb) { char lastRestartPointFname[MAXPGPATH]; XLogSegNo restartSegNo; @@ -7337,7 +7338,7 @@ CreateRestartPoint(int flags) XLogFileName(lastRestartPointFname, restartTli, restartSegNo, wal_segment_size); - shell_archive_cleanup(lastRestartPointFname); + RecoveryContext.archive_cleanup_cb(lastRestartPointFname); } return true; diff --git a/src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c b/src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c index b5cb060d55..fdab7dad43 100644 --- a/src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c +++ b/src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c @@ -22,7 +22,9 @@ #include "access/xlog.h" #include "access/xlog_internal.h" #include "access/xlogarchive.h" +#include "access/xlogrecovery.h" #include "common/archive.h" +#include "fmgr.h" #include "miscadmin.h" #include "pgstat.h" #include "postmaster/startup.h" @@ -32,6 +34,11 @@ #include "storage/ipc.h" #include "storage/lwlock.h" +/* + * Global context for recovery-related callbacks. + */ +RecoveryModuleCallbacks RecoveryContext; + /* * Attempt to retrieve the specified file from off-line archival storage. * If successful, fill "path" with its complete path (note that this will be @@ -71,7 +78,7 @@ RestoreArchivedFile(char *path, const char *xlogfname, goto not_available; /* In standby mode, restore_command might not be supplied */ - if (recoveryRestoreCommand == NULL || strcmp(recoveryRestoreCommand, "") == 0) + if (RecoveryContext.restore_cb == NULL) goto not_available; /* @@ -149,14 +156,15 @@ RestoreArchivedFile(char *path, const char *xlogfname, XLogFileName(lastRestartPointFname, 0, 0L, wal_segment_size); /* - * Check signals before restore command and reset afterwards. + * Check signals before restore callback and reset afterwards. */ PreRestoreCommand(); /* * Copy xlog from archival storage to XLOGDIR */ - ret = shell_restore(xlogfname, xlogpath, lastRestartPointFname); + ret = RecoveryContext.restore_cb(xlogfname, xlogpath, + lastRestartPointFname); PostRestoreCommand(); @@ -603,3 +611,59 @@ XLogArchiveCleanup(const char *xlog) unlink(archiveStatusPath); /* should we complain about failure? */ } + +/* + * Loads all the recovery callbacks into our global RecoveryContext. The + * caller is responsible for validating the combination of library/command + * parameters that are set (e.g., restore_command and restore_library cannot + * both be set). + */ +void +LoadRecoveryCallbacks(void) +{ + RecoveryModuleInit init; + + /* + * If the shell command is enabled, use our special initialization + * function. Otherwise, load the library and call its + * _PG_recovery_module_init(). + */ + if (restoreLibrary[0] == '\0') + init = shell_restore_init; + else + init = (RecoveryModuleInit) + load_external_function(restoreLibrary, "_PG_recovery_module_init", + false, NULL); + + if (init == NULL) + ereport(ERROR, + (errmsg("recovery modules have to define the symbol " + "_PG_recovery_module_init"))); + + memset(&RecoveryContext, 0, sizeof(RecoveryModuleCallbacks)); + (*init) (&RecoveryContext); + + /* + * If using shell commands, remove callbacks for any commands that are not + * set. + */ + if (restoreLibrary[0] == '\0') + { + if (recoveryRestoreCommand[0] == '\0') + RecoveryContext.restore_cb = NULL; + if (archiveCleanupCommand[0] == '\0') + RecoveryContext.archive_cleanup_cb = NULL; + if (recoveryEndCommand[0] == '\0') + RecoveryContext.recovery_end_cb = NULL; + } +} + +/* + * Call the shutdown callback of the loaded recovery module, if defined. + */ +void +call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb(int code, Datum arg) +{ + if (RecoveryContext.shutdown_cb) + RecoveryContext.shutdown_cb(); +} diff --git a/src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c b/src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c index bc3c3eb3e7..95bcc3a0b7 100644 --- a/src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c +++ b/src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c @@ -80,6 +80,7 @@ const struct config_enum_entry recovery_target_action_options[] = { /* options formerly taken from recovery.conf for archive recovery */ char *recoveryRestoreCommand = NULL; +char *restoreLibrary = NULL; char *recoveryEndCommand = NULL; char *archiveCleanupCommand = NULL; RecoveryTargetType recoveryTarget = RECOVERY_TARGET_UNSET; @@ -1053,24 +1054,37 @@ validateRecoveryParameters(void) if (!ArchiveRecoveryRequested) return; + /* + * Check for invalid combinations of the command/library parameters and + * load the callbacks. + */ + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + recoveryRestoreCommand, "restore_command"); + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + recoveryEndCommand, "recovery_end_command"); + before_shmem_exit(call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb, 0); + LoadRecoveryCallbacks(); + /* * Check for compulsory parameters */ if (StandbyModeRequested) { if ((PrimaryConnInfo == NULL || strcmp(PrimaryConnInfo, "") == 0) && - (recoveryRestoreCommand == NULL || strcmp(recoveryRestoreCommand, "") == 0)) + RecoveryContext.restore_cb == NULL) ereport(WARNING, - (errmsg("specified neither primary_conninfo nor restore_command"), - errhint("The database server will regularly poll the pg_wal subdirectory to check for files placed there."))); + (errmsg("specified neither primary_conninfo nor restore_command " + "nor a restore_library that defines a restore callback"), + errhint("The database server will regularly poll the pg_wal " + "subdirectory to check for files placed there."))); } else { - if (recoveryRestoreCommand == NULL || - strcmp(recoveryRestoreCommand, "") == 0) + if (RecoveryContext.restore_cb == NULL) ereport(FATAL, (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), - errmsg("must specify restore_command when standby mode is not enabled"))); + errmsg("must specify restore_command or a restore_library that defines " + "a restore callback when standby mode is not enabled"))); } /* diff --git a/src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c b/src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c index de0bbbfa79..6350fd0b83 100644 --- a/src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c +++ b/src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c @@ -38,6 +38,7 @@ #include "access/xlog.h" #include "access/xlog_internal.h" +#include "access/xlogarchive.h" #include "access/xlogrecovery.h" #include "libpq/pqsignal.h" #include "miscadmin.h" @@ -222,6 +223,16 @@ CheckpointerMain(void) */ before_shmem_exit(pgstat_before_server_shutdown, 0); + /* + * Check for invalid combinations of the command/library parameters and + * load the callbacks. We do this before setting up the exception handler + * so that any problems result in a server crash shortly after startup. + */ + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + archiveCleanupCommand, "archive_cleanup_command"); + before_shmem_exit(call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb, 0); + LoadRecoveryCallbacks(); + /* * Create a memory context that we will do all our work in. We do this so * that we can reset the context during error recovery and thereby avoid @@ -548,6 +559,9 @@ HandleCheckpointerInterrupts(void) if (ConfigReloadPending) { + char *prevRestoreLibrary = pstrdup(restoreLibrary); + char *prevArchiveCleanupCommand = pstrdup(archiveCleanupCommand); + ConfigReloadPending = false; ProcessConfigFile(PGC_SIGHUP); @@ -563,6 +577,18 @@ HandleCheckpointerInterrupts(void) * because of SIGHUP. */ UpdateSharedMemoryConfig(); + + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + archiveCleanupCommand, "archive_cleanup_command"); + if (strcmp(prevRestoreLibrary, restoreLibrary) != 0 || + strcmp(prevArchiveCleanupCommand, archiveCleanupCommand) != 0) + { + call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb(0, (Datum) 0); + LoadRecoveryCallbacks(); + } + + pfree(prevRestoreLibrary); + pfree(prevArchiveCleanupCommand); } if (ShutdownRequestPending) { diff --git a/src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c b/src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c index 8ecdb9ca23..8e91f2d70f 100644 --- a/src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c +++ b/src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c @@ -831,11 +831,8 @@ LoadArchiveLibrary(void) { ArchiveModuleInit archive_init; - if (XLogArchiveLibrary[0] != '\0' && XLogArchiveCommand[0] != '\0') - ereport(ERROR, - (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), - errmsg("both archive_command and archive_library set"), - errdetail("Only one of archive_command, archive_library may be set."))); + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(XLogArchiveLibrary, "archive_library", + XLogArchiveCommand, "archive_command"); memset(&ArchiveContext, 0, sizeof(ArchiveModuleCallbacks)); diff --git a/src/backend/postmaster/startup.c b/src/backend/postmaster/startup.c index 8786186898..f9ff2b5583 100644 --- a/src/backend/postmaster/startup.c +++ b/src/backend/postmaster/startup.c @@ -20,6 +20,7 @@ #include "postgres.h" #include "access/xlog.h" +#include "access/xlogarchive.h" #include "access/xlogrecovery.h" #include "access/xlogutils.h" #include "libpq/pqsignal.h" @@ -133,13 +134,17 @@ StartupProcShutdownHandler(SIGNAL_ARGS) * Re-read the config file. * * If one of the critical walreceiver options has changed, flag xlog.c - * to restart it. + * to restart it. Also, check for invalid combinations of the command/library + * parameters and reload the recovery callbacks if necessary. */ static void StartupRereadConfig(void) { char *conninfo = pstrdup(PrimaryConnInfo); char *slotname = pstrdup(PrimarySlotName); + char *prevRestoreLibrary = pstrdup(restoreLibrary); + char *prevRestoreCommand = pstrdup(recoveryRestoreCommand); + char *prevRecoveryEndCommand = pstrdup(recoveryEndCommand); bool tempSlot = wal_receiver_create_temp_slot; bool conninfoChanged; bool slotnameChanged; @@ -161,6 +166,22 @@ StartupRereadConfig(void) if (conninfoChanged || slotnameChanged || tempSlotChanged) StartupRequestWalReceiverRestart(); + + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + recoveryRestoreCommand, "restore_command"); + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + recoveryEndCommand, "recovery_end_command"); + if (strcmp(prevRestoreLibrary, restoreLibrary) != 0 || + strcmp(prevRestoreCommand, recoveryRestoreCommand) != 0 || + strcmp(prevRecoveryEndCommand, recoveryEndCommand) != 0) + { + call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb(0, (Datum) 0); + LoadRecoveryCallbacks(); + } + + pfree(prevRestoreLibrary); + pfree(prevRestoreCommand); + pfree(prevRecoveryEndCommand); } /* Handle various signals that might be sent to the startup process */ diff --git a/src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c b/src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c index d52069f446..7858e9a649 100644 --- a/src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c +++ b/src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c @@ -6880,3 +6880,17 @@ call_enum_check_hook(struct config_enum *conf, int *newval, void **extra, return true; } + +/* + * ERROR if both parameters are set. + */ +void +CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(const char *p1val, const char *p1name, + const char *p2val, const char *p2name) +{ + if (p1val[0] != '\0' && p2val[0] != '\0') + ereport(ERROR, + (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), + errmsg("both %s and %s set", p1name, p2name), + errdetail("Only one of %s, %s may be set.", p1name, p2name))); +} diff --git a/src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c b/src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c index 68328b1402..19746e2489 100644 --- a/src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c +++ b/src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c @@ -3764,6 +3764,16 @@ struct config_string ConfigureNamesString[] = NULL, NULL, NULL }, + { + {"restore_library", PGC_SIGHUP, WAL_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY, + gettext_noop("Sets the library that will be called for recovery actions."), + NULL + }, + &restoreLibrary, + "", + NULL, NULL, NULL + }, + { {"archive_cleanup_command", PGC_SIGHUP, WAL_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY, gettext_noop("Sets the shell command that will be executed at every restart point."), diff --git a/src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample b/src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample index 5afdeb04de..e71e79271a 100644 --- a/src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample +++ b/src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample @@ -269,6 +269,7 @@ # placeholders: %p = path of file to restore # %f = file name only # e.g. 'cp /mnt/server/archivedir/%f %p' +#restore_library = '' # library to use for recovery actions #archive_cleanup_command = '' # command to execute at every restartpoint #recovery_end_command = '' # command to execute at completion of recovery diff --git a/src/include/access/xlog_internal.h b/src/include/access/xlog_internal.h index 59fc7bc105..756f0898b5 100644 --- a/src/include/access/xlog_internal.h +++ b/src/include/access/xlog_internal.h @@ -400,5 +400,6 @@ extern PGDLLIMPORT bool ArchiveRecoveryRequested; extern PGDLLIMPORT bool InArchiveRecovery; extern PGDLLIMPORT bool StandbyMode; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *recoveryRestoreCommand; +extern PGDLLIMPORT char *restoreLibrary; #endif /* XLOG_INTERNAL_H */ diff --git a/src/include/access/xlogarchive.h b/src/include/access/xlogarchive.h index 299304703e..71c9b88165 100644 --- a/src/include/access/xlogarchive.h +++ b/src/include/access/xlogarchive.h @@ -30,9 +30,45 @@ extern bool XLogArchiveIsReady(const char *xlog); extern bool XLogArchiveIsReadyOrDone(const char *xlog); extern void XLogArchiveCleanup(const char *xlog); -extern bool shell_restore(const char *file, const char *path, - const char *lastRestartPointFileName); -extern void shell_archive_cleanup(const char *lastRestartPointFileName); -extern void shell_recovery_end(const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +/* + * Recovery module callbacks + * + * These callback functions should be defined by recovery libraries and + * returned via _PG_recovery_module_init(). For more information about the + * purpose of each callback, refer to the recovery modules documentation. + */ +typedef bool (*RecoveryRestoreCB) (const char *file, const char *path, + const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +typedef void (*RecoveryArchiveCleanupCB) (const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +typedef void (*RecoveryEndCB) (const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +typedef void (*RecoveryShutdownCB) (void); + +typedef struct RecoveryModuleCallbacks +{ + RecoveryRestoreCB restore_cb; + RecoveryArchiveCleanupCB archive_cleanup_cb; + RecoveryEndCB recovery_end_cb; + RecoveryShutdownCB shutdown_cb; +} RecoveryModuleCallbacks; + +extern RecoveryModuleCallbacks RecoveryContext; + +/* + * Type of the shared library symbol _PG_recovery_module_init that is looked up + * when loading a recovery library. + */ +typedef void (*RecoveryModuleInit) (RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb); + +extern PGDLLEXPORT void _PG_recovery_module_init(RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb); + +extern void LoadRecoveryCallbacks(void); +extern void call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb(int code, Datum arg); + +/* + * Since the logic for recovery via a shell command is in the core server and + * does not need to be loaded via a shared library, it has a special + * initialization function. + */ +extern void shell_restore_init(RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb); #endif /* XLOG_ARCHIVE_H */ diff --git a/src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h b/src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h index 47c29350f5..35d1d09374 100644 --- a/src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h +++ b/src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h @@ -55,6 +55,7 @@ extern PGDLLIMPORT int recovery_min_apply_delay; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *PrimaryConnInfo; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *PrimarySlotName; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *recoveryRestoreCommand; +extern PGDLLIMPORT char *restoreLibrary; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *recoveryEndCommand; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *archiveCleanupCommand; diff --git a/src/include/utils/guc.h b/src/include/utils/guc.h index ba89d013e6..947597247f 100644 --- a/src/include/utils/guc.h +++ b/src/include/utils/guc.h @@ -404,6 +404,8 @@ extern void *guc_malloc(int elevel, size_t size); extern pg_nodiscard void *guc_realloc(int elevel, void *old, size_t size); extern char *guc_strdup(int elevel, const char *src); extern void guc_free(void *ptr); +extern void CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(const char *p1val, const char *p1name, + const char *p2val, const char *p2name); #ifdef EXEC_BACKEND extern void write_nondefault_variables(GucContext context); -- 2.25.1 --Kj7319i9nmIyA2yE-- ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 17+ messages in thread
* [PATCH v5 3/3] Allow recovery via loadable modules. @ 2022-12-10 03:40 Nathan Bossart <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 17+ messages in thread From: Nathan Bossart @ 2022-12-10 03:40 UTC (permalink / raw) This adds the restore_library parameter to allow archive recovery via a loadable module, rather than running shell commands. --- contrib/basic_archive/Makefile | 4 +- contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c | 67 ++++++- contrib/basic_archive/meson.build | 7 +- contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl | 44 +++++ doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml | 168 ++++++++++++++++-- doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml | 43 ++++- doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml | 33 ++-- doc/src/sgml/config.sgml | 54 +++++- doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml | 23 ++- src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c | 21 ++- src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c | 13 +- src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c | 70 +++++++- src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c | 26 ++- src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c | 26 +++ src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c | 7 +- src/backend/postmaster/startup.c | 23 ++- src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c | 14 ++ src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c | 10 ++ src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample | 1 + src/include/access/xlog_internal.h | 1 + src/include/access/xlogarchive.h | 44 ++++- src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h | 1 + src/include/utils/guc.h | 2 + 23 files changed, 618 insertions(+), 84 deletions(-) create mode 100644 contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl diff --git a/contrib/basic_archive/Makefile b/contrib/basic_archive/Makefile index 55d299d650..487dc563f3 100644 --- a/contrib/basic_archive/Makefile +++ b/contrib/basic_archive/Makefile @@ -1,7 +1,7 @@ # contrib/basic_archive/Makefile MODULES = basic_archive -PGFILEDESC = "basic_archive - basic archive module" +PGFILEDESC = "basic_archive - basic archive and recovery module" REGRESS = basic_archive REGRESS_OPTS = --temp-config $(top_srcdir)/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.conf @@ -9,6 +9,8 @@ REGRESS_OPTS = --temp-config $(top_srcdir)/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c # which typical installcheck users do not have (e.g. buildfarm clients). NO_INSTALLCHECK = 1 +TAP_TESTS = 1 + ifdef USE_PGXS PG_CONFIG = pg_config PGXS := $(shell $(PG_CONFIG) --pgxs) diff --git a/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c b/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c index 28cbb6cce0..8c333c8f99 100644 --- a/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c +++ b/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c @@ -17,6 +17,11 @@ * a file is successfully archived and then the system crashes before * a durable record of the success has been made. * + * This file also demonstrates a basic restore library implementation that + * is roughly equivalent to the following shell command: + * + * cp /path/to/archivedir/%f %p + * * Copyright (c) 2022-2023, PostgreSQL Global Development Group * * IDENTIFICATION @@ -30,6 +35,7 @@ #include <sys/time.h> #include <unistd.h> +#include "access/xlogarchive.h" #include "common/int.h" #include "miscadmin.h" #include "postmaster/pgarch.h" @@ -48,6 +54,8 @@ static bool basic_archive_file(const char *file, const char *path); static void basic_archive_file_internal(const char *file, const char *path); static bool check_archive_directory(char **newval, void **extra, GucSource source); static bool compare_files(const char *file1, const char *file2); +static bool basic_restore_file(const char *file, const char *path, + const char *lastRestartPointFileName); /* * _PG_init @@ -87,6 +95,19 @@ _PG_archive_module_init(ArchiveModuleCallbacks *cb) cb->archive_file_cb = basic_archive_file; } +/* + * _PG_recovery_module_init + * + * Returns the module's restore callback. + */ +void +_PG_recovery_module_init(RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb) +{ + AssertVariableIsOfType(&_PG_recovery_module_init, RecoveryModuleInit); + + cb->restore_cb = basic_restore_file; +} + /* * check_archive_directory * @@ -99,8 +120,8 @@ check_archive_directory(char **newval, void **extra, GucSource source) /* * The default value is an empty string, so we have to accept that value. - * Our check_configured callback also checks for this and prevents - * archiving from proceeding if it is still empty. + * Our check_configured and restore callbacks also check for this and + * prevent archiving or recovery from proceeding if it is still empty. */ if (*newval == NULL || *newval[0] == '\0') return true; @@ -368,3 +389,45 @@ compare_files(const char *file1, const char *file2) return ret; } + +/* + * basic_restore_file + * + * Retrieves one file from the WAL archives. + */ +static bool +basic_restore_file(const char *file, const char *path, + const char *lastRestartPointFileName) +{ + char source[MAXPGPATH]; + struct stat st; + + ereport(DEBUG1, + (errmsg("restoring \"%s\" via basic_archive", file))); + + if (archive_directory == NULL || archive_directory[0] == '\0') + ereport(ERROR, + (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), + errmsg("\"basic_archive.archive_directory\" is not set"))); + + /* + * Check whether the file exists. If not, we return false to indicate that + * there are no more files to restore. + */ + snprintf(source, MAXPGPATH, "%s/%s", archive_directory, file); + if (stat(source, &st) != 0) + { + int elevel = (errno == ENOENT) ? DEBUG1 : ERROR; + + ereport(elevel, + (errcode_for_file_access(), + errmsg("could not stat file \"%s\": %m", source))); + return false; + } + + copy_file(source, unconstify(char *, path)); + + ereport(DEBUG1, + (errmsg("restored \"%s\" via basic_archive", file))); + return true; +} diff --git a/contrib/basic_archive/meson.build b/contrib/basic_archive/meson.build index bc1380e6f6..af4580dea9 100644 --- a/contrib/basic_archive/meson.build +++ b/contrib/basic_archive/meson.build @@ -7,7 +7,7 @@ basic_archive_sources = files( if host_system == 'windows' basic_archive_sources += rc_lib_gen.process(win32ver_rc, extra_args: [ '--NAME', 'basic_archive', - '--FILEDESC', 'basic_archive - basic archive module',]) + '--FILEDESC', 'basic_archive - basic archive and recovery module',]) endif basic_archive = shared_module('basic_archive', @@ -31,4 +31,9 @@ tests += { # which typical runningcheck users do not have (e.g. buildfarm clients). 'runningcheck': false, }, + 'tap': { + 'tests': [ + 't/001_restore.pl', + ], + }, } diff --git a/contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl b/contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ec8767d740 --- /dev/null +++ b/contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl @@ -0,0 +1,44 @@ + +# Copyright (c) 2022, PostgreSQL Global Development Group + +use strict; +use warnings; +use PostgreSQL::Test::Cluster; +use PostgreSQL::Test::Utils; +use Test::More; + +# start a node +my $node = PostgreSQL::Test::Cluster->new('node'); +$node->init(has_archiving => 1, allows_streaming => 1); +my $archive_dir = $node->archive_dir; +$archive_dir =~ s!\\!/!g if $PostgreSQL::Test::Utils::windows_os; +$node->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "archive_command = ''"); +$node->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "archive_library = 'basic_archive'"); +$node->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "basic_archive.archive_directory = '$archive_dir'"); +$node->start; + +# backup the node +my $backup = 'backup'; +$node->backup($backup); + +# generate some new WAL files +$node->safe_psql('postgres', "CREATE TABLE test (a INT);"); +$node->safe_psql('postgres', "SELECT pg_switch_wal();"); +$node->safe_psql('postgres', "INSERT INTO test VALUES (1);"); + +# shut down the node (this should archive all WAL files) +$node->stop; + +# restore from the backup +my $restore = PostgreSQL::Test::Cluster->new('restore'); +$restore->init_from_backup($node, $backup, has_restoring => 1, standby => 0); +$restore->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "restore_command = ''"); +$restore->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "restore_library = 'basic_archive'"); +$restore->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "basic_archive.archive_directory = '$archive_dir'"); +$restore->start; + +# ensure post-backup WAL was replayed +my $result = $restore->safe_psql("postgres", "SELECT count(*) FROM test;"); +is($result, "1", "check restore content"); + +done_testing(); diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml index ef02051f7f..53e657040b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml @@ -1,34 +1,40 @@ <!-- doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml --> <chapter id="archive-modules"> - <title>Archive Modules</title> + <title>Archive and Recovery Modules</title> <indexterm zone="archive-modules"> - <primary>Archive Modules</primary> + <primary>Archive and Recovery Modules</primary> </indexterm> <para> PostgreSQL provides infrastructure to create custom modules for continuous - archiving (see <xref linkend="continuous-archiving"/>). While archiving via - a shell command (i.e., <xref linkend="guc-archive-command"/>) is much - simpler, a custom archive module will often be considerably more robust and - performant. + archiving and recovery (see <xref linkend="continuous-archiving"/>). While + a shell command (e.g., <xref linkend="guc-archive-command"/>, + <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/>) is much simpler, a custom module will + often be considerably more robust and performant. </para> <para> When a custom <xref linkend="guc-archive-library"/> is configured, PostgreSQL will submit completed WAL files to the module, and the server will avoid recycling or removing these WAL files until the module indicates that the files - were successfully archived. It is ultimately up to the module to decide what - to do with each WAL file, but many recommendations are listed at - <xref linkend="backup-archiving-wal"/>. + were successfully archived. When a custom + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> is configured, PostgreSQL will use the + module for recovery actions. It is ultimately up to the module to decide how + to accomplish each task, but some recommendations are listed at + <xref linkend="backup-archiving-wal"/> and + <xref linkend="backup-pitr-recovery"/>. </para> <para> - Archiving modules must at least consist of an initialization function (see - <xref linkend="archive-module-init"/>) and the required callbacks (see - <xref linkend="archive-module-callbacks"/>). However, archive modules are - also permitted to do much more (e.g., declare GUCs and register background - workers). + Archive and recovery modules must at least consist of an initialization + function (see <xref linkend="archive-module-init"/> and + <xref linkend="recovery-module-init"/>) and the required callbacks (see + <xref linkend="archive-module-callbacks"/> and + <xref linkend="recovery-module-callbacks"/>). However, archive and recovery + modules are also permitted to do much more (e.g., declare GUCs and register + background workers). A module may be used for both + <varname>archive_library</varname> and <varname>restore_library</varname>. </para> <para> @@ -37,7 +43,7 @@ </para> <sect1 id="archive-module-init"> - <title>Initialization Functions</title> + <title>Archive Module Initialization Functions</title> <indexterm zone="archive-module-init"> <primary>_PG_archive_module_init</primary> </indexterm> @@ -64,6 +70,12 @@ typedef void (*ArchiveModuleInit) (struct ArchiveModuleCallbacks *cb); Only the <function>archive_file_cb</function> callback is required. The others are optional. </para> + + <note> + <para> + <varname>archive_library</varname> is only loaded in the archiver process. + </para> + </note> </sect1> <sect1 id="archive-module-callbacks"> @@ -129,6 +141,132 @@ typedef bool (*ArchiveFileCB) (const char *file, const char *path); <programlisting> typedef void (*ArchiveShutdownCB) (void); +</programlisting> + </para> + </sect2> + </sect1> + + <sect1 id="recovery-module-init"> + <title>Recovery Module Initialization Functions</title> + <indexterm zone="recovery-module-init"> + <primary>_PG_recovery_module_init</primary> + </indexterm> + <para> + A recovery library is loaded by dynamically loading a shared library with the + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> as the library base name. The normal + library search path is used to locate the library. To provide the required + recovery module callbacks and to indicate that the library is actually a + recovery module, it needs to provide a function named + <function>_PG_recovery_module_init</function>. This function is passed a + struct that needs to be filled with the callback function pointers for + individual actions. + +<programlisting> +typedef struct RecoveryModuleCallbacks +{ + RecoveryRestoreCB restore_cb; + RecoveryArchiveCleanupCB archive_cleanup_cb; + RecoveryEndCB recovery_end_cb; + RecoveryShutdownCB shutdown_cb; +} RecoveryModuleCallbacks; +typedef void (*RecoveryModuleInit) (struct RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb); +</programlisting> + + The <function>restore_cb</function> callback is required for archive + recovery, but it is optional for streaming replication. The others are + always optional. + </para> + + <note> + <para> + <varname>restore_library</varname> is only loaded in the startup and + checkpointer processes and in single-user mode. + </para> + </note> + </sect1> + + <sect1 id="recovery-module-callbacks"> + <title>Recovery Module Callbacks</title> + <para> + The recovery callbacks define the actual behavior of the module. The server + will call them as required to execute recovery actions. + </para> + + <sect2 id="recovery-module-restore"> + <title>Restore Callback</title> + <para> + The <function>restore_cb</function> callback is called to retrieve a single + archived segment of the WAL file series for archive recovery or streaming + replication. + +<programlisting> +typedef bool (*RecoveryRestoreCB) (const char *file, const char *path, const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +</programlisting> + + This callback must return <literal>true</literal> only if the file was + successfully retrieved. If the file is not available in the archives, the + callback must return <literal>false</literal>. + <replaceable>file</replaceable> will contain just the file name + of the WAL file to retrieve, while <replaceable>path</replaceable> contains + the destination's relative path (including the file name). + <replaceable>lastRestartPointFileName</replaceable> will contain the name + of the file containing the last valid restart point. That is the earliest + file that must be kept to allow a restore to be restartable, so this + information can be used to truncate the archive to just the minimum + required to support restarting from the current restore. + <replaceable>lastRestartPointFileName</replaceable> is typically only used + by warm-standby configurations (see <xref linkend="warm-standby"/>). Note + that if multiple standby servers are restoring from the same archive + directory, you will need to ensure that you do not delete WAL files until + they are no longer needed by any of the servers. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="recovery-module-archive-cleanup"> + <title>Archive Cleanup Callback</title> + <para> + The <function>archive_cleanup_cb</function> callback is called at every + restart point and is intended to provide a mechanism for cleaning up old + archived WAL files that are no longer needed by the standby server. + +<programlisting> +typedef void (*RecoveryArchiveCleanupCB) (const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +</programlisting> + + <replaceable>lastRestartPointFileName</replaceable> will contain the name + of the file containing the last valid restart point, like in + <link linkend="recovery-module-restore"><function>restore_cb</function></link>. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="recovery-module-end"> + <title>Recovery End Callback</title> + <para> + The <function>recovery_end_cb</function> callback is called once at the end + of recovery and is intended to provide a mechanism for cleanup following + replication or recovery. + +<programlisting> +typedef void (*RecoveryEndCB) (const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +</programlisting> + + <replaceable>lastRestartPointFileName</replaceable> will contain the name + of the file containing the last valid restart point, like in + <link linkend="recovery-module-restore"><function>restore_cb</function></link>. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="recovery-module-shutdown"> + <title>Shutdown Callback</title> + <para> + The <function>shutdown_cb</function> callback is called when a process that + has loaded the recovery module exits (e.g., after an error) or the value of + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> changes. If no + <function>shutdown_cb</function> is defined, no special action is taken in + these situations. + +<programlisting> +typedef void (*RecoveryShutdownCB) (void); </programlisting> </para> </sect2> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml index 8bab521718..d6d34078fc 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml @@ -1181,9 +1181,27 @@ SELECT * FROM pg_backup_stop(wait_for_archive => true); <para> The key part of all this is to set up a recovery configuration that describes how you want to recover and how far the recovery should - run. The one thing that you absolutely must specify is the <varname>restore_command</varname>, - which tells <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> how to retrieve archived - WAL file segments. Like the <varname>archive_command</varname>, this is + run. The one thing that you absolutely must specify is either + <varname>restore_command</varname> or a <varname>restore_library</varname> + that defines a restore callback, which tells + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> how to retrieve archived WAL file + segments. + </para> + + <para> + Like the <varname>archive_library</varname> parameter, + <varname>restore_library</varname> is a shared library. Since such + libraries are written in <literal>C</literal>, creating your own may + require considerably more effort than writing a shell command. However, + recovery modules can be more performant than restoring via shell, and they + will have access to many useful server resources. For more information + about creating a <varname>restore_library</varname>, see + <xref linkend="archive-modules"/>. + </para> + + <para> + Like the <varname>archive_command</varname>, + <varname>restore_command</varname> is a shell command string. It can contain <literal>%f</literal>, which is replaced by the name of the desired WAL file, and <literal>%p</literal>, which is replaced by the path name to copy the WAL file to. @@ -1202,14 +1220,20 @@ restore_command = 'cp /mnt/server/archivedir/%f %p' </para> <para> - It is important that the command return nonzero exit status on failure. - The command <emphasis>will</emphasis> be called requesting files that are not - present in the archive; it must return nonzero when so asked. This is not - an error condition. An exception is that if the command was terminated by + It is important that the <varname>restore_command</varname> return nonzero + exit status on failure, or, if you are using a + <varname>restore_library</varname>, that the restore function returns + <literal>false</literal> on failure. The command or library + <emphasis>will</emphasis> be called requesting files that are not + present in the archive; it must fail when so asked. This is not + an error condition. An exception is that if the + <varname>restore_command</varname> was terminated by a signal (other than <systemitem>SIGTERM</systemitem>, which is used as part of a database server shutdown) or an error by the shell (such as command not found), then recovery will abort and the server will not start - up. + up. Likewise, if the restore function provided by the + <varname>restore_library</varname> emits an <literal>ERROR</literal> or + <literal>FATAL</literal>, recovery will abort and the server won't start. </para> <para> @@ -1233,7 +1257,8 @@ restore_command = 'cp /mnt/server/archivedir/%f %p' close as possible given the available WAL segments). Therefore, a normal recovery will end with a <quote>file not found</quote> message, the exact text of the error message depending upon your choice of - <varname>restore_command</varname>. You may also see an error message + <varname>restore_command</varname> or <varname>restore_library</varname>. + You may also see an error message at the start of recovery for a file named something like <filename>00000001.history</filename>. This is also normal and does not indicate a problem in simple recovery situations; see diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml index 60f23d2855..11fd670dbc 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml @@ -8,17 +8,20 @@ </indexterm> <para> - <filename>basic_archive</filename> is an example of an archive module. This - module copies completed WAL segment files to the specified directory. This - may not be especially useful, but it can serve as a starting point for - developing your own archive module. For more information about archive - modules, see <xref linkend="archive-modules"/>. + <filename>basic_archive</filename> is an example of an archive and recovery + module. This module copies completed WAL segment files to or from the + specified directory. This may not be especially useful, but it can serve as + a starting point for developing your own archive and recovery modules. For + more information about archive and recovery modules, see + see <xref linkend="archive-modules"/>. </para> <para> - In order to function, this module must be loaded via + For use as an archive module, this module must be loaded via <xref linkend="guc-archive-library"/>, and <xref linkend="guc-archive-mode"/> - must be enabled. + must be enabled. For use as a recovery module, this module must be loaded + via <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/>, and recovery must be enabled (see + <xref linkend="runtime-config-wal-archive-recovery"/>). </para> <sect2 id="basic-archive-configuration-parameters"> @@ -34,11 +37,12 @@ </term> <listitem> <para> - The directory where the server should copy WAL segment files. This - directory must already exist. The default is an empty string, which - effectively halts WAL archiving, but if <xref linkend="guc-archive-mode"/> - is enabled, the server will accumulate WAL segment files in the - expectation that a value will soon be provided. + The directory where the server should copy WAL segment files to or from. + This directory must already exist. The default is an empty string, + which, when used for archiving, effectively halts WAL archival, but if + <xref linkend="guc-archive-mode"/> is enabled, the server will accumulate + WAL segment files in the expectation that a value will soon be provided. + When an empty string is used for recovery, restore will fail. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -46,7 +50,7 @@ <para> These parameters must be set in <filename>postgresql.conf</filename>. - Typical usage might be: + Typical usage as an archive module might be: </para> <programlisting> @@ -61,7 +65,8 @@ basic_archive.archive_directory = '/path/to/archive/directory' <title>Notes</title> <para> - Server crashes may leave temporary files with the prefix + When <filename>basic_archive</filename> is used as an archive module, server + crashes may leave temporary files with the prefix <filename>archtemp</filename> in the archive directory. It is recommended to delete such files before restarting the server after a crash. It is safe to remove such files while the server is running as long as they are unrelated diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml index 77574e2d4e..039d3360ac 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml @@ -3773,7 +3773,8 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' recovery when the end of archived WAL is reached, but will keep trying to continue recovery by connecting to the sending server as specified by the <varname>primary_conninfo</varname> setting and/or by fetching new WAL - segments using <varname>restore_command</varname>. For this mode, the + segments using <varname>restore_command</varname> or + <varname>restore_library</varname>. For this mode, the parameters from this section and <xref linkend="runtime-config-replication-standby"/> are of interest. Parameters from <xref linkend="runtime-config-wal-recovery-target"/> will @@ -3801,7 +3802,8 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' <listitem> <para> The local shell command to execute to retrieve an archived segment of - the WAL file series. This parameter is required for archive recovery, + the WAL file series. Either <varname>restore_command</varname> or + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> is required for archive recovery, but optional for streaming replication. Any <literal>%f</literal> in the string is replaced by the name of the file to retrieve from the archive, @@ -3836,7 +3838,42 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows <para> This parameter can only be set in the <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> - file or on the server command line. + file or on the server command line. It is only used if + <varname>restore_library</varname> is set to an empty string. If both + <varname>restore_command</varname> and + <varname>restore_library</varname> are set, an error will be raised. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry id="guc-restore-library" xreflabel="restore_library"> + <term><varname>restore_library</varname> (<type>string</type>) + <indexterm> + <primary><varname>restore_library</varname> configuration parameter</primary> + </indexterm> + </term> + <listitem> + <para> + The library to use for recovery actions, including retrieving archived + segments of the WAL file series and executing tasks at restartpoints + and at recovery end. Either <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> or + <varname>restore_library</varname> is required for archive recovery, + but optional for streaming replication. If this parameter is set to an + empty string (the default), restoring via shell is enabled, and + <varname>restore_command</varname>, + <varname>archive_cleanup_command</varname> and + <varname>recovery_end_command</varname> are used. If both + <varname>restore_library</varname> and any of + <varname>restore_command</varname>, + <varname>archive_cleanup_command</varname> or + <varname>recovery_end_command</varname> are set, an error will be + raised. Otherwise, the specified shared library is used for recovery. + For more information, see <xref linkend="archive-modules"/>. + </para> + + <para> + This parameter can only be set in the + <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> file or on the server command line. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -3881,7 +3918,10 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows </para> <para> This parameter can only be set in the <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> - file or on the server command line. + file or on the server command line. It is only used if + <varname>restore_library</varname> is set to an empty string. If both + <varname>archive_cleanup_command</varname> and + <varname>restore_library</varname> are set, an error will be raised. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -3910,11 +3950,13 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows </para> <para> This parameter can only be set in the <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> - file or on the server command line. + file or on the server command line. It is only used if + <varname>restore_library</varname> is set to an empty string. If both + <varname>recovery_end_command</varname> and + <varname>restore_library</varname> are set, an error will be raised. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> - </variablelist> </sect2> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml index f180607528..6266e2df7f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml @@ -627,7 +627,8 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <para> In standby mode, the server continuously applies WAL received from the primary server. The standby server can read WAL from a WAL archive - (see <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/>) or directly from the primary + (see <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> and + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/>) or directly from the primary over a TCP connection (streaming replication). The standby server will also attempt to restore any WAL found in the standby cluster's <filename>pg_wal</filename> directory. That typically happens after a server @@ -638,9 +639,11 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <para> At startup, the standby begins by restoring all WAL available in the - archive location, calling <varname>restore_command</varname>. Once it - reaches the end of WAL available there and <varname>restore_command</varname> - fails, it tries to restore any WAL available in the <filename>pg_wal</filename> directory. + archive location, either by calling <varname>restore_command</varname> or + by executing the <varname>restore_library</varname>'s restore callback. + Once it reaches the end of WAL available there and + <varname>restore_command</varname> or the restore callback fails, it tries + to restore any WAL available in the <filename>pg_wal</filename> directory. If that fails, and streaming replication has been configured, the standby tries to connect to the primary server and start streaming WAL from the last valid record found in archive or <filename>pg_wal</filename>. If that fails @@ -698,7 +701,8 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. server (see <xref linkend="backup-pitr-recovery"/>). Create a file <link linkend="file-standby-signal"><filename>standby.signal</filename></link><indexterm><primary>standby.signal</primary></indexterm> in the standby's cluster data - directory. Set <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> to a simple command to copy files from + directory. Set <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> or + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> to copy files from the WAL archive. If you plan to have multiple standby servers for high availability purposes, make sure that <varname>recovery_target_timeline</varname> is set to <literal>latest</literal> (the default), to make the standby server follow the timeline change @@ -707,7 +711,8 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <note> <para> - <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> should return immediately + <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> and restore callbacks provided by + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> should return immediately if the file does not exist; the server will retry the command again if necessary. </para> @@ -731,8 +736,10 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <para> If you're using a WAL archive, its size can be minimized using the <xref - linkend="guc-archive-cleanup-command"/> parameter to remove files that are no - longer required by the standby server. + linkend="guc-archive-cleanup-command"/> parameter or the + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/>'s + <function>archive_cleanup_cb</function> callback function to remove files + that are no longer required by the standby server. The <application>pg_archivecleanup</application> utility is designed specifically to be used with <varname>archive_cleanup_command</varname> in typical single-standby configurations, see <xref linkend="pgarchivecleanup"/>. diff --git a/src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c b/src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c index 68bf6e8556..eb101b51fb 100644 --- a/src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c +++ b/src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c @@ -3,7 +3,8 @@ * shell_restore.c * * These recovery functions use a user-specified shell command (e.g., the - * restore_command GUC). + * restore_command GUC). It is used as the default, but other modules may + * define their own recovery logic. * * Copyright (c) 2022, PostgreSQL Global Development Group * @@ -23,11 +24,25 @@ #include "storage/ipc.h" #include "utils/wait_event.h" +static bool shell_restore(const char *file, const char *path, + const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +static void shell_archive_cleanup(const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +static void shell_recovery_end(const char *lastRestartPointFileName); static bool ExecuteRecoveryCommand(const char *command, const char *commandName, bool failOnSignal, bool exitOnSigterm, uint32 wait_event_info, int fail_elevel); +void +shell_restore_init(RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb) +{ + AssertVariableIsOfType(&shell_restore_init, RecoveryModuleInit); + + cb->restore_cb = shell_restore; + cb->archive_cleanup_cb = shell_archive_cleanup; + cb->recovery_end_cb = shell_recovery_end; +} + bool shell_restore(const char *file, const char *path, const char *lastRestartPointFileName) @@ -70,7 +85,7 @@ shell_restore(const char *file, const char *path, return ret; } -void +static void shell_archive_cleanup(const char *lastRestartPointFileName) { char *cmd; @@ -83,7 +98,7 @@ shell_archive_cleanup(const char *lastRestartPointFileName) pfree(cmd); } -void +static void shell_recovery_end(const char *lastRestartPointFileName) { char *cmd; diff --git a/src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c b/src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c index fdce12614a..c4ad571327 100644 --- a/src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c +++ b/src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c @@ -4883,10 +4883,11 @@ static void CleanupAfterArchiveRecovery(TimeLineID EndOfLogTLI, XLogRecPtr EndOfLog, TimeLineID newTLI) { + /* - * Execute the recovery_end_command, if any. + * Execute the recovery-end callback, if any. */ - if (recoveryEndCommand && strcmp(recoveryEndCommand, "") != 0) + if (RecoveryContext.recovery_end_cb) { char lastRestartPointFname[MAXPGPATH]; XLogSegNo restartSegNo; @@ -4903,7 +4904,7 @@ CleanupAfterArchiveRecovery(TimeLineID EndOfLogTLI, XLogRecPtr EndOfLog, XLogFileName(lastRestartPointFname, restartTli, restartSegNo, wal_segment_size); - shell_recovery_end(lastRestartPointFname); + RecoveryContext.recovery_end_cb(lastRestartPointFname); } /* @@ -7318,9 +7319,9 @@ CreateRestartPoint(int flags) timestamptz_to_str(xtime)) : 0)); /* - * Finally, execute archive_cleanup_command, if any. + * Execute the archive-cleanup callback, if any. */ - if (archiveCleanupCommand && strcmp(archiveCleanupCommand, "") != 0) + if (RecoveryContext.archive_cleanup_cb) { char lastRestartPointFname[MAXPGPATH]; XLogSegNo restartSegNo; @@ -7337,7 +7338,7 @@ CreateRestartPoint(int flags) XLogFileName(lastRestartPointFname, restartTli, restartSegNo, wal_segment_size); - shell_archive_cleanup(lastRestartPointFname); + RecoveryContext.archive_cleanup_cb(lastRestartPointFname); } return true; diff --git a/src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c b/src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c index b5cb060d55..fdab7dad43 100644 --- a/src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c +++ b/src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c @@ -22,7 +22,9 @@ #include "access/xlog.h" #include "access/xlog_internal.h" #include "access/xlogarchive.h" +#include "access/xlogrecovery.h" #include "common/archive.h" +#include "fmgr.h" #include "miscadmin.h" #include "pgstat.h" #include "postmaster/startup.h" @@ -32,6 +34,11 @@ #include "storage/ipc.h" #include "storage/lwlock.h" +/* + * Global context for recovery-related callbacks. + */ +RecoveryModuleCallbacks RecoveryContext; + /* * Attempt to retrieve the specified file from off-line archival storage. * If successful, fill "path" with its complete path (note that this will be @@ -71,7 +78,7 @@ RestoreArchivedFile(char *path, const char *xlogfname, goto not_available; /* In standby mode, restore_command might not be supplied */ - if (recoveryRestoreCommand == NULL || strcmp(recoveryRestoreCommand, "") == 0) + if (RecoveryContext.restore_cb == NULL) goto not_available; /* @@ -149,14 +156,15 @@ RestoreArchivedFile(char *path, const char *xlogfname, XLogFileName(lastRestartPointFname, 0, 0L, wal_segment_size); /* - * Check signals before restore command and reset afterwards. + * Check signals before restore callback and reset afterwards. */ PreRestoreCommand(); /* * Copy xlog from archival storage to XLOGDIR */ - ret = shell_restore(xlogfname, xlogpath, lastRestartPointFname); + ret = RecoveryContext.restore_cb(xlogfname, xlogpath, + lastRestartPointFname); PostRestoreCommand(); @@ -603,3 +611,59 @@ XLogArchiveCleanup(const char *xlog) unlink(archiveStatusPath); /* should we complain about failure? */ } + +/* + * Loads all the recovery callbacks into our global RecoveryContext. The + * caller is responsible for validating the combination of library/command + * parameters that are set (e.g., restore_command and restore_library cannot + * both be set). + */ +void +LoadRecoveryCallbacks(void) +{ + RecoveryModuleInit init; + + /* + * If the shell command is enabled, use our special initialization + * function. Otherwise, load the library and call its + * _PG_recovery_module_init(). + */ + if (restoreLibrary[0] == '\0') + init = shell_restore_init; + else + init = (RecoveryModuleInit) + load_external_function(restoreLibrary, "_PG_recovery_module_init", + false, NULL); + + if (init == NULL) + ereport(ERROR, + (errmsg("recovery modules have to define the symbol " + "_PG_recovery_module_init"))); + + memset(&RecoveryContext, 0, sizeof(RecoveryModuleCallbacks)); + (*init) (&RecoveryContext); + + /* + * If using shell commands, remove callbacks for any commands that are not + * set. + */ + if (restoreLibrary[0] == '\0') + { + if (recoveryRestoreCommand[0] == '\0') + RecoveryContext.restore_cb = NULL; + if (archiveCleanupCommand[0] == '\0') + RecoveryContext.archive_cleanup_cb = NULL; + if (recoveryEndCommand[0] == '\0') + RecoveryContext.recovery_end_cb = NULL; + } +} + +/* + * Call the shutdown callback of the loaded recovery module, if defined. + */ +void +call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb(int code, Datum arg) +{ + if (RecoveryContext.shutdown_cb) + RecoveryContext.shutdown_cb(); +} diff --git a/src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c b/src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c index 5e65785306..db0cd4469a 100644 --- a/src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c +++ b/src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c @@ -80,6 +80,7 @@ const struct config_enum_entry recovery_target_action_options[] = { /* options formerly taken from recovery.conf for archive recovery */ char *recoveryRestoreCommand = NULL; +char *restoreLibrary = NULL; char *recoveryEndCommand = NULL; char *archiveCleanupCommand = NULL; RecoveryTargetType recoveryTarget = RECOVERY_TARGET_UNSET; @@ -1053,24 +1054,37 @@ validateRecoveryParameters(void) if (!ArchiveRecoveryRequested) return; + /* + * Check for invalid combinations of the command/library parameters and + * load the callbacks. + */ + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + recoveryRestoreCommand, "restore_command"); + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + recoveryEndCommand, "recovery_end_command"); + before_shmem_exit(call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb, 0); + LoadRecoveryCallbacks(); + /* * Check for compulsory parameters */ if (StandbyModeRequested) { if ((PrimaryConnInfo == NULL || strcmp(PrimaryConnInfo, "") == 0) && - (recoveryRestoreCommand == NULL || strcmp(recoveryRestoreCommand, "") == 0)) + RecoveryContext.restore_cb == NULL) ereport(WARNING, - (errmsg("specified neither primary_conninfo nor restore_command"), - errhint("The database server will regularly poll the pg_wal subdirectory to check for files placed there."))); + (errmsg("specified neither primary_conninfo nor restore_command " + "nor a restore_library that defines a restore callback"), + errhint("The database server will regularly poll the pg_wal " + "subdirectory to check for files placed there."))); } else { - if (recoveryRestoreCommand == NULL || - strcmp(recoveryRestoreCommand, "") == 0) + if (RecoveryContext.restore_cb == NULL) ereport(FATAL, (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), - errmsg("must specify restore_command when standby mode is not enabled"))); + errmsg("must specify restore_command or a restore_library that defines " + "a restore callback when standby mode is not enabled"))); } /* diff --git a/src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c b/src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c index de0bbbfa79..6350fd0b83 100644 --- a/src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c +++ b/src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c @@ -38,6 +38,7 @@ #include "access/xlog.h" #include "access/xlog_internal.h" +#include "access/xlogarchive.h" #include "access/xlogrecovery.h" #include "libpq/pqsignal.h" #include "miscadmin.h" @@ -222,6 +223,16 @@ CheckpointerMain(void) */ before_shmem_exit(pgstat_before_server_shutdown, 0); + /* + * Check for invalid combinations of the command/library parameters and + * load the callbacks. We do this before setting up the exception handler + * so that any problems result in a server crash shortly after startup. + */ + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + archiveCleanupCommand, "archive_cleanup_command"); + before_shmem_exit(call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb, 0); + LoadRecoveryCallbacks(); + /* * Create a memory context that we will do all our work in. We do this so * that we can reset the context during error recovery and thereby avoid @@ -548,6 +559,9 @@ HandleCheckpointerInterrupts(void) if (ConfigReloadPending) { + char *prevRestoreLibrary = pstrdup(restoreLibrary); + char *prevArchiveCleanupCommand = pstrdup(archiveCleanupCommand); + ConfigReloadPending = false; ProcessConfigFile(PGC_SIGHUP); @@ -563,6 +577,18 @@ HandleCheckpointerInterrupts(void) * because of SIGHUP. */ UpdateSharedMemoryConfig(); + + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + archiveCleanupCommand, "archive_cleanup_command"); + if (strcmp(prevRestoreLibrary, restoreLibrary) != 0 || + strcmp(prevArchiveCleanupCommand, archiveCleanupCommand) != 0) + { + call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb(0, (Datum) 0); + LoadRecoveryCallbacks(); + } + + pfree(prevRestoreLibrary); + pfree(prevArchiveCleanupCommand); } if (ShutdownRequestPending) { diff --git a/src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c b/src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c index 8ecdb9ca23..8e91f2d70f 100644 --- a/src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c +++ b/src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c @@ -831,11 +831,8 @@ LoadArchiveLibrary(void) { ArchiveModuleInit archive_init; - if (XLogArchiveLibrary[0] != '\0' && XLogArchiveCommand[0] != '\0') - ereport(ERROR, - (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), - errmsg("both archive_command and archive_library set"), - errdetail("Only one of archive_command, archive_library may be set."))); + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(XLogArchiveLibrary, "archive_library", + XLogArchiveCommand, "archive_command"); memset(&ArchiveContext, 0, sizeof(ArchiveModuleCallbacks)); diff --git a/src/backend/postmaster/startup.c b/src/backend/postmaster/startup.c index 8786186898..f9ff2b5583 100644 --- a/src/backend/postmaster/startup.c +++ b/src/backend/postmaster/startup.c @@ -20,6 +20,7 @@ #include "postgres.h" #include "access/xlog.h" +#include "access/xlogarchive.h" #include "access/xlogrecovery.h" #include "access/xlogutils.h" #include "libpq/pqsignal.h" @@ -133,13 +134,17 @@ StartupProcShutdownHandler(SIGNAL_ARGS) * Re-read the config file. * * If one of the critical walreceiver options has changed, flag xlog.c - * to restart it. + * to restart it. Also, check for invalid combinations of the command/library + * parameters and reload the recovery callbacks if necessary. */ static void StartupRereadConfig(void) { char *conninfo = pstrdup(PrimaryConnInfo); char *slotname = pstrdup(PrimarySlotName); + char *prevRestoreLibrary = pstrdup(restoreLibrary); + char *prevRestoreCommand = pstrdup(recoveryRestoreCommand); + char *prevRecoveryEndCommand = pstrdup(recoveryEndCommand); bool tempSlot = wal_receiver_create_temp_slot; bool conninfoChanged; bool slotnameChanged; @@ -161,6 +166,22 @@ StartupRereadConfig(void) if (conninfoChanged || slotnameChanged || tempSlotChanged) StartupRequestWalReceiverRestart(); + + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + recoveryRestoreCommand, "restore_command"); + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + recoveryEndCommand, "recovery_end_command"); + if (strcmp(prevRestoreLibrary, restoreLibrary) != 0 || + strcmp(prevRestoreCommand, recoveryRestoreCommand) != 0 || + strcmp(prevRecoveryEndCommand, recoveryEndCommand) != 0) + { + call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb(0, (Datum) 0); + LoadRecoveryCallbacks(); + } + + pfree(prevRestoreLibrary); + pfree(prevRestoreCommand); + pfree(prevRecoveryEndCommand); } /* Handle various signals that might be sent to the startup process */ diff --git a/src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c b/src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c index d52069f446..7858e9a649 100644 --- a/src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c +++ b/src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c @@ -6880,3 +6880,17 @@ call_enum_check_hook(struct config_enum *conf, int *newval, void **extra, return true; } + +/* + * ERROR if both parameters are set. + */ +void +CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(const char *p1val, const char *p1name, + const char *p2val, const char *p2name) +{ + if (p1val[0] != '\0' && p2val[0] != '\0') + ereport(ERROR, + (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), + errmsg("both %s and %s set", p1name, p2name), + errdetail("Only one of %s, %s may be set.", p1name, p2name))); +} diff --git a/src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c b/src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c index 5025e80f89..a8a516b0c6 100644 --- a/src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c +++ b/src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c @@ -3776,6 +3776,16 @@ struct config_string ConfigureNamesString[] = NULL, NULL, NULL }, + { + {"restore_library", PGC_SIGHUP, WAL_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY, + gettext_noop("Sets the library that will be called for recovery actions."), + NULL + }, + &restoreLibrary, + "", + NULL, NULL, NULL + }, + { {"archive_cleanup_command", PGC_SIGHUP, WAL_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY, gettext_noop("Sets the shell command that will be executed at every restart point."), diff --git a/src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample b/src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample index 4cceda4162..38fb3e0823 100644 --- a/src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample +++ b/src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample @@ -269,6 +269,7 @@ # placeholders: %p = path of file to restore # %f = file name only # e.g. 'cp /mnt/server/archivedir/%f %p' +#restore_library = '' # library to use for recovery actions #archive_cleanup_command = '' # command to execute at every restartpoint #recovery_end_command = '' # command to execute at completion of recovery diff --git a/src/include/access/xlog_internal.h b/src/include/access/xlog_internal.h index 59fc7bc105..756f0898b5 100644 --- a/src/include/access/xlog_internal.h +++ b/src/include/access/xlog_internal.h @@ -400,5 +400,6 @@ extern PGDLLIMPORT bool ArchiveRecoveryRequested; extern PGDLLIMPORT bool InArchiveRecovery; extern PGDLLIMPORT bool StandbyMode; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *recoveryRestoreCommand; +extern PGDLLIMPORT char *restoreLibrary; #endif /* XLOG_INTERNAL_H */ diff --git a/src/include/access/xlogarchive.h b/src/include/access/xlogarchive.h index 299304703e..71c9b88165 100644 --- a/src/include/access/xlogarchive.h +++ b/src/include/access/xlogarchive.h @@ -30,9 +30,45 @@ extern bool XLogArchiveIsReady(const char *xlog); extern bool XLogArchiveIsReadyOrDone(const char *xlog); extern void XLogArchiveCleanup(const char *xlog); -extern bool shell_restore(const char *file, const char *path, - const char *lastRestartPointFileName); -extern void shell_archive_cleanup(const char *lastRestartPointFileName); -extern void shell_recovery_end(const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +/* + * Recovery module callbacks + * + * These callback functions should be defined by recovery libraries and + * returned via _PG_recovery_module_init(). For more information about the + * purpose of each callback, refer to the recovery modules documentation. + */ +typedef bool (*RecoveryRestoreCB) (const char *file, const char *path, + const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +typedef void (*RecoveryArchiveCleanupCB) (const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +typedef void (*RecoveryEndCB) (const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +typedef void (*RecoveryShutdownCB) (void); + +typedef struct RecoveryModuleCallbacks +{ + RecoveryRestoreCB restore_cb; + RecoveryArchiveCleanupCB archive_cleanup_cb; + RecoveryEndCB recovery_end_cb; + RecoveryShutdownCB shutdown_cb; +} RecoveryModuleCallbacks; + +extern RecoveryModuleCallbacks RecoveryContext; + +/* + * Type of the shared library symbol _PG_recovery_module_init that is looked up + * when loading a recovery library. + */ +typedef void (*RecoveryModuleInit) (RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb); + +extern PGDLLEXPORT void _PG_recovery_module_init(RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb); + +extern void LoadRecoveryCallbacks(void); +extern void call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb(int code, Datum arg); + +/* + * Since the logic for recovery via a shell command is in the core server and + * does not need to be loaded via a shared library, it has a special + * initialization function. + */ +extern void shell_restore_init(RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb); #endif /* XLOG_ARCHIVE_H */ diff --git a/src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h b/src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h index 47c29350f5..35d1d09374 100644 --- a/src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h +++ b/src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h @@ -55,6 +55,7 @@ extern PGDLLIMPORT int recovery_min_apply_delay; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *PrimaryConnInfo; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *PrimarySlotName; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *recoveryRestoreCommand; +extern PGDLLIMPORT char *restoreLibrary; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *recoveryEndCommand; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *archiveCleanupCommand; diff --git a/src/include/utils/guc.h b/src/include/utils/guc.h index ba89d013e6..947597247f 100644 --- a/src/include/utils/guc.h +++ b/src/include/utils/guc.h @@ -404,6 +404,8 @@ extern void *guc_malloc(int elevel, size_t size); extern pg_nodiscard void *guc_realloc(int elevel, void *old, size_t size); extern char *guc_strdup(int elevel, const char *src); extern void guc_free(void *ptr); +extern void CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(const char *p1val, const char *p1name, + const char *p2val, const char *p2name); #ifdef EXEC_BACKEND extern void write_nondefault_variables(GucContext context); -- 2.25.1 --C7zPtVaVf+AK4Oqc-- ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 17+ messages in thread
* [PATCH v6 3/3] Allow recovery via loadable modules. @ 2022-12-10 03:40 Nathan Bossart <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 17+ messages in thread From: Nathan Bossart @ 2022-12-10 03:40 UTC (permalink / raw) This adds the restore_library parameter to allow archive recovery via a loadable module, rather than running shell commands. --- contrib/basic_archive/Makefile | 4 +- contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c | 67 ++++++- contrib/basic_archive/meson.build | 7 +- contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl | 44 +++++ doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml | 168 ++++++++++++++++-- doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml | 43 ++++- doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml | 33 ++-- doc/src/sgml/config.sgml | 54 +++++- doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml | 23 ++- src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c | 21 ++- src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c | 13 +- src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c | 70 +++++++- src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c | 26 ++- src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c | 26 +++ src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c | 7 +- src/backend/postmaster/startup.c | 23 ++- src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c | 14 ++ src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c | 10 ++ src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample | 1 + src/include/access/xlog_internal.h | 1 + src/include/access/xlogarchive.h | 44 ++++- src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h | 1 + src/include/utils/guc.h | 2 + 23 files changed, 618 insertions(+), 84 deletions(-) create mode 100644 contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl diff --git a/contrib/basic_archive/Makefile b/contrib/basic_archive/Makefile index 55d299d650..487dc563f3 100644 --- a/contrib/basic_archive/Makefile +++ b/contrib/basic_archive/Makefile @@ -1,7 +1,7 @@ # contrib/basic_archive/Makefile MODULES = basic_archive -PGFILEDESC = "basic_archive - basic archive module" +PGFILEDESC = "basic_archive - basic archive and recovery module" REGRESS = basic_archive REGRESS_OPTS = --temp-config $(top_srcdir)/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.conf @@ -9,6 +9,8 @@ REGRESS_OPTS = --temp-config $(top_srcdir)/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c # which typical installcheck users do not have (e.g. buildfarm clients). NO_INSTALLCHECK = 1 +TAP_TESTS = 1 + ifdef USE_PGXS PG_CONFIG = pg_config PGXS := $(shell $(PG_CONFIG) --pgxs) diff --git a/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c b/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c index 28cbb6cce0..8c333c8f99 100644 --- a/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c +++ b/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c @@ -17,6 +17,11 @@ * a file is successfully archived and then the system crashes before * a durable record of the success has been made. * + * This file also demonstrates a basic restore library implementation that + * is roughly equivalent to the following shell command: + * + * cp /path/to/archivedir/%f %p + * * Copyright (c) 2022-2023, PostgreSQL Global Development Group * * IDENTIFICATION @@ -30,6 +35,7 @@ #include <sys/time.h> #include <unistd.h> +#include "access/xlogarchive.h" #include "common/int.h" #include "miscadmin.h" #include "postmaster/pgarch.h" @@ -48,6 +54,8 @@ static bool basic_archive_file(const char *file, const char *path); static void basic_archive_file_internal(const char *file, const char *path); static bool check_archive_directory(char **newval, void **extra, GucSource source); static bool compare_files(const char *file1, const char *file2); +static bool basic_restore_file(const char *file, const char *path, + const char *lastRestartPointFileName); /* * _PG_init @@ -87,6 +95,19 @@ _PG_archive_module_init(ArchiveModuleCallbacks *cb) cb->archive_file_cb = basic_archive_file; } +/* + * _PG_recovery_module_init + * + * Returns the module's restore callback. + */ +void +_PG_recovery_module_init(RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb) +{ + AssertVariableIsOfType(&_PG_recovery_module_init, RecoveryModuleInit); + + cb->restore_cb = basic_restore_file; +} + /* * check_archive_directory * @@ -99,8 +120,8 @@ check_archive_directory(char **newval, void **extra, GucSource source) /* * The default value is an empty string, so we have to accept that value. - * Our check_configured callback also checks for this and prevents - * archiving from proceeding if it is still empty. + * Our check_configured and restore callbacks also check for this and + * prevent archiving or recovery from proceeding if it is still empty. */ if (*newval == NULL || *newval[0] == '\0') return true; @@ -368,3 +389,45 @@ compare_files(const char *file1, const char *file2) return ret; } + +/* + * basic_restore_file + * + * Retrieves one file from the WAL archives. + */ +static bool +basic_restore_file(const char *file, const char *path, + const char *lastRestartPointFileName) +{ + char source[MAXPGPATH]; + struct stat st; + + ereport(DEBUG1, + (errmsg("restoring \"%s\" via basic_archive", file))); + + if (archive_directory == NULL || archive_directory[0] == '\0') + ereport(ERROR, + (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), + errmsg("\"basic_archive.archive_directory\" is not set"))); + + /* + * Check whether the file exists. If not, we return false to indicate that + * there are no more files to restore. + */ + snprintf(source, MAXPGPATH, "%s/%s", archive_directory, file); + if (stat(source, &st) != 0) + { + int elevel = (errno == ENOENT) ? DEBUG1 : ERROR; + + ereport(elevel, + (errcode_for_file_access(), + errmsg("could not stat file \"%s\": %m", source))); + return false; + } + + copy_file(source, unconstify(char *, path)); + + ereport(DEBUG1, + (errmsg("restored \"%s\" via basic_archive", file))); + return true; +} diff --git a/contrib/basic_archive/meson.build b/contrib/basic_archive/meson.build index bc1380e6f6..af4580dea9 100644 --- a/contrib/basic_archive/meson.build +++ b/contrib/basic_archive/meson.build @@ -7,7 +7,7 @@ basic_archive_sources = files( if host_system == 'windows' basic_archive_sources += rc_lib_gen.process(win32ver_rc, extra_args: [ '--NAME', 'basic_archive', - '--FILEDESC', 'basic_archive - basic archive module',]) + '--FILEDESC', 'basic_archive - basic archive and recovery module',]) endif basic_archive = shared_module('basic_archive', @@ -31,4 +31,9 @@ tests += { # which typical runningcheck users do not have (e.g. buildfarm clients). 'runningcheck': false, }, + 'tap': { + 'tests': [ + 't/001_restore.pl', + ], + }, } diff --git a/contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl b/contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ec8767d740 --- /dev/null +++ b/contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl @@ -0,0 +1,44 @@ + +# Copyright (c) 2022, PostgreSQL Global Development Group + +use strict; +use warnings; +use PostgreSQL::Test::Cluster; +use PostgreSQL::Test::Utils; +use Test::More; + +# start a node +my $node = PostgreSQL::Test::Cluster->new('node'); +$node->init(has_archiving => 1, allows_streaming => 1); +my $archive_dir = $node->archive_dir; +$archive_dir =~ s!\\!/!g if $PostgreSQL::Test::Utils::windows_os; +$node->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "archive_command = ''"); +$node->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "archive_library = 'basic_archive'"); +$node->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "basic_archive.archive_directory = '$archive_dir'"); +$node->start; + +# backup the node +my $backup = 'backup'; +$node->backup($backup); + +# generate some new WAL files +$node->safe_psql('postgres', "CREATE TABLE test (a INT);"); +$node->safe_psql('postgres', "SELECT pg_switch_wal();"); +$node->safe_psql('postgres', "INSERT INTO test VALUES (1);"); + +# shut down the node (this should archive all WAL files) +$node->stop; + +# restore from the backup +my $restore = PostgreSQL::Test::Cluster->new('restore'); +$restore->init_from_backup($node, $backup, has_restoring => 1, standby => 0); +$restore->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "restore_command = ''"); +$restore->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "restore_library = 'basic_archive'"); +$restore->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "basic_archive.archive_directory = '$archive_dir'"); +$restore->start; + +# ensure post-backup WAL was replayed +my $result = $restore->safe_psql("postgres", "SELECT count(*) FROM test;"); +is($result, "1", "check restore content"); + +done_testing(); diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml index ef02051f7f..53e657040b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml @@ -1,34 +1,40 @@ <!-- doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml --> <chapter id="archive-modules"> - <title>Archive Modules</title> + <title>Archive and Recovery Modules</title> <indexterm zone="archive-modules"> - <primary>Archive Modules</primary> + <primary>Archive and Recovery Modules</primary> </indexterm> <para> PostgreSQL provides infrastructure to create custom modules for continuous - archiving (see <xref linkend="continuous-archiving"/>). While archiving via - a shell command (i.e., <xref linkend="guc-archive-command"/>) is much - simpler, a custom archive module will often be considerably more robust and - performant. + archiving and recovery (see <xref linkend="continuous-archiving"/>). While + a shell command (e.g., <xref linkend="guc-archive-command"/>, + <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/>) is much simpler, a custom module will + often be considerably more robust and performant. </para> <para> When a custom <xref linkend="guc-archive-library"/> is configured, PostgreSQL will submit completed WAL files to the module, and the server will avoid recycling or removing these WAL files until the module indicates that the files - were successfully archived. It is ultimately up to the module to decide what - to do with each WAL file, but many recommendations are listed at - <xref linkend="backup-archiving-wal"/>. + were successfully archived. When a custom + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> is configured, PostgreSQL will use the + module for recovery actions. It is ultimately up to the module to decide how + to accomplish each task, but some recommendations are listed at + <xref linkend="backup-archiving-wal"/> and + <xref linkend="backup-pitr-recovery"/>. </para> <para> - Archiving modules must at least consist of an initialization function (see - <xref linkend="archive-module-init"/>) and the required callbacks (see - <xref linkend="archive-module-callbacks"/>). However, archive modules are - also permitted to do much more (e.g., declare GUCs and register background - workers). + Archive and recovery modules must at least consist of an initialization + function (see <xref linkend="archive-module-init"/> and + <xref linkend="recovery-module-init"/>) and the required callbacks (see + <xref linkend="archive-module-callbacks"/> and + <xref linkend="recovery-module-callbacks"/>). However, archive and recovery + modules are also permitted to do much more (e.g., declare GUCs and register + background workers). A module may be used for both + <varname>archive_library</varname> and <varname>restore_library</varname>. </para> <para> @@ -37,7 +43,7 @@ </para> <sect1 id="archive-module-init"> - <title>Initialization Functions</title> + <title>Archive Module Initialization Functions</title> <indexterm zone="archive-module-init"> <primary>_PG_archive_module_init</primary> </indexterm> @@ -64,6 +70,12 @@ typedef void (*ArchiveModuleInit) (struct ArchiveModuleCallbacks *cb); Only the <function>archive_file_cb</function> callback is required. The others are optional. </para> + + <note> + <para> + <varname>archive_library</varname> is only loaded in the archiver process. + </para> + </note> </sect1> <sect1 id="archive-module-callbacks"> @@ -129,6 +141,132 @@ typedef bool (*ArchiveFileCB) (const char *file, const char *path); <programlisting> typedef void (*ArchiveShutdownCB) (void); +</programlisting> + </para> + </sect2> + </sect1> + + <sect1 id="recovery-module-init"> + <title>Recovery Module Initialization Functions</title> + <indexterm zone="recovery-module-init"> + <primary>_PG_recovery_module_init</primary> + </indexterm> + <para> + A recovery library is loaded by dynamically loading a shared library with the + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> as the library base name. The normal + library search path is used to locate the library. To provide the required + recovery module callbacks and to indicate that the library is actually a + recovery module, it needs to provide a function named + <function>_PG_recovery_module_init</function>. This function is passed a + struct that needs to be filled with the callback function pointers for + individual actions. + +<programlisting> +typedef struct RecoveryModuleCallbacks +{ + RecoveryRestoreCB restore_cb; + RecoveryArchiveCleanupCB archive_cleanup_cb; + RecoveryEndCB recovery_end_cb; + RecoveryShutdownCB shutdown_cb; +} RecoveryModuleCallbacks; +typedef void (*RecoveryModuleInit) (struct RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb); +</programlisting> + + The <function>restore_cb</function> callback is required for archive + recovery, but it is optional for streaming replication. The others are + always optional. + </para> + + <note> + <para> + <varname>restore_library</varname> is only loaded in the startup and + checkpointer processes and in single-user mode. + </para> + </note> + </sect1> + + <sect1 id="recovery-module-callbacks"> + <title>Recovery Module Callbacks</title> + <para> + The recovery callbacks define the actual behavior of the module. The server + will call them as required to execute recovery actions. + </para> + + <sect2 id="recovery-module-restore"> + <title>Restore Callback</title> + <para> + The <function>restore_cb</function> callback is called to retrieve a single + archived segment of the WAL file series for archive recovery or streaming + replication. + +<programlisting> +typedef bool (*RecoveryRestoreCB) (const char *file, const char *path, const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +</programlisting> + + This callback must return <literal>true</literal> only if the file was + successfully retrieved. If the file is not available in the archives, the + callback must return <literal>false</literal>. + <replaceable>file</replaceable> will contain just the file name + of the WAL file to retrieve, while <replaceable>path</replaceable> contains + the destination's relative path (including the file name). + <replaceable>lastRestartPointFileName</replaceable> will contain the name + of the file containing the last valid restart point. That is the earliest + file that must be kept to allow a restore to be restartable, so this + information can be used to truncate the archive to just the minimum + required to support restarting from the current restore. + <replaceable>lastRestartPointFileName</replaceable> is typically only used + by warm-standby configurations (see <xref linkend="warm-standby"/>). Note + that if multiple standby servers are restoring from the same archive + directory, you will need to ensure that you do not delete WAL files until + they are no longer needed by any of the servers. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="recovery-module-archive-cleanup"> + <title>Archive Cleanup Callback</title> + <para> + The <function>archive_cleanup_cb</function> callback is called at every + restart point and is intended to provide a mechanism for cleaning up old + archived WAL files that are no longer needed by the standby server. + +<programlisting> +typedef void (*RecoveryArchiveCleanupCB) (const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +</programlisting> + + <replaceable>lastRestartPointFileName</replaceable> will contain the name + of the file containing the last valid restart point, like in + <link linkend="recovery-module-restore"><function>restore_cb</function></link>. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="recovery-module-end"> + <title>Recovery End Callback</title> + <para> + The <function>recovery_end_cb</function> callback is called once at the end + of recovery and is intended to provide a mechanism for cleanup following + replication or recovery. + +<programlisting> +typedef void (*RecoveryEndCB) (const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +</programlisting> + + <replaceable>lastRestartPointFileName</replaceable> will contain the name + of the file containing the last valid restart point, like in + <link linkend="recovery-module-restore"><function>restore_cb</function></link>. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="recovery-module-shutdown"> + <title>Shutdown Callback</title> + <para> + The <function>shutdown_cb</function> callback is called when a process that + has loaded the recovery module exits (e.g., after an error) or the value of + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> changes. If no + <function>shutdown_cb</function> is defined, no special action is taken in + these situations. + +<programlisting> +typedef void (*RecoveryShutdownCB) (void); </programlisting> </para> </sect2> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml index 8bab521718..d6d34078fc 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml @@ -1181,9 +1181,27 @@ SELECT * FROM pg_backup_stop(wait_for_archive => true); <para> The key part of all this is to set up a recovery configuration that describes how you want to recover and how far the recovery should - run. The one thing that you absolutely must specify is the <varname>restore_command</varname>, - which tells <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> how to retrieve archived - WAL file segments. Like the <varname>archive_command</varname>, this is + run. The one thing that you absolutely must specify is either + <varname>restore_command</varname> or a <varname>restore_library</varname> + that defines a restore callback, which tells + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> how to retrieve archived WAL file + segments. + </para> + + <para> + Like the <varname>archive_library</varname> parameter, + <varname>restore_library</varname> is a shared library. Since such + libraries are written in <literal>C</literal>, creating your own may + require considerably more effort than writing a shell command. However, + recovery modules can be more performant than restoring via shell, and they + will have access to many useful server resources. For more information + about creating a <varname>restore_library</varname>, see + <xref linkend="archive-modules"/>. + </para> + + <para> + Like the <varname>archive_command</varname>, + <varname>restore_command</varname> is a shell command string. It can contain <literal>%f</literal>, which is replaced by the name of the desired WAL file, and <literal>%p</literal>, which is replaced by the path name to copy the WAL file to. @@ -1202,14 +1220,20 @@ restore_command = 'cp /mnt/server/archivedir/%f %p' </para> <para> - It is important that the command return nonzero exit status on failure. - The command <emphasis>will</emphasis> be called requesting files that are not - present in the archive; it must return nonzero when so asked. This is not - an error condition. An exception is that if the command was terminated by + It is important that the <varname>restore_command</varname> return nonzero + exit status on failure, or, if you are using a + <varname>restore_library</varname>, that the restore function returns + <literal>false</literal> on failure. The command or library + <emphasis>will</emphasis> be called requesting files that are not + present in the archive; it must fail when so asked. This is not + an error condition. An exception is that if the + <varname>restore_command</varname> was terminated by a signal (other than <systemitem>SIGTERM</systemitem>, which is used as part of a database server shutdown) or an error by the shell (such as command not found), then recovery will abort and the server will not start - up. + up. Likewise, if the restore function provided by the + <varname>restore_library</varname> emits an <literal>ERROR</literal> or + <literal>FATAL</literal>, recovery will abort and the server won't start. </para> <para> @@ -1233,7 +1257,8 @@ restore_command = 'cp /mnt/server/archivedir/%f %p' close as possible given the available WAL segments). Therefore, a normal recovery will end with a <quote>file not found</quote> message, the exact text of the error message depending upon your choice of - <varname>restore_command</varname>. You may also see an error message + <varname>restore_command</varname> or <varname>restore_library</varname>. + You may also see an error message at the start of recovery for a file named something like <filename>00000001.history</filename>. This is also normal and does not indicate a problem in simple recovery situations; see diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml index 60f23d2855..11fd670dbc 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml @@ -8,17 +8,20 @@ </indexterm> <para> - <filename>basic_archive</filename> is an example of an archive module. This - module copies completed WAL segment files to the specified directory. This - may not be especially useful, but it can serve as a starting point for - developing your own archive module. For more information about archive - modules, see <xref linkend="archive-modules"/>. + <filename>basic_archive</filename> is an example of an archive and recovery + module. This module copies completed WAL segment files to or from the + specified directory. This may not be especially useful, but it can serve as + a starting point for developing your own archive and recovery modules. For + more information about archive and recovery modules, see + see <xref linkend="archive-modules"/>. </para> <para> - In order to function, this module must be loaded via + For use as an archive module, this module must be loaded via <xref linkend="guc-archive-library"/>, and <xref linkend="guc-archive-mode"/> - must be enabled. + must be enabled. For use as a recovery module, this module must be loaded + via <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/>, and recovery must be enabled (see + <xref linkend="runtime-config-wal-archive-recovery"/>). </para> <sect2 id="basic-archive-configuration-parameters"> @@ -34,11 +37,12 @@ </term> <listitem> <para> - The directory where the server should copy WAL segment files. This - directory must already exist. The default is an empty string, which - effectively halts WAL archiving, but if <xref linkend="guc-archive-mode"/> - is enabled, the server will accumulate WAL segment files in the - expectation that a value will soon be provided. + The directory where the server should copy WAL segment files to or from. + This directory must already exist. The default is an empty string, + which, when used for archiving, effectively halts WAL archival, but if + <xref linkend="guc-archive-mode"/> is enabled, the server will accumulate + WAL segment files in the expectation that a value will soon be provided. + When an empty string is used for recovery, restore will fail. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -46,7 +50,7 @@ <para> These parameters must be set in <filename>postgresql.conf</filename>. - Typical usage might be: + Typical usage as an archive module might be: </para> <programlisting> @@ -61,7 +65,8 @@ basic_archive.archive_directory = '/path/to/archive/directory' <title>Notes</title> <para> - Server crashes may leave temporary files with the prefix + When <filename>basic_archive</filename> is used as an archive module, server + crashes may leave temporary files with the prefix <filename>archtemp</filename> in the archive directory. It is recommended to delete such files before restarting the server after a crash. It is safe to remove such files while the server is running as long as they are unrelated diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml index 77574e2d4e..039d3360ac 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml @@ -3773,7 +3773,8 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' recovery when the end of archived WAL is reached, but will keep trying to continue recovery by connecting to the sending server as specified by the <varname>primary_conninfo</varname> setting and/or by fetching new WAL - segments using <varname>restore_command</varname>. For this mode, the + segments using <varname>restore_command</varname> or + <varname>restore_library</varname>. For this mode, the parameters from this section and <xref linkend="runtime-config-replication-standby"/> are of interest. Parameters from <xref linkend="runtime-config-wal-recovery-target"/> will @@ -3801,7 +3802,8 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' <listitem> <para> The local shell command to execute to retrieve an archived segment of - the WAL file series. This parameter is required for archive recovery, + the WAL file series. Either <varname>restore_command</varname> or + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> is required for archive recovery, but optional for streaming replication. Any <literal>%f</literal> in the string is replaced by the name of the file to retrieve from the archive, @@ -3836,7 +3838,42 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows <para> This parameter can only be set in the <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> - file or on the server command line. + file or on the server command line. It is only used if + <varname>restore_library</varname> is set to an empty string. If both + <varname>restore_command</varname> and + <varname>restore_library</varname> are set, an error will be raised. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry id="guc-restore-library" xreflabel="restore_library"> + <term><varname>restore_library</varname> (<type>string</type>) + <indexterm> + <primary><varname>restore_library</varname> configuration parameter</primary> + </indexterm> + </term> + <listitem> + <para> + The library to use for recovery actions, including retrieving archived + segments of the WAL file series and executing tasks at restartpoints + and at recovery end. Either <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> or + <varname>restore_library</varname> is required for archive recovery, + but optional for streaming replication. If this parameter is set to an + empty string (the default), restoring via shell is enabled, and + <varname>restore_command</varname>, + <varname>archive_cleanup_command</varname> and + <varname>recovery_end_command</varname> are used. If both + <varname>restore_library</varname> and any of + <varname>restore_command</varname>, + <varname>archive_cleanup_command</varname> or + <varname>recovery_end_command</varname> are set, an error will be + raised. Otherwise, the specified shared library is used for recovery. + For more information, see <xref linkend="archive-modules"/>. + </para> + + <para> + This parameter can only be set in the + <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> file or on the server command line. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -3881,7 +3918,10 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows </para> <para> This parameter can only be set in the <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> - file or on the server command line. + file or on the server command line. It is only used if + <varname>restore_library</varname> is set to an empty string. If both + <varname>archive_cleanup_command</varname> and + <varname>restore_library</varname> are set, an error will be raised. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -3910,11 +3950,13 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows </para> <para> This parameter can only be set in the <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> - file or on the server command line. + file or on the server command line. It is only used if + <varname>restore_library</varname> is set to an empty string. If both + <varname>recovery_end_command</varname> and + <varname>restore_library</varname> are set, an error will be raised. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> - </variablelist> </sect2> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml index f180607528..6266e2df7f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml @@ -627,7 +627,8 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <para> In standby mode, the server continuously applies WAL received from the primary server. The standby server can read WAL from a WAL archive - (see <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/>) or directly from the primary + (see <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> and + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/>) or directly from the primary over a TCP connection (streaming replication). The standby server will also attempt to restore any WAL found in the standby cluster's <filename>pg_wal</filename> directory. That typically happens after a server @@ -638,9 +639,11 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <para> At startup, the standby begins by restoring all WAL available in the - archive location, calling <varname>restore_command</varname>. Once it - reaches the end of WAL available there and <varname>restore_command</varname> - fails, it tries to restore any WAL available in the <filename>pg_wal</filename> directory. + archive location, either by calling <varname>restore_command</varname> or + by executing the <varname>restore_library</varname>'s restore callback. + Once it reaches the end of WAL available there and + <varname>restore_command</varname> or the restore callback fails, it tries + to restore any WAL available in the <filename>pg_wal</filename> directory. If that fails, and streaming replication has been configured, the standby tries to connect to the primary server and start streaming WAL from the last valid record found in archive or <filename>pg_wal</filename>. If that fails @@ -698,7 +701,8 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. server (see <xref linkend="backup-pitr-recovery"/>). Create a file <link linkend="file-standby-signal"><filename>standby.signal</filename></link><indexterm><primary>standby.signal</primary></indexterm> in the standby's cluster data - directory. Set <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> to a simple command to copy files from + directory. Set <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> or + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> to copy files from the WAL archive. If you plan to have multiple standby servers for high availability purposes, make sure that <varname>recovery_target_timeline</varname> is set to <literal>latest</literal> (the default), to make the standby server follow the timeline change @@ -707,7 +711,8 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <note> <para> - <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> should return immediately + <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> and restore callbacks provided by + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> should return immediately if the file does not exist; the server will retry the command again if necessary. </para> @@ -731,8 +736,10 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <para> If you're using a WAL archive, its size can be minimized using the <xref - linkend="guc-archive-cleanup-command"/> parameter to remove files that are no - longer required by the standby server. + linkend="guc-archive-cleanup-command"/> parameter or the + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/>'s + <function>archive_cleanup_cb</function> callback function to remove files + that are no longer required by the standby server. The <application>pg_archivecleanup</application> utility is designed specifically to be used with <varname>archive_cleanup_command</varname> in typical single-standby configurations, see <xref linkend="pgarchivecleanup"/>. diff --git a/src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c b/src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c index 68bf6e8556..eb101b51fb 100644 --- a/src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c +++ b/src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c @@ -3,7 +3,8 @@ * shell_restore.c * * These recovery functions use a user-specified shell command (e.g., the - * restore_command GUC). + * restore_command GUC). It is used as the default, but other modules may + * define their own recovery logic. * * Copyright (c) 2022, PostgreSQL Global Development Group * @@ -23,11 +24,25 @@ #include "storage/ipc.h" #include "utils/wait_event.h" +static bool shell_restore(const char *file, const char *path, + const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +static void shell_archive_cleanup(const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +static void shell_recovery_end(const char *lastRestartPointFileName); static bool ExecuteRecoveryCommand(const char *command, const char *commandName, bool failOnSignal, bool exitOnSigterm, uint32 wait_event_info, int fail_elevel); +void +shell_restore_init(RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb) +{ + AssertVariableIsOfType(&shell_restore_init, RecoveryModuleInit); + + cb->restore_cb = shell_restore; + cb->archive_cleanup_cb = shell_archive_cleanup; + cb->recovery_end_cb = shell_recovery_end; +} + bool shell_restore(const char *file, const char *path, const char *lastRestartPointFileName) @@ -70,7 +85,7 @@ shell_restore(const char *file, const char *path, return ret; } -void +static void shell_archive_cleanup(const char *lastRestartPointFileName) { char *cmd; @@ -83,7 +98,7 @@ shell_archive_cleanup(const char *lastRestartPointFileName) pfree(cmd); } -void +static void shell_recovery_end(const char *lastRestartPointFileName) { char *cmd; diff --git a/src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c b/src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c index 8f47fb7570..ae537cd87f 100644 --- a/src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c +++ b/src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c @@ -4884,15 +4884,16 @@ static void CleanupAfterArchiveRecovery(TimeLineID EndOfLogTLI, XLogRecPtr EndOfLog, TimeLineID newTLI) { + /* - * Execute the recovery_end_command, if any. + * Execute the recovery-end callback, if any. */ - if (recoveryEndCommand && strcmp(recoveryEndCommand, "") != 0) + if (RecoveryContext.recovery_end_cb) { char lastRestartPointFname[MAXFNAMELEN]; GetOldestRestartPointFileName(lastRestartPointFname); - shell_recovery_end(lastRestartPointFname); + RecoveryContext.recovery_end_cb(lastRestartPointFname); } /* @@ -7307,14 +7308,14 @@ CreateRestartPoint(int flags) timestamptz_to_str(xtime)) : 0)); /* - * Finally, execute archive_cleanup_command, if any. + * Execute the archive-cleanup callback, if any. */ - if (archiveCleanupCommand && strcmp(archiveCleanupCommand, "") != 0) + if (RecoveryContext.archive_cleanup_cb) { char lastRestartPointFname[MAXFNAMELEN]; GetOldestRestartPointFileName(lastRestartPointFname); - shell_archive_cleanup(lastRestartPointFname); + RecoveryContext.archive_cleanup_cb(lastRestartPointFname); } return true; diff --git a/src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c b/src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c index b5cb060d55..fdab7dad43 100644 --- a/src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c +++ b/src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c @@ -22,7 +22,9 @@ #include "access/xlog.h" #include "access/xlog_internal.h" #include "access/xlogarchive.h" +#include "access/xlogrecovery.h" #include "common/archive.h" +#include "fmgr.h" #include "miscadmin.h" #include "pgstat.h" #include "postmaster/startup.h" @@ -32,6 +34,11 @@ #include "storage/ipc.h" #include "storage/lwlock.h" +/* + * Global context for recovery-related callbacks. + */ +RecoveryModuleCallbacks RecoveryContext; + /* * Attempt to retrieve the specified file from off-line archival storage. * If successful, fill "path" with its complete path (note that this will be @@ -71,7 +78,7 @@ RestoreArchivedFile(char *path, const char *xlogfname, goto not_available; /* In standby mode, restore_command might not be supplied */ - if (recoveryRestoreCommand == NULL || strcmp(recoveryRestoreCommand, "") == 0) + if (RecoveryContext.restore_cb == NULL) goto not_available; /* @@ -149,14 +156,15 @@ RestoreArchivedFile(char *path, const char *xlogfname, XLogFileName(lastRestartPointFname, 0, 0L, wal_segment_size); /* - * Check signals before restore command and reset afterwards. + * Check signals before restore callback and reset afterwards. */ PreRestoreCommand(); /* * Copy xlog from archival storage to XLOGDIR */ - ret = shell_restore(xlogfname, xlogpath, lastRestartPointFname); + ret = RecoveryContext.restore_cb(xlogfname, xlogpath, + lastRestartPointFname); PostRestoreCommand(); @@ -603,3 +611,59 @@ XLogArchiveCleanup(const char *xlog) unlink(archiveStatusPath); /* should we complain about failure? */ } + +/* + * Loads all the recovery callbacks into our global RecoveryContext. The + * caller is responsible for validating the combination of library/command + * parameters that are set (e.g., restore_command and restore_library cannot + * both be set). + */ +void +LoadRecoveryCallbacks(void) +{ + RecoveryModuleInit init; + + /* + * If the shell command is enabled, use our special initialization + * function. Otherwise, load the library and call its + * _PG_recovery_module_init(). + */ + if (restoreLibrary[0] == '\0') + init = shell_restore_init; + else + init = (RecoveryModuleInit) + load_external_function(restoreLibrary, "_PG_recovery_module_init", + false, NULL); + + if (init == NULL) + ereport(ERROR, + (errmsg("recovery modules have to define the symbol " + "_PG_recovery_module_init"))); + + memset(&RecoveryContext, 0, sizeof(RecoveryModuleCallbacks)); + (*init) (&RecoveryContext); + + /* + * If using shell commands, remove callbacks for any commands that are not + * set. + */ + if (restoreLibrary[0] == '\0') + { + if (recoveryRestoreCommand[0] == '\0') + RecoveryContext.restore_cb = NULL; + if (archiveCleanupCommand[0] == '\0') + RecoveryContext.archive_cleanup_cb = NULL; + if (recoveryEndCommand[0] == '\0') + RecoveryContext.recovery_end_cb = NULL; + } +} + +/* + * Call the shutdown callback of the loaded recovery module, if defined. + */ +void +call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb(int code, Datum arg) +{ + if (RecoveryContext.shutdown_cb) + RecoveryContext.shutdown_cb(); +} diff --git a/src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c b/src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c index 5e65785306..db0cd4469a 100644 --- a/src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c +++ b/src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c @@ -80,6 +80,7 @@ const struct config_enum_entry recovery_target_action_options[] = { /* options formerly taken from recovery.conf for archive recovery */ char *recoveryRestoreCommand = NULL; +char *restoreLibrary = NULL; char *recoveryEndCommand = NULL; char *archiveCleanupCommand = NULL; RecoveryTargetType recoveryTarget = RECOVERY_TARGET_UNSET; @@ -1053,24 +1054,37 @@ validateRecoveryParameters(void) if (!ArchiveRecoveryRequested) return; + /* + * Check for invalid combinations of the command/library parameters and + * load the callbacks. + */ + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + recoveryRestoreCommand, "restore_command"); + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + recoveryEndCommand, "recovery_end_command"); + before_shmem_exit(call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb, 0); + LoadRecoveryCallbacks(); + /* * Check for compulsory parameters */ if (StandbyModeRequested) { if ((PrimaryConnInfo == NULL || strcmp(PrimaryConnInfo, "") == 0) && - (recoveryRestoreCommand == NULL || strcmp(recoveryRestoreCommand, "") == 0)) + RecoveryContext.restore_cb == NULL) ereport(WARNING, - (errmsg("specified neither primary_conninfo nor restore_command"), - errhint("The database server will regularly poll the pg_wal subdirectory to check for files placed there."))); + (errmsg("specified neither primary_conninfo nor restore_command " + "nor a restore_library that defines a restore callback"), + errhint("The database server will regularly poll the pg_wal " + "subdirectory to check for files placed there."))); } else { - if (recoveryRestoreCommand == NULL || - strcmp(recoveryRestoreCommand, "") == 0) + if (RecoveryContext.restore_cb == NULL) ereport(FATAL, (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), - errmsg("must specify restore_command when standby mode is not enabled"))); + errmsg("must specify restore_command or a restore_library that defines " + "a restore callback when standby mode is not enabled"))); } /* diff --git a/src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c b/src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c index de0bbbfa79..6350fd0b83 100644 --- a/src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c +++ b/src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c @@ -38,6 +38,7 @@ #include "access/xlog.h" #include "access/xlog_internal.h" +#include "access/xlogarchive.h" #include "access/xlogrecovery.h" #include "libpq/pqsignal.h" #include "miscadmin.h" @@ -222,6 +223,16 @@ CheckpointerMain(void) */ before_shmem_exit(pgstat_before_server_shutdown, 0); + /* + * Check for invalid combinations of the command/library parameters and + * load the callbacks. We do this before setting up the exception handler + * so that any problems result in a server crash shortly after startup. + */ + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + archiveCleanupCommand, "archive_cleanup_command"); + before_shmem_exit(call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb, 0); + LoadRecoveryCallbacks(); + /* * Create a memory context that we will do all our work in. We do this so * that we can reset the context during error recovery and thereby avoid @@ -548,6 +559,9 @@ HandleCheckpointerInterrupts(void) if (ConfigReloadPending) { + char *prevRestoreLibrary = pstrdup(restoreLibrary); + char *prevArchiveCleanupCommand = pstrdup(archiveCleanupCommand); + ConfigReloadPending = false; ProcessConfigFile(PGC_SIGHUP); @@ -563,6 +577,18 @@ HandleCheckpointerInterrupts(void) * because of SIGHUP. */ UpdateSharedMemoryConfig(); + + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + archiveCleanupCommand, "archive_cleanup_command"); + if (strcmp(prevRestoreLibrary, restoreLibrary) != 0 || + strcmp(prevArchiveCleanupCommand, archiveCleanupCommand) != 0) + { + call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb(0, (Datum) 0); + LoadRecoveryCallbacks(); + } + + pfree(prevRestoreLibrary); + pfree(prevArchiveCleanupCommand); } if (ShutdownRequestPending) { diff --git a/src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c b/src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c index 8ecdb9ca23..8e91f2d70f 100644 --- a/src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c +++ b/src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c @@ -831,11 +831,8 @@ LoadArchiveLibrary(void) { ArchiveModuleInit archive_init; - if (XLogArchiveLibrary[0] != '\0' && XLogArchiveCommand[0] != '\0') - ereport(ERROR, - (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), - errmsg("both archive_command and archive_library set"), - errdetail("Only one of archive_command, archive_library may be set."))); + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(XLogArchiveLibrary, "archive_library", + XLogArchiveCommand, "archive_command"); memset(&ArchiveContext, 0, sizeof(ArchiveModuleCallbacks)); diff --git a/src/backend/postmaster/startup.c b/src/backend/postmaster/startup.c index 8786186898..f9ff2b5583 100644 --- a/src/backend/postmaster/startup.c +++ b/src/backend/postmaster/startup.c @@ -20,6 +20,7 @@ #include "postgres.h" #include "access/xlog.h" +#include "access/xlogarchive.h" #include "access/xlogrecovery.h" #include "access/xlogutils.h" #include "libpq/pqsignal.h" @@ -133,13 +134,17 @@ StartupProcShutdownHandler(SIGNAL_ARGS) * Re-read the config file. * * If one of the critical walreceiver options has changed, flag xlog.c - * to restart it. + * to restart it. Also, check for invalid combinations of the command/library + * parameters and reload the recovery callbacks if necessary. */ static void StartupRereadConfig(void) { char *conninfo = pstrdup(PrimaryConnInfo); char *slotname = pstrdup(PrimarySlotName); + char *prevRestoreLibrary = pstrdup(restoreLibrary); + char *prevRestoreCommand = pstrdup(recoveryRestoreCommand); + char *prevRecoveryEndCommand = pstrdup(recoveryEndCommand); bool tempSlot = wal_receiver_create_temp_slot; bool conninfoChanged; bool slotnameChanged; @@ -161,6 +166,22 @@ StartupRereadConfig(void) if (conninfoChanged || slotnameChanged || tempSlotChanged) StartupRequestWalReceiverRestart(); + + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + recoveryRestoreCommand, "restore_command"); + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + recoveryEndCommand, "recovery_end_command"); + if (strcmp(prevRestoreLibrary, restoreLibrary) != 0 || + strcmp(prevRestoreCommand, recoveryRestoreCommand) != 0 || + strcmp(prevRecoveryEndCommand, recoveryEndCommand) != 0) + { + call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb(0, (Datum) 0); + LoadRecoveryCallbacks(); + } + + pfree(prevRestoreLibrary); + pfree(prevRestoreCommand); + pfree(prevRecoveryEndCommand); } /* Handle various signals that might be sent to the startup process */ diff --git a/src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c b/src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c index d52069f446..7858e9a649 100644 --- a/src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c +++ b/src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c @@ -6880,3 +6880,17 @@ call_enum_check_hook(struct config_enum *conf, int *newval, void **extra, return true; } + +/* + * ERROR if both parameters are set. + */ +void +CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(const char *p1val, const char *p1name, + const char *p2val, const char *p2name) +{ + if (p1val[0] != '\0' && p2val[0] != '\0') + ereport(ERROR, + (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), + errmsg("both %s and %s set", p1name, p2name), + errdetail("Only one of %s, %s may be set.", p1name, p2name))); +} diff --git a/src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c b/src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c index 5025e80f89..a8a516b0c6 100644 --- a/src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c +++ b/src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c @@ -3776,6 +3776,16 @@ struct config_string ConfigureNamesString[] = NULL, NULL, NULL }, + { + {"restore_library", PGC_SIGHUP, WAL_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY, + gettext_noop("Sets the library that will be called for recovery actions."), + NULL + }, + &restoreLibrary, + "", + NULL, NULL, NULL + }, + { {"archive_cleanup_command", PGC_SIGHUP, WAL_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY, gettext_noop("Sets the shell command that will be executed at every restart point."), diff --git a/src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample b/src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample index 4cceda4162..38fb3e0823 100644 --- a/src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample +++ b/src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample @@ -269,6 +269,7 @@ # placeholders: %p = path of file to restore # %f = file name only # e.g. 'cp /mnt/server/archivedir/%f %p' +#restore_library = '' # library to use for recovery actions #archive_cleanup_command = '' # command to execute at every restartpoint #recovery_end_command = '' # command to execute at completion of recovery diff --git a/src/include/access/xlog_internal.h b/src/include/access/xlog_internal.h index 59fc7bc105..756f0898b5 100644 --- a/src/include/access/xlog_internal.h +++ b/src/include/access/xlog_internal.h @@ -400,5 +400,6 @@ extern PGDLLIMPORT bool ArchiveRecoveryRequested; extern PGDLLIMPORT bool InArchiveRecovery; extern PGDLLIMPORT bool StandbyMode; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *recoveryRestoreCommand; +extern PGDLLIMPORT char *restoreLibrary; #endif /* XLOG_INTERNAL_H */ diff --git a/src/include/access/xlogarchive.h b/src/include/access/xlogarchive.h index 299304703e..71c9b88165 100644 --- a/src/include/access/xlogarchive.h +++ b/src/include/access/xlogarchive.h @@ -30,9 +30,45 @@ extern bool XLogArchiveIsReady(const char *xlog); extern bool XLogArchiveIsReadyOrDone(const char *xlog); extern void XLogArchiveCleanup(const char *xlog); -extern bool shell_restore(const char *file, const char *path, - const char *lastRestartPointFileName); -extern void shell_archive_cleanup(const char *lastRestartPointFileName); -extern void shell_recovery_end(const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +/* + * Recovery module callbacks + * + * These callback functions should be defined by recovery libraries and + * returned via _PG_recovery_module_init(). For more information about the + * purpose of each callback, refer to the recovery modules documentation. + */ +typedef bool (*RecoveryRestoreCB) (const char *file, const char *path, + const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +typedef void (*RecoveryArchiveCleanupCB) (const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +typedef void (*RecoveryEndCB) (const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +typedef void (*RecoveryShutdownCB) (void); + +typedef struct RecoveryModuleCallbacks +{ + RecoveryRestoreCB restore_cb; + RecoveryArchiveCleanupCB archive_cleanup_cb; + RecoveryEndCB recovery_end_cb; + RecoveryShutdownCB shutdown_cb; +} RecoveryModuleCallbacks; + +extern RecoveryModuleCallbacks RecoveryContext; + +/* + * Type of the shared library symbol _PG_recovery_module_init that is looked up + * when loading a recovery library. + */ +typedef void (*RecoveryModuleInit) (RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb); + +extern PGDLLEXPORT void _PG_recovery_module_init(RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb); + +extern void LoadRecoveryCallbacks(void); +extern void call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb(int code, Datum arg); + +/* + * Since the logic for recovery via a shell command is in the core server and + * does not need to be loaded via a shared library, it has a special + * initialization function. + */ +extern void shell_restore_init(RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb); #endif /* XLOG_ARCHIVE_H */ diff --git a/src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h b/src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h index 47c29350f5..35d1d09374 100644 --- a/src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h +++ b/src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h @@ -55,6 +55,7 @@ extern PGDLLIMPORT int recovery_min_apply_delay; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *PrimaryConnInfo; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *PrimarySlotName; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *recoveryRestoreCommand; +extern PGDLLIMPORT char *restoreLibrary; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *recoveryEndCommand; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *archiveCleanupCommand; diff --git a/src/include/utils/guc.h b/src/include/utils/guc.h index ba89d013e6..947597247f 100644 --- a/src/include/utils/guc.h +++ b/src/include/utils/guc.h @@ -404,6 +404,8 @@ extern void *guc_malloc(int elevel, size_t size); extern pg_nodiscard void *guc_realloc(int elevel, void *old, size_t size); extern char *guc_strdup(int elevel, const char *src); extern void guc_free(void *ptr); +extern void CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(const char *p1val, const char *p1name, + const char *p2val, const char *p2name); #ifdef EXEC_BACKEND extern void write_nondefault_variables(GucContext context); -- 2.25.1 --pWyiEgJYm5f9v55/-- ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 17+ messages in thread
* [PATCH v7 2/2] Allow recovery via loadable modules. @ 2022-12-10 03:40 Nathan Bossart <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 17+ messages in thread From: Nathan Bossart @ 2022-12-10 03:40 UTC (permalink / raw) This adds the restore_library parameter to allow archive recovery via a loadable module, rather than running shell commands. --- contrib/basic_archive/Makefile | 4 +- contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c | 67 ++++++- contrib/basic_archive/meson.build | 7 +- contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl | 44 +++++ doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml | 168 ++++++++++++++++-- doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml | 43 ++++- doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml | 33 ++-- doc/src/sgml/config.sgml | 54 +++++- doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml | 23 ++- src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c | 21 ++- src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c | 13 +- src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c | 70 +++++++- src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c | 26 ++- src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c | 26 +++ src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c | 7 +- src/backend/postmaster/startup.c | 23 ++- src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c | 14 ++ src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c | 10 ++ src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample | 1 + src/include/access/xlog_internal.h | 1 + src/include/access/xlogarchive.h | 44 ++++- src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h | 1 + src/include/utils/guc.h | 2 + 23 files changed, 618 insertions(+), 84 deletions(-) create mode 100644 contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl diff --git a/contrib/basic_archive/Makefile b/contrib/basic_archive/Makefile index 55d299d650..487dc563f3 100644 --- a/contrib/basic_archive/Makefile +++ b/contrib/basic_archive/Makefile @@ -1,7 +1,7 @@ # contrib/basic_archive/Makefile MODULES = basic_archive -PGFILEDESC = "basic_archive - basic archive module" +PGFILEDESC = "basic_archive - basic archive and recovery module" REGRESS = basic_archive REGRESS_OPTS = --temp-config $(top_srcdir)/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.conf @@ -9,6 +9,8 @@ REGRESS_OPTS = --temp-config $(top_srcdir)/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c # which typical installcheck users do not have (e.g. buildfarm clients). NO_INSTALLCHECK = 1 +TAP_TESTS = 1 + ifdef USE_PGXS PG_CONFIG = pg_config PGXS := $(shell $(PG_CONFIG) --pgxs) diff --git a/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c b/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c index 28cbb6cce0..8c333c8f99 100644 --- a/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c +++ b/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c @@ -17,6 +17,11 @@ * a file is successfully archived and then the system crashes before * a durable record of the success has been made. * + * This file also demonstrates a basic restore library implementation that + * is roughly equivalent to the following shell command: + * + * cp /path/to/archivedir/%f %p + * * Copyright (c) 2022-2023, PostgreSQL Global Development Group * * IDENTIFICATION @@ -30,6 +35,7 @@ #include <sys/time.h> #include <unistd.h> +#include "access/xlogarchive.h" #include "common/int.h" #include "miscadmin.h" #include "postmaster/pgarch.h" @@ -48,6 +54,8 @@ static bool basic_archive_file(const char *file, const char *path); static void basic_archive_file_internal(const char *file, const char *path); static bool check_archive_directory(char **newval, void **extra, GucSource source); static bool compare_files(const char *file1, const char *file2); +static bool basic_restore_file(const char *file, const char *path, + const char *lastRestartPointFileName); /* * _PG_init @@ -87,6 +95,19 @@ _PG_archive_module_init(ArchiveModuleCallbacks *cb) cb->archive_file_cb = basic_archive_file; } +/* + * _PG_recovery_module_init + * + * Returns the module's restore callback. + */ +void +_PG_recovery_module_init(RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb) +{ + AssertVariableIsOfType(&_PG_recovery_module_init, RecoveryModuleInit); + + cb->restore_cb = basic_restore_file; +} + /* * check_archive_directory * @@ -99,8 +120,8 @@ check_archive_directory(char **newval, void **extra, GucSource source) /* * The default value is an empty string, so we have to accept that value. - * Our check_configured callback also checks for this and prevents - * archiving from proceeding if it is still empty. + * Our check_configured and restore callbacks also check for this and + * prevent archiving or recovery from proceeding if it is still empty. */ if (*newval == NULL || *newval[0] == '\0') return true; @@ -368,3 +389,45 @@ compare_files(const char *file1, const char *file2) return ret; } + +/* + * basic_restore_file + * + * Retrieves one file from the WAL archives. + */ +static bool +basic_restore_file(const char *file, const char *path, + const char *lastRestartPointFileName) +{ + char source[MAXPGPATH]; + struct stat st; + + ereport(DEBUG1, + (errmsg("restoring \"%s\" via basic_archive", file))); + + if (archive_directory == NULL || archive_directory[0] == '\0') + ereport(ERROR, + (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), + errmsg("\"basic_archive.archive_directory\" is not set"))); + + /* + * Check whether the file exists. If not, we return false to indicate that + * there are no more files to restore. + */ + snprintf(source, MAXPGPATH, "%s/%s", archive_directory, file); + if (stat(source, &st) != 0) + { + int elevel = (errno == ENOENT) ? DEBUG1 : ERROR; + + ereport(elevel, + (errcode_for_file_access(), + errmsg("could not stat file \"%s\": %m", source))); + return false; + } + + copy_file(source, unconstify(char *, path)); + + ereport(DEBUG1, + (errmsg("restored \"%s\" via basic_archive", file))); + return true; +} diff --git a/contrib/basic_archive/meson.build b/contrib/basic_archive/meson.build index bc1380e6f6..af4580dea9 100644 --- a/contrib/basic_archive/meson.build +++ b/contrib/basic_archive/meson.build @@ -7,7 +7,7 @@ basic_archive_sources = files( if host_system == 'windows' basic_archive_sources += rc_lib_gen.process(win32ver_rc, extra_args: [ '--NAME', 'basic_archive', - '--FILEDESC', 'basic_archive - basic archive module',]) + '--FILEDESC', 'basic_archive - basic archive and recovery module',]) endif basic_archive = shared_module('basic_archive', @@ -31,4 +31,9 @@ tests += { # which typical runningcheck users do not have (e.g. buildfarm clients). 'runningcheck': false, }, + 'tap': { + 'tests': [ + 't/001_restore.pl', + ], + }, } diff --git a/contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl b/contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ec8767d740 --- /dev/null +++ b/contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl @@ -0,0 +1,44 @@ + +# Copyright (c) 2022, PostgreSQL Global Development Group + +use strict; +use warnings; +use PostgreSQL::Test::Cluster; +use PostgreSQL::Test::Utils; +use Test::More; + +# start a node +my $node = PostgreSQL::Test::Cluster->new('node'); +$node->init(has_archiving => 1, allows_streaming => 1); +my $archive_dir = $node->archive_dir; +$archive_dir =~ s!\\!/!g if $PostgreSQL::Test::Utils::windows_os; +$node->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "archive_command = ''"); +$node->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "archive_library = 'basic_archive'"); +$node->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "basic_archive.archive_directory = '$archive_dir'"); +$node->start; + +# backup the node +my $backup = 'backup'; +$node->backup($backup); + +# generate some new WAL files +$node->safe_psql('postgres', "CREATE TABLE test (a INT);"); +$node->safe_psql('postgres', "SELECT pg_switch_wal();"); +$node->safe_psql('postgres', "INSERT INTO test VALUES (1);"); + +# shut down the node (this should archive all WAL files) +$node->stop; + +# restore from the backup +my $restore = PostgreSQL::Test::Cluster->new('restore'); +$restore->init_from_backup($node, $backup, has_restoring => 1, standby => 0); +$restore->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "restore_command = ''"); +$restore->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "restore_library = 'basic_archive'"); +$restore->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "basic_archive.archive_directory = '$archive_dir'"); +$restore->start; + +# ensure post-backup WAL was replayed +my $result = $restore->safe_psql("postgres", "SELECT count(*) FROM test;"); +is($result, "1", "check restore content"); + +done_testing(); diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml index ef02051f7f..53e657040b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml @@ -1,34 +1,40 @@ <!-- doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml --> <chapter id="archive-modules"> - <title>Archive Modules</title> + <title>Archive and Recovery Modules</title> <indexterm zone="archive-modules"> - <primary>Archive Modules</primary> + <primary>Archive and Recovery Modules</primary> </indexterm> <para> PostgreSQL provides infrastructure to create custom modules for continuous - archiving (see <xref linkend="continuous-archiving"/>). While archiving via - a shell command (i.e., <xref linkend="guc-archive-command"/>) is much - simpler, a custom archive module will often be considerably more robust and - performant. + archiving and recovery (see <xref linkend="continuous-archiving"/>). While + a shell command (e.g., <xref linkend="guc-archive-command"/>, + <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/>) is much simpler, a custom module will + often be considerably more robust and performant. </para> <para> When a custom <xref linkend="guc-archive-library"/> is configured, PostgreSQL will submit completed WAL files to the module, and the server will avoid recycling or removing these WAL files until the module indicates that the files - were successfully archived. It is ultimately up to the module to decide what - to do with each WAL file, but many recommendations are listed at - <xref linkend="backup-archiving-wal"/>. + were successfully archived. When a custom + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> is configured, PostgreSQL will use the + module for recovery actions. It is ultimately up to the module to decide how + to accomplish each task, but some recommendations are listed at + <xref linkend="backup-archiving-wal"/> and + <xref linkend="backup-pitr-recovery"/>. </para> <para> - Archiving modules must at least consist of an initialization function (see - <xref linkend="archive-module-init"/>) and the required callbacks (see - <xref linkend="archive-module-callbacks"/>). However, archive modules are - also permitted to do much more (e.g., declare GUCs and register background - workers). + Archive and recovery modules must at least consist of an initialization + function (see <xref linkend="archive-module-init"/> and + <xref linkend="recovery-module-init"/>) and the required callbacks (see + <xref linkend="archive-module-callbacks"/> and + <xref linkend="recovery-module-callbacks"/>). However, archive and recovery + modules are also permitted to do much more (e.g., declare GUCs and register + background workers). A module may be used for both + <varname>archive_library</varname> and <varname>restore_library</varname>. </para> <para> @@ -37,7 +43,7 @@ </para> <sect1 id="archive-module-init"> - <title>Initialization Functions</title> + <title>Archive Module Initialization Functions</title> <indexterm zone="archive-module-init"> <primary>_PG_archive_module_init</primary> </indexterm> @@ -64,6 +70,12 @@ typedef void (*ArchiveModuleInit) (struct ArchiveModuleCallbacks *cb); Only the <function>archive_file_cb</function> callback is required. The others are optional. </para> + + <note> + <para> + <varname>archive_library</varname> is only loaded in the archiver process. + </para> + </note> </sect1> <sect1 id="archive-module-callbacks"> @@ -129,6 +141,132 @@ typedef bool (*ArchiveFileCB) (const char *file, const char *path); <programlisting> typedef void (*ArchiveShutdownCB) (void); +</programlisting> + </para> + </sect2> + </sect1> + + <sect1 id="recovery-module-init"> + <title>Recovery Module Initialization Functions</title> + <indexterm zone="recovery-module-init"> + <primary>_PG_recovery_module_init</primary> + </indexterm> + <para> + A recovery library is loaded by dynamically loading a shared library with the + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> as the library base name. The normal + library search path is used to locate the library. To provide the required + recovery module callbacks and to indicate that the library is actually a + recovery module, it needs to provide a function named + <function>_PG_recovery_module_init</function>. This function is passed a + struct that needs to be filled with the callback function pointers for + individual actions. + +<programlisting> +typedef struct RecoveryModuleCallbacks +{ + RecoveryRestoreCB restore_cb; + RecoveryArchiveCleanupCB archive_cleanup_cb; + RecoveryEndCB recovery_end_cb; + RecoveryShutdownCB shutdown_cb; +} RecoveryModuleCallbacks; +typedef void (*RecoveryModuleInit) (struct RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb); +</programlisting> + + The <function>restore_cb</function> callback is required for archive + recovery, but it is optional for streaming replication. The others are + always optional. + </para> + + <note> + <para> + <varname>restore_library</varname> is only loaded in the startup and + checkpointer processes and in single-user mode. + </para> + </note> + </sect1> + + <sect1 id="recovery-module-callbacks"> + <title>Recovery Module Callbacks</title> + <para> + The recovery callbacks define the actual behavior of the module. The server + will call them as required to execute recovery actions. + </para> + + <sect2 id="recovery-module-restore"> + <title>Restore Callback</title> + <para> + The <function>restore_cb</function> callback is called to retrieve a single + archived segment of the WAL file series for archive recovery or streaming + replication. + +<programlisting> +typedef bool (*RecoveryRestoreCB) (const char *file, const char *path, const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +</programlisting> + + This callback must return <literal>true</literal> only if the file was + successfully retrieved. If the file is not available in the archives, the + callback must return <literal>false</literal>. + <replaceable>file</replaceable> will contain just the file name + of the WAL file to retrieve, while <replaceable>path</replaceable> contains + the destination's relative path (including the file name). + <replaceable>lastRestartPointFileName</replaceable> will contain the name + of the file containing the last valid restart point. That is the earliest + file that must be kept to allow a restore to be restartable, so this + information can be used to truncate the archive to just the minimum + required to support restarting from the current restore. + <replaceable>lastRestartPointFileName</replaceable> is typically only used + by warm-standby configurations (see <xref linkend="warm-standby"/>). Note + that if multiple standby servers are restoring from the same archive + directory, you will need to ensure that you do not delete WAL files until + they are no longer needed by any of the servers. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="recovery-module-archive-cleanup"> + <title>Archive Cleanup Callback</title> + <para> + The <function>archive_cleanup_cb</function> callback is called at every + restart point and is intended to provide a mechanism for cleaning up old + archived WAL files that are no longer needed by the standby server. + +<programlisting> +typedef void (*RecoveryArchiveCleanupCB) (const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +</programlisting> + + <replaceable>lastRestartPointFileName</replaceable> will contain the name + of the file containing the last valid restart point, like in + <link linkend="recovery-module-restore"><function>restore_cb</function></link>. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="recovery-module-end"> + <title>Recovery End Callback</title> + <para> + The <function>recovery_end_cb</function> callback is called once at the end + of recovery and is intended to provide a mechanism for cleanup following + replication or recovery. + +<programlisting> +typedef void (*RecoveryEndCB) (const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +</programlisting> + + <replaceable>lastRestartPointFileName</replaceable> will contain the name + of the file containing the last valid restart point, like in + <link linkend="recovery-module-restore"><function>restore_cb</function></link>. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="recovery-module-shutdown"> + <title>Shutdown Callback</title> + <para> + The <function>shutdown_cb</function> callback is called when a process that + has loaded the recovery module exits (e.g., after an error) or the value of + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> changes. If no + <function>shutdown_cb</function> is defined, no special action is taken in + these situations. + +<programlisting> +typedef void (*RecoveryShutdownCB) (void); </programlisting> </para> </sect2> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml index be05a33205..f44135061d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml @@ -1180,9 +1180,27 @@ SELECT * FROM pg_backup_stop(wait_for_archive => true); <para> The key part of all this is to set up a recovery configuration that describes how you want to recover and how far the recovery should - run. The one thing that you absolutely must specify is the <varname>restore_command</varname>, - which tells <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> how to retrieve archived - WAL file segments. Like the <varname>archive_command</varname>, this is + run. The one thing that you absolutely must specify is either + <varname>restore_command</varname> or a <varname>restore_library</varname> + that defines a restore callback, which tells + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> how to retrieve archived WAL file + segments. + </para> + + <para> + Like the <varname>archive_library</varname> parameter, + <varname>restore_library</varname> is a shared library. Since such + libraries are written in <literal>C</literal>, creating your own may + require considerably more effort than writing a shell command. However, + recovery modules can be more performant than restoring via shell, and they + will have access to many useful server resources. For more information + about creating a <varname>restore_library</varname>, see + <xref linkend="archive-modules"/>. + </para> + + <para> + Like the <varname>archive_command</varname>, + <varname>restore_command</varname> is a shell command string. It can contain <literal>%f</literal>, which is replaced by the name of the desired WAL file, and <literal>%p</literal>, which is replaced by the path name to copy the WAL file to. @@ -1201,14 +1219,20 @@ restore_command = 'cp /mnt/server/archivedir/%f %p' </para> <para> - It is important that the command return nonzero exit status on failure. - The command <emphasis>will</emphasis> be called requesting files that are not - present in the archive; it must return nonzero when so asked. This is not - an error condition. An exception is that if the command was terminated by + It is important that the <varname>restore_command</varname> return nonzero + exit status on failure, or, if you are using a + <varname>restore_library</varname>, that the restore function returns + <literal>false</literal> on failure. The command or library + <emphasis>will</emphasis> be called requesting files that are not + present in the archive; it must fail when so asked. This is not + an error condition. An exception is that if the + <varname>restore_command</varname> was terminated by a signal (other than <systemitem>SIGTERM</systemitem>, which is used as part of a database server shutdown) or an error by the shell (such as command not found), then recovery will abort and the server will not start - up. + up. Likewise, if the restore function provided by the + <varname>restore_library</varname> emits an <literal>ERROR</literal> or + <literal>FATAL</literal>, recovery will abort and the server won't start. </para> <para> @@ -1232,7 +1256,8 @@ restore_command = 'cp /mnt/server/archivedir/%f %p' close as possible given the available WAL segments). Therefore, a normal recovery will end with a <quote>file not found</quote> message, the exact text of the error message depending upon your choice of - <varname>restore_command</varname>. You may also see an error message + <varname>restore_command</varname> or <varname>restore_library</varname>. + You may also see an error message at the start of recovery for a file named something like <filename>00000001.history</filename>. This is also normal and does not indicate a problem in simple recovery situations; see diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml index 60f23d2855..11fd670dbc 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml @@ -8,17 +8,20 @@ </indexterm> <para> - <filename>basic_archive</filename> is an example of an archive module. This - module copies completed WAL segment files to the specified directory. This - may not be especially useful, but it can serve as a starting point for - developing your own archive module. For more information about archive - modules, see <xref linkend="archive-modules"/>. + <filename>basic_archive</filename> is an example of an archive and recovery + module. This module copies completed WAL segment files to or from the + specified directory. This may not be especially useful, but it can serve as + a starting point for developing your own archive and recovery modules. For + more information about archive and recovery modules, see + see <xref linkend="archive-modules"/>. </para> <para> - In order to function, this module must be loaded via + For use as an archive module, this module must be loaded via <xref linkend="guc-archive-library"/>, and <xref linkend="guc-archive-mode"/> - must be enabled. + must be enabled. For use as a recovery module, this module must be loaded + via <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/>, and recovery must be enabled (see + <xref linkend="runtime-config-wal-archive-recovery"/>). </para> <sect2 id="basic-archive-configuration-parameters"> @@ -34,11 +37,12 @@ </term> <listitem> <para> - The directory where the server should copy WAL segment files. This - directory must already exist. The default is an empty string, which - effectively halts WAL archiving, but if <xref linkend="guc-archive-mode"/> - is enabled, the server will accumulate WAL segment files in the - expectation that a value will soon be provided. + The directory where the server should copy WAL segment files to or from. + This directory must already exist. The default is an empty string, + which, when used for archiving, effectively halts WAL archival, but if + <xref linkend="guc-archive-mode"/> is enabled, the server will accumulate + WAL segment files in the expectation that a value will soon be provided. + When an empty string is used for recovery, restore will fail. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -46,7 +50,7 @@ <para> These parameters must be set in <filename>postgresql.conf</filename>. - Typical usage might be: + Typical usage as an archive module might be: </para> <programlisting> @@ -61,7 +65,8 @@ basic_archive.archive_directory = '/path/to/archive/directory' <title>Notes</title> <para> - Server crashes may leave temporary files with the prefix + When <filename>basic_archive</filename> is used as an archive module, server + crashes may leave temporary files with the prefix <filename>archtemp</filename> in the archive directory. It is recommended to delete such files before restarting the server after a crash. It is safe to remove such files while the server is running as long as they are unrelated diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml index 77574e2d4e..039d3360ac 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml @@ -3773,7 +3773,8 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' recovery when the end of archived WAL is reached, but will keep trying to continue recovery by connecting to the sending server as specified by the <varname>primary_conninfo</varname> setting and/or by fetching new WAL - segments using <varname>restore_command</varname>. For this mode, the + segments using <varname>restore_command</varname> or + <varname>restore_library</varname>. For this mode, the parameters from this section and <xref linkend="runtime-config-replication-standby"/> are of interest. Parameters from <xref linkend="runtime-config-wal-recovery-target"/> will @@ -3801,7 +3802,8 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' <listitem> <para> The local shell command to execute to retrieve an archived segment of - the WAL file series. This parameter is required for archive recovery, + the WAL file series. Either <varname>restore_command</varname> or + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> is required for archive recovery, but optional for streaming replication. Any <literal>%f</literal> in the string is replaced by the name of the file to retrieve from the archive, @@ -3836,7 +3838,42 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows <para> This parameter can only be set in the <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> - file or on the server command line. + file or on the server command line. It is only used if + <varname>restore_library</varname> is set to an empty string. If both + <varname>restore_command</varname> and + <varname>restore_library</varname> are set, an error will be raised. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry id="guc-restore-library" xreflabel="restore_library"> + <term><varname>restore_library</varname> (<type>string</type>) + <indexterm> + <primary><varname>restore_library</varname> configuration parameter</primary> + </indexterm> + </term> + <listitem> + <para> + The library to use for recovery actions, including retrieving archived + segments of the WAL file series and executing tasks at restartpoints + and at recovery end. Either <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> or + <varname>restore_library</varname> is required for archive recovery, + but optional for streaming replication. If this parameter is set to an + empty string (the default), restoring via shell is enabled, and + <varname>restore_command</varname>, + <varname>archive_cleanup_command</varname> and + <varname>recovery_end_command</varname> are used. If both + <varname>restore_library</varname> and any of + <varname>restore_command</varname>, + <varname>archive_cleanup_command</varname> or + <varname>recovery_end_command</varname> are set, an error will be + raised. Otherwise, the specified shared library is used for recovery. + For more information, see <xref linkend="archive-modules"/>. + </para> + + <para> + This parameter can only be set in the + <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> file or on the server command line. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -3881,7 +3918,10 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows </para> <para> This parameter can only be set in the <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> - file or on the server command line. + file or on the server command line. It is only used if + <varname>restore_library</varname> is set to an empty string. If both + <varname>archive_cleanup_command</varname> and + <varname>restore_library</varname> are set, an error will be raised. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -3910,11 +3950,13 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows </para> <para> This parameter can only be set in the <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> - file or on the server command line. + file or on the server command line. It is only used if + <varname>restore_library</varname> is set to an empty string. If both + <varname>recovery_end_command</varname> and + <varname>restore_library</varname> are set, an error will be raised. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> - </variablelist> </sect2> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml index f180607528..6266e2df7f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml @@ -627,7 +627,8 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <para> In standby mode, the server continuously applies WAL received from the primary server. The standby server can read WAL from a WAL archive - (see <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/>) or directly from the primary + (see <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> and + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/>) or directly from the primary over a TCP connection (streaming replication). The standby server will also attempt to restore any WAL found in the standby cluster's <filename>pg_wal</filename> directory. That typically happens after a server @@ -638,9 +639,11 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <para> At startup, the standby begins by restoring all WAL available in the - archive location, calling <varname>restore_command</varname>. Once it - reaches the end of WAL available there and <varname>restore_command</varname> - fails, it tries to restore any WAL available in the <filename>pg_wal</filename> directory. + archive location, either by calling <varname>restore_command</varname> or + by executing the <varname>restore_library</varname>'s restore callback. + Once it reaches the end of WAL available there and + <varname>restore_command</varname> or the restore callback fails, it tries + to restore any WAL available in the <filename>pg_wal</filename> directory. If that fails, and streaming replication has been configured, the standby tries to connect to the primary server and start streaming WAL from the last valid record found in archive or <filename>pg_wal</filename>. If that fails @@ -698,7 +701,8 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. server (see <xref linkend="backup-pitr-recovery"/>). Create a file <link linkend="file-standby-signal"><filename>standby.signal</filename></link><indexterm><primary>standby.signal</primary></indexterm> in the standby's cluster data - directory. Set <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> to a simple command to copy files from + directory. Set <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> or + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> to copy files from the WAL archive. If you plan to have multiple standby servers for high availability purposes, make sure that <varname>recovery_target_timeline</varname> is set to <literal>latest</literal> (the default), to make the standby server follow the timeline change @@ -707,7 +711,8 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <note> <para> - <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> should return immediately + <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> and restore callbacks provided by + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> should return immediately if the file does not exist; the server will retry the command again if necessary. </para> @@ -731,8 +736,10 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <para> If you're using a WAL archive, its size can be minimized using the <xref - linkend="guc-archive-cleanup-command"/> parameter to remove files that are no - longer required by the standby server. + linkend="guc-archive-cleanup-command"/> parameter or the + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/>'s + <function>archive_cleanup_cb</function> callback function to remove files + that are no longer required by the standby server. The <application>pg_archivecleanup</application> utility is designed specifically to be used with <varname>archive_cleanup_command</varname> in typical single-standby configurations, see <xref linkend="pgarchivecleanup"/>. diff --git a/src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c b/src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c index f5b6cf174e..c0bc78d8b4 100644 --- a/src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c +++ b/src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c @@ -4,7 +4,8 @@ * Recovery functions for a user-specified shell command. * * These recovery functions use a user-specified shell command (e.g. based - * on the GUC restore_command). + * on the GUC restore_command). It is used as the default, but other + * modules may define their own recovery logic. * * Portions Copyright (c) 1996-2023, PostgreSQL Global Development Group * Portions Copyright (c) 1994, Regents of the University of California @@ -25,11 +26,25 @@ #include "storage/ipc.h" #include "utils/wait_event.h" +static bool shell_restore(const char *file, const char *path, + const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +static void shell_archive_cleanup(const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +static void shell_recovery_end(const char *lastRestartPointFileName); static bool ExecuteRecoveryCommand(const char *command, const char *commandName, bool failOnSignal, bool exitOnSigterm, uint32 wait_event_info, int fail_elevel); +void +shell_restore_init(RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb) +{ + AssertVariableIsOfType(&shell_restore_init, RecoveryModuleInit); + + cb->restore_cb = shell_restore; + cb->archive_cleanup_cb = shell_archive_cleanup; + cb->recovery_end_cb = shell_recovery_end; +} + /* * Attempt to execute a shell-based restore command. * @@ -80,7 +95,7 @@ shell_restore(const char *file, const char *path, /* * Attempt to execute a shell-based archive cleanup command. */ -void +static void shell_archive_cleanup(const char *lastRestartPointFileName) { char *cmd; @@ -96,7 +111,7 @@ shell_archive_cleanup(const char *lastRestartPointFileName) /* * Attempt to execute a shell-based end-of-recovery command. */ -void +static void shell_recovery_end(const char *lastRestartPointFileName) { char *cmd; diff --git a/src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c b/src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c index 8f47fb7570..ae537cd87f 100644 --- a/src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c +++ b/src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c @@ -4884,15 +4884,16 @@ static void CleanupAfterArchiveRecovery(TimeLineID EndOfLogTLI, XLogRecPtr EndOfLog, TimeLineID newTLI) { + /* - * Execute the recovery_end_command, if any. + * Execute the recovery-end callback, if any. */ - if (recoveryEndCommand && strcmp(recoveryEndCommand, "") != 0) + if (RecoveryContext.recovery_end_cb) { char lastRestartPointFname[MAXFNAMELEN]; GetOldestRestartPointFileName(lastRestartPointFname); - shell_recovery_end(lastRestartPointFname); + RecoveryContext.recovery_end_cb(lastRestartPointFname); } /* @@ -7307,14 +7308,14 @@ CreateRestartPoint(int flags) timestamptz_to_str(xtime)) : 0)); /* - * Finally, execute archive_cleanup_command, if any. + * Execute the archive-cleanup callback, if any. */ - if (archiveCleanupCommand && strcmp(archiveCleanupCommand, "") != 0) + if (RecoveryContext.archive_cleanup_cb) { char lastRestartPointFname[MAXFNAMELEN]; GetOldestRestartPointFileName(lastRestartPointFname); - shell_archive_cleanup(lastRestartPointFname); + RecoveryContext.archive_cleanup_cb(lastRestartPointFname); } return true; diff --git a/src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c b/src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c index b5cb060d55..fdab7dad43 100644 --- a/src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c +++ b/src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c @@ -22,7 +22,9 @@ #include "access/xlog.h" #include "access/xlog_internal.h" #include "access/xlogarchive.h" +#include "access/xlogrecovery.h" #include "common/archive.h" +#include "fmgr.h" #include "miscadmin.h" #include "pgstat.h" #include "postmaster/startup.h" @@ -32,6 +34,11 @@ #include "storage/ipc.h" #include "storage/lwlock.h" +/* + * Global context for recovery-related callbacks. + */ +RecoveryModuleCallbacks RecoveryContext; + /* * Attempt to retrieve the specified file from off-line archival storage. * If successful, fill "path" with its complete path (note that this will be @@ -71,7 +78,7 @@ RestoreArchivedFile(char *path, const char *xlogfname, goto not_available; /* In standby mode, restore_command might not be supplied */ - if (recoveryRestoreCommand == NULL || strcmp(recoveryRestoreCommand, "") == 0) + if (RecoveryContext.restore_cb == NULL) goto not_available; /* @@ -149,14 +156,15 @@ RestoreArchivedFile(char *path, const char *xlogfname, XLogFileName(lastRestartPointFname, 0, 0L, wal_segment_size); /* - * Check signals before restore command and reset afterwards. + * Check signals before restore callback and reset afterwards. */ PreRestoreCommand(); /* * Copy xlog from archival storage to XLOGDIR */ - ret = shell_restore(xlogfname, xlogpath, lastRestartPointFname); + ret = RecoveryContext.restore_cb(xlogfname, xlogpath, + lastRestartPointFname); PostRestoreCommand(); @@ -603,3 +611,59 @@ XLogArchiveCleanup(const char *xlog) unlink(archiveStatusPath); /* should we complain about failure? */ } + +/* + * Loads all the recovery callbacks into our global RecoveryContext. The + * caller is responsible for validating the combination of library/command + * parameters that are set (e.g., restore_command and restore_library cannot + * both be set). + */ +void +LoadRecoveryCallbacks(void) +{ + RecoveryModuleInit init; + + /* + * If the shell command is enabled, use our special initialization + * function. Otherwise, load the library and call its + * _PG_recovery_module_init(). + */ + if (restoreLibrary[0] == '\0') + init = shell_restore_init; + else + init = (RecoveryModuleInit) + load_external_function(restoreLibrary, "_PG_recovery_module_init", + false, NULL); + + if (init == NULL) + ereport(ERROR, + (errmsg("recovery modules have to define the symbol " + "_PG_recovery_module_init"))); + + memset(&RecoveryContext, 0, sizeof(RecoveryModuleCallbacks)); + (*init) (&RecoveryContext); + + /* + * If using shell commands, remove callbacks for any commands that are not + * set. + */ + if (restoreLibrary[0] == '\0') + { + if (recoveryRestoreCommand[0] == '\0') + RecoveryContext.restore_cb = NULL; + if (archiveCleanupCommand[0] == '\0') + RecoveryContext.archive_cleanup_cb = NULL; + if (recoveryEndCommand[0] == '\0') + RecoveryContext.recovery_end_cb = NULL; + } +} + +/* + * Call the shutdown callback of the loaded recovery module, if defined. + */ +void +call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb(int code, Datum arg) +{ + if (RecoveryContext.shutdown_cb) + RecoveryContext.shutdown_cb(); +} diff --git a/src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c b/src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c index 5e65785306..db0cd4469a 100644 --- a/src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c +++ b/src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c @@ -80,6 +80,7 @@ const struct config_enum_entry recovery_target_action_options[] = { /* options formerly taken from recovery.conf for archive recovery */ char *recoveryRestoreCommand = NULL; +char *restoreLibrary = NULL; char *recoveryEndCommand = NULL; char *archiveCleanupCommand = NULL; RecoveryTargetType recoveryTarget = RECOVERY_TARGET_UNSET; @@ -1053,24 +1054,37 @@ validateRecoveryParameters(void) if (!ArchiveRecoveryRequested) return; + /* + * Check for invalid combinations of the command/library parameters and + * load the callbacks. + */ + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + recoveryRestoreCommand, "restore_command"); + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + recoveryEndCommand, "recovery_end_command"); + before_shmem_exit(call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb, 0); + LoadRecoveryCallbacks(); + /* * Check for compulsory parameters */ if (StandbyModeRequested) { if ((PrimaryConnInfo == NULL || strcmp(PrimaryConnInfo, "") == 0) && - (recoveryRestoreCommand == NULL || strcmp(recoveryRestoreCommand, "") == 0)) + RecoveryContext.restore_cb == NULL) ereport(WARNING, - (errmsg("specified neither primary_conninfo nor restore_command"), - errhint("The database server will regularly poll the pg_wal subdirectory to check for files placed there."))); + (errmsg("specified neither primary_conninfo nor restore_command " + "nor a restore_library that defines a restore callback"), + errhint("The database server will regularly poll the pg_wal " + "subdirectory to check for files placed there."))); } else { - if (recoveryRestoreCommand == NULL || - strcmp(recoveryRestoreCommand, "") == 0) + if (RecoveryContext.restore_cb == NULL) ereport(FATAL, (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), - errmsg("must specify restore_command when standby mode is not enabled"))); + errmsg("must specify restore_command or a restore_library that defines " + "a restore callback when standby mode is not enabled"))); } /* diff --git a/src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c b/src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c index de0bbbfa79..6350fd0b83 100644 --- a/src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c +++ b/src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c @@ -38,6 +38,7 @@ #include "access/xlog.h" #include "access/xlog_internal.h" +#include "access/xlogarchive.h" #include "access/xlogrecovery.h" #include "libpq/pqsignal.h" #include "miscadmin.h" @@ -222,6 +223,16 @@ CheckpointerMain(void) */ before_shmem_exit(pgstat_before_server_shutdown, 0); + /* + * Check for invalid combinations of the command/library parameters and + * load the callbacks. We do this before setting up the exception handler + * so that any problems result in a server crash shortly after startup. + */ + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + archiveCleanupCommand, "archive_cleanup_command"); + before_shmem_exit(call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb, 0); + LoadRecoveryCallbacks(); + /* * Create a memory context that we will do all our work in. We do this so * that we can reset the context during error recovery and thereby avoid @@ -548,6 +559,9 @@ HandleCheckpointerInterrupts(void) if (ConfigReloadPending) { + char *prevRestoreLibrary = pstrdup(restoreLibrary); + char *prevArchiveCleanupCommand = pstrdup(archiveCleanupCommand); + ConfigReloadPending = false; ProcessConfigFile(PGC_SIGHUP); @@ -563,6 +577,18 @@ HandleCheckpointerInterrupts(void) * because of SIGHUP. */ UpdateSharedMemoryConfig(); + + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + archiveCleanupCommand, "archive_cleanup_command"); + if (strcmp(prevRestoreLibrary, restoreLibrary) != 0 || + strcmp(prevArchiveCleanupCommand, archiveCleanupCommand) != 0) + { + call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb(0, (Datum) 0); + LoadRecoveryCallbacks(); + } + + pfree(prevRestoreLibrary); + pfree(prevArchiveCleanupCommand); } if (ShutdownRequestPending) { diff --git a/src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c b/src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c index 8ecdb9ca23..8e91f2d70f 100644 --- a/src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c +++ b/src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c @@ -831,11 +831,8 @@ LoadArchiveLibrary(void) { ArchiveModuleInit archive_init; - if (XLogArchiveLibrary[0] != '\0' && XLogArchiveCommand[0] != '\0') - ereport(ERROR, - (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), - errmsg("both archive_command and archive_library set"), - errdetail("Only one of archive_command, archive_library may be set."))); + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(XLogArchiveLibrary, "archive_library", + XLogArchiveCommand, "archive_command"); memset(&ArchiveContext, 0, sizeof(ArchiveModuleCallbacks)); diff --git a/src/backend/postmaster/startup.c b/src/backend/postmaster/startup.c index 8786186898..f9ff2b5583 100644 --- a/src/backend/postmaster/startup.c +++ b/src/backend/postmaster/startup.c @@ -20,6 +20,7 @@ #include "postgres.h" #include "access/xlog.h" +#include "access/xlogarchive.h" #include "access/xlogrecovery.h" #include "access/xlogutils.h" #include "libpq/pqsignal.h" @@ -133,13 +134,17 @@ StartupProcShutdownHandler(SIGNAL_ARGS) * Re-read the config file. * * If one of the critical walreceiver options has changed, flag xlog.c - * to restart it. + * to restart it. Also, check for invalid combinations of the command/library + * parameters and reload the recovery callbacks if necessary. */ static void StartupRereadConfig(void) { char *conninfo = pstrdup(PrimaryConnInfo); char *slotname = pstrdup(PrimarySlotName); + char *prevRestoreLibrary = pstrdup(restoreLibrary); + char *prevRestoreCommand = pstrdup(recoveryRestoreCommand); + char *prevRecoveryEndCommand = pstrdup(recoveryEndCommand); bool tempSlot = wal_receiver_create_temp_slot; bool conninfoChanged; bool slotnameChanged; @@ -161,6 +166,22 @@ StartupRereadConfig(void) if (conninfoChanged || slotnameChanged || tempSlotChanged) StartupRequestWalReceiverRestart(); + + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + recoveryRestoreCommand, "restore_command"); + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + recoveryEndCommand, "recovery_end_command"); + if (strcmp(prevRestoreLibrary, restoreLibrary) != 0 || + strcmp(prevRestoreCommand, recoveryRestoreCommand) != 0 || + strcmp(prevRecoveryEndCommand, recoveryEndCommand) != 0) + { + call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb(0, (Datum) 0); + LoadRecoveryCallbacks(); + } + + pfree(prevRestoreLibrary); + pfree(prevRestoreCommand); + pfree(prevRecoveryEndCommand); } /* Handle various signals that might be sent to the startup process */ diff --git a/src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c b/src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c index d52069f446..7858e9a649 100644 --- a/src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c +++ b/src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c @@ -6880,3 +6880,17 @@ call_enum_check_hook(struct config_enum *conf, int *newval, void **extra, return true; } + +/* + * ERROR if both parameters are set. + */ +void +CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(const char *p1val, const char *p1name, + const char *p2val, const char *p2name) +{ + if (p1val[0] != '\0' && p2val[0] != '\0') + ereport(ERROR, + (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), + errmsg("both %s and %s set", p1name, p2name), + errdetail("Only one of %s, %s may be set.", p1name, p2name))); +} diff --git a/src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c b/src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c index 5025e80f89..a8a516b0c6 100644 --- a/src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c +++ b/src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c @@ -3776,6 +3776,16 @@ struct config_string ConfigureNamesString[] = NULL, NULL, NULL }, + { + {"restore_library", PGC_SIGHUP, WAL_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY, + gettext_noop("Sets the library that will be called for recovery actions."), + NULL + }, + &restoreLibrary, + "", + NULL, NULL, NULL + }, + { {"archive_cleanup_command", PGC_SIGHUP, WAL_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY, gettext_noop("Sets the shell command that will be executed at every restart point."), diff --git a/src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample b/src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample index 4cceda4162..38fb3e0823 100644 --- a/src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample +++ b/src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample @@ -269,6 +269,7 @@ # placeholders: %p = path of file to restore # %f = file name only # e.g. 'cp /mnt/server/archivedir/%f %p' +#restore_library = '' # library to use for recovery actions #archive_cleanup_command = '' # command to execute at every restartpoint #recovery_end_command = '' # command to execute at completion of recovery diff --git a/src/include/access/xlog_internal.h b/src/include/access/xlog_internal.h index 59fc7bc105..756f0898b5 100644 --- a/src/include/access/xlog_internal.h +++ b/src/include/access/xlog_internal.h @@ -400,5 +400,6 @@ extern PGDLLIMPORT bool ArchiveRecoveryRequested; extern PGDLLIMPORT bool InArchiveRecovery; extern PGDLLIMPORT bool StandbyMode; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *recoveryRestoreCommand; +extern PGDLLIMPORT char *restoreLibrary; #endif /* XLOG_INTERNAL_H */ diff --git a/src/include/access/xlogarchive.h b/src/include/access/xlogarchive.h index 299304703e..71c9b88165 100644 --- a/src/include/access/xlogarchive.h +++ b/src/include/access/xlogarchive.h @@ -30,9 +30,45 @@ extern bool XLogArchiveIsReady(const char *xlog); extern bool XLogArchiveIsReadyOrDone(const char *xlog); extern void XLogArchiveCleanup(const char *xlog); -extern bool shell_restore(const char *file, const char *path, - const char *lastRestartPointFileName); -extern void shell_archive_cleanup(const char *lastRestartPointFileName); -extern void shell_recovery_end(const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +/* + * Recovery module callbacks + * + * These callback functions should be defined by recovery libraries and + * returned via _PG_recovery_module_init(). For more information about the + * purpose of each callback, refer to the recovery modules documentation. + */ +typedef bool (*RecoveryRestoreCB) (const char *file, const char *path, + const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +typedef void (*RecoveryArchiveCleanupCB) (const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +typedef void (*RecoveryEndCB) (const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +typedef void (*RecoveryShutdownCB) (void); + +typedef struct RecoveryModuleCallbacks +{ + RecoveryRestoreCB restore_cb; + RecoveryArchiveCleanupCB archive_cleanup_cb; + RecoveryEndCB recovery_end_cb; + RecoveryShutdownCB shutdown_cb; +} RecoveryModuleCallbacks; + +extern RecoveryModuleCallbacks RecoveryContext; + +/* + * Type of the shared library symbol _PG_recovery_module_init that is looked up + * when loading a recovery library. + */ +typedef void (*RecoveryModuleInit) (RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb); + +extern PGDLLEXPORT void _PG_recovery_module_init(RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb); + +extern void LoadRecoveryCallbacks(void); +extern void call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb(int code, Datum arg); + +/* + * Since the logic for recovery via a shell command is in the core server and + * does not need to be loaded via a shared library, it has a special + * initialization function. + */ +extern void shell_restore_init(RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb); #endif /* XLOG_ARCHIVE_H */ diff --git a/src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h b/src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h index 47c29350f5..35d1d09374 100644 --- a/src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h +++ b/src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h @@ -55,6 +55,7 @@ extern PGDLLIMPORT int recovery_min_apply_delay; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *PrimaryConnInfo; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *PrimarySlotName; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *recoveryRestoreCommand; +extern PGDLLIMPORT char *restoreLibrary; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *recoveryEndCommand; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *archiveCleanupCommand; diff --git a/src/include/utils/guc.h b/src/include/utils/guc.h index ba89d013e6..947597247f 100644 --- a/src/include/utils/guc.h +++ b/src/include/utils/guc.h @@ -404,6 +404,8 @@ extern void *guc_malloc(int elevel, size_t size); extern pg_nodiscard void *guc_realloc(int elevel, void *old, size_t size); extern char *guc_strdup(int elevel, const char *src); extern void guc_free(void *ptr); +extern void CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(const char *p1val, const char *p1name, + const char *p2val, const char *p2name); #ifdef EXEC_BACKEND extern void write_nondefault_variables(GucContext context); -- 2.25.1 --PEIAKu/WMn1b1Hv9-- ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 17+ messages in thread
* [PATCH v8 2/2] Allow recovery via loadable modules. @ 2022-12-10 03:40 Nathan Bossart <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 17+ messages in thread From: Nathan Bossart @ 2022-12-10 03:40 UTC (permalink / raw) This adds the restore_library parameter to allow archive recovery via a loadable module, rather than running shell commands. --- contrib/basic_archive/Makefile | 4 +- contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c | 67 ++++++- contrib/basic_archive/meson.build | 7 +- contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl | 44 +++++ doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml | 168 ++++++++++++++++-- doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml | 43 ++++- doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml | 33 ++-- doc/src/sgml/config.sgml | 54 +++++- doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml | 23 ++- src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c | 21 ++- src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c | 13 +- src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c | 70 +++++++- src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c | 26 ++- src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c | 26 +++ src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c | 7 +- src/backend/postmaster/startup.c | 23 ++- src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c | 14 ++ src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c | 10 ++ src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample | 1 + src/include/access/xlog_internal.h | 1 + src/include/access/xlogarchive.h | 44 ++++- src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h | 1 + src/include/utils/guc.h | 2 + 23 files changed, 618 insertions(+), 84 deletions(-) create mode 100644 contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl diff --git a/contrib/basic_archive/Makefile b/contrib/basic_archive/Makefile index 55d299d650..487dc563f3 100644 --- a/contrib/basic_archive/Makefile +++ b/contrib/basic_archive/Makefile @@ -1,7 +1,7 @@ # contrib/basic_archive/Makefile MODULES = basic_archive -PGFILEDESC = "basic_archive - basic archive module" +PGFILEDESC = "basic_archive - basic archive and recovery module" REGRESS = basic_archive REGRESS_OPTS = --temp-config $(top_srcdir)/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.conf @@ -9,6 +9,8 @@ REGRESS_OPTS = --temp-config $(top_srcdir)/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c # which typical installcheck users do not have (e.g. buildfarm clients). NO_INSTALLCHECK = 1 +TAP_TESTS = 1 + ifdef USE_PGXS PG_CONFIG = pg_config PGXS := $(shell $(PG_CONFIG) --pgxs) diff --git a/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c b/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c index 28cbb6cce0..8c333c8f99 100644 --- a/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c +++ b/contrib/basic_archive/basic_archive.c @@ -17,6 +17,11 @@ * a file is successfully archived and then the system crashes before * a durable record of the success has been made. * + * This file also demonstrates a basic restore library implementation that + * is roughly equivalent to the following shell command: + * + * cp /path/to/archivedir/%f %p + * * Copyright (c) 2022-2023, PostgreSQL Global Development Group * * IDENTIFICATION @@ -30,6 +35,7 @@ #include <sys/time.h> #include <unistd.h> +#include "access/xlogarchive.h" #include "common/int.h" #include "miscadmin.h" #include "postmaster/pgarch.h" @@ -48,6 +54,8 @@ static bool basic_archive_file(const char *file, const char *path); static void basic_archive_file_internal(const char *file, const char *path); static bool check_archive_directory(char **newval, void **extra, GucSource source); static bool compare_files(const char *file1, const char *file2); +static bool basic_restore_file(const char *file, const char *path, + const char *lastRestartPointFileName); /* * _PG_init @@ -87,6 +95,19 @@ _PG_archive_module_init(ArchiveModuleCallbacks *cb) cb->archive_file_cb = basic_archive_file; } +/* + * _PG_recovery_module_init + * + * Returns the module's restore callback. + */ +void +_PG_recovery_module_init(RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb) +{ + AssertVariableIsOfType(&_PG_recovery_module_init, RecoveryModuleInit); + + cb->restore_cb = basic_restore_file; +} + /* * check_archive_directory * @@ -99,8 +120,8 @@ check_archive_directory(char **newval, void **extra, GucSource source) /* * The default value is an empty string, so we have to accept that value. - * Our check_configured callback also checks for this and prevents - * archiving from proceeding if it is still empty. + * Our check_configured and restore callbacks also check for this and + * prevent archiving or recovery from proceeding if it is still empty. */ if (*newval == NULL || *newval[0] == '\0') return true; @@ -368,3 +389,45 @@ compare_files(const char *file1, const char *file2) return ret; } + +/* + * basic_restore_file + * + * Retrieves one file from the WAL archives. + */ +static bool +basic_restore_file(const char *file, const char *path, + const char *lastRestartPointFileName) +{ + char source[MAXPGPATH]; + struct stat st; + + ereport(DEBUG1, + (errmsg("restoring \"%s\" via basic_archive", file))); + + if (archive_directory == NULL || archive_directory[0] == '\0') + ereport(ERROR, + (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), + errmsg("\"basic_archive.archive_directory\" is not set"))); + + /* + * Check whether the file exists. If not, we return false to indicate that + * there are no more files to restore. + */ + snprintf(source, MAXPGPATH, "%s/%s", archive_directory, file); + if (stat(source, &st) != 0) + { + int elevel = (errno == ENOENT) ? DEBUG1 : ERROR; + + ereport(elevel, + (errcode_for_file_access(), + errmsg("could not stat file \"%s\": %m", source))); + return false; + } + + copy_file(source, unconstify(char *, path)); + + ereport(DEBUG1, + (errmsg("restored \"%s\" via basic_archive", file))); + return true; +} diff --git a/contrib/basic_archive/meson.build b/contrib/basic_archive/meson.build index bc1380e6f6..af4580dea9 100644 --- a/contrib/basic_archive/meson.build +++ b/contrib/basic_archive/meson.build @@ -7,7 +7,7 @@ basic_archive_sources = files( if host_system == 'windows' basic_archive_sources += rc_lib_gen.process(win32ver_rc, extra_args: [ '--NAME', 'basic_archive', - '--FILEDESC', 'basic_archive - basic archive module',]) + '--FILEDESC', 'basic_archive - basic archive and recovery module',]) endif basic_archive = shared_module('basic_archive', @@ -31,4 +31,9 @@ tests += { # which typical runningcheck users do not have (e.g. buildfarm clients). 'runningcheck': false, }, + 'tap': { + 'tests': [ + 't/001_restore.pl', + ], + }, } diff --git a/contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl b/contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ec8767d740 --- /dev/null +++ b/contrib/basic_archive/t/001_restore.pl @@ -0,0 +1,44 @@ + +# Copyright (c) 2022, PostgreSQL Global Development Group + +use strict; +use warnings; +use PostgreSQL::Test::Cluster; +use PostgreSQL::Test::Utils; +use Test::More; + +# start a node +my $node = PostgreSQL::Test::Cluster->new('node'); +$node->init(has_archiving => 1, allows_streaming => 1); +my $archive_dir = $node->archive_dir; +$archive_dir =~ s!\\!/!g if $PostgreSQL::Test::Utils::windows_os; +$node->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "archive_command = ''"); +$node->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "archive_library = 'basic_archive'"); +$node->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "basic_archive.archive_directory = '$archive_dir'"); +$node->start; + +# backup the node +my $backup = 'backup'; +$node->backup($backup); + +# generate some new WAL files +$node->safe_psql('postgres', "CREATE TABLE test (a INT);"); +$node->safe_psql('postgres', "SELECT pg_switch_wal();"); +$node->safe_psql('postgres', "INSERT INTO test VALUES (1);"); + +# shut down the node (this should archive all WAL files) +$node->stop; + +# restore from the backup +my $restore = PostgreSQL::Test::Cluster->new('restore'); +$restore->init_from_backup($node, $backup, has_restoring => 1, standby => 0); +$restore->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "restore_command = ''"); +$restore->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "restore_library = 'basic_archive'"); +$restore->append_conf('postgresql.conf', "basic_archive.archive_directory = '$archive_dir'"); +$restore->start; + +# ensure post-backup WAL was replayed +my $result = $restore->safe_psql("postgres", "SELECT count(*) FROM test;"); +is($result, "1", "check restore content"); + +done_testing(); diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml index ef02051f7f..53e657040b 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml @@ -1,34 +1,40 @@ <!-- doc/src/sgml/archive-modules.sgml --> <chapter id="archive-modules"> - <title>Archive Modules</title> + <title>Archive and Recovery Modules</title> <indexterm zone="archive-modules"> - <primary>Archive Modules</primary> + <primary>Archive and Recovery Modules</primary> </indexterm> <para> PostgreSQL provides infrastructure to create custom modules for continuous - archiving (see <xref linkend="continuous-archiving"/>). While archiving via - a shell command (i.e., <xref linkend="guc-archive-command"/>) is much - simpler, a custom archive module will often be considerably more robust and - performant. + archiving and recovery (see <xref linkend="continuous-archiving"/>). While + a shell command (e.g., <xref linkend="guc-archive-command"/>, + <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/>) is much simpler, a custom module will + often be considerably more robust and performant. </para> <para> When a custom <xref linkend="guc-archive-library"/> is configured, PostgreSQL will submit completed WAL files to the module, and the server will avoid recycling or removing these WAL files until the module indicates that the files - were successfully archived. It is ultimately up to the module to decide what - to do with each WAL file, but many recommendations are listed at - <xref linkend="backup-archiving-wal"/>. + were successfully archived. When a custom + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> is configured, PostgreSQL will use the + module for recovery actions. It is ultimately up to the module to decide how + to accomplish each task, but some recommendations are listed at + <xref linkend="backup-archiving-wal"/> and + <xref linkend="backup-pitr-recovery"/>. </para> <para> - Archiving modules must at least consist of an initialization function (see - <xref linkend="archive-module-init"/>) and the required callbacks (see - <xref linkend="archive-module-callbacks"/>). However, archive modules are - also permitted to do much more (e.g., declare GUCs and register background - workers). + Archive and recovery modules must at least consist of an initialization + function (see <xref linkend="archive-module-init"/> and + <xref linkend="recovery-module-init"/>) and the required callbacks (see + <xref linkend="archive-module-callbacks"/> and + <xref linkend="recovery-module-callbacks"/>). However, archive and recovery + modules are also permitted to do much more (e.g., declare GUCs and register + background workers). A module may be used for both + <varname>archive_library</varname> and <varname>restore_library</varname>. </para> <para> @@ -37,7 +43,7 @@ </para> <sect1 id="archive-module-init"> - <title>Initialization Functions</title> + <title>Archive Module Initialization Functions</title> <indexterm zone="archive-module-init"> <primary>_PG_archive_module_init</primary> </indexterm> @@ -64,6 +70,12 @@ typedef void (*ArchiveModuleInit) (struct ArchiveModuleCallbacks *cb); Only the <function>archive_file_cb</function> callback is required. The others are optional. </para> + + <note> + <para> + <varname>archive_library</varname> is only loaded in the archiver process. + </para> + </note> </sect1> <sect1 id="archive-module-callbacks"> @@ -129,6 +141,132 @@ typedef bool (*ArchiveFileCB) (const char *file, const char *path); <programlisting> typedef void (*ArchiveShutdownCB) (void); +</programlisting> + </para> + </sect2> + </sect1> + + <sect1 id="recovery-module-init"> + <title>Recovery Module Initialization Functions</title> + <indexterm zone="recovery-module-init"> + <primary>_PG_recovery_module_init</primary> + </indexterm> + <para> + A recovery library is loaded by dynamically loading a shared library with the + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> as the library base name. The normal + library search path is used to locate the library. To provide the required + recovery module callbacks and to indicate that the library is actually a + recovery module, it needs to provide a function named + <function>_PG_recovery_module_init</function>. This function is passed a + struct that needs to be filled with the callback function pointers for + individual actions. + +<programlisting> +typedef struct RecoveryModuleCallbacks +{ + RecoveryRestoreCB restore_cb; + RecoveryArchiveCleanupCB archive_cleanup_cb; + RecoveryEndCB recovery_end_cb; + RecoveryShutdownCB shutdown_cb; +} RecoveryModuleCallbacks; +typedef void (*RecoveryModuleInit) (struct RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb); +</programlisting> + + The <function>restore_cb</function> callback is required for archive + recovery, but it is optional for streaming replication. The others are + always optional. + </para> + + <note> + <para> + <varname>restore_library</varname> is only loaded in the startup and + checkpointer processes and in single-user mode. + </para> + </note> + </sect1> + + <sect1 id="recovery-module-callbacks"> + <title>Recovery Module Callbacks</title> + <para> + The recovery callbacks define the actual behavior of the module. The server + will call them as required to execute recovery actions. + </para> + + <sect2 id="recovery-module-restore"> + <title>Restore Callback</title> + <para> + The <function>restore_cb</function> callback is called to retrieve a single + archived segment of the WAL file series for archive recovery or streaming + replication. + +<programlisting> +typedef bool (*RecoveryRestoreCB) (const char *file, const char *path, const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +</programlisting> + + This callback must return <literal>true</literal> only if the file was + successfully retrieved. If the file is not available in the archives, the + callback must return <literal>false</literal>. + <replaceable>file</replaceable> will contain just the file name + of the WAL file to retrieve, while <replaceable>path</replaceable> contains + the destination's relative path (including the file name). + <replaceable>lastRestartPointFileName</replaceable> will contain the name + of the file containing the last valid restart point. That is the earliest + file that must be kept to allow a restore to be restartable, so this + information can be used to truncate the archive to just the minimum + required to support restarting from the current restore. + <replaceable>lastRestartPointFileName</replaceable> is typically only used + by warm-standby configurations (see <xref linkend="warm-standby"/>). Note + that if multiple standby servers are restoring from the same archive + directory, you will need to ensure that you do not delete WAL files until + they are no longer needed by any of the servers. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="recovery-module-archive-cleanup"> + <title>Archive Cleanup Callback</title> + <para> + The <function>archive_cleanup_cb</function> callback is called at every + restart point and is intended to provide a mechanism for cleaning up old + archived WAL files that are no longer needed by the standby server. + +<programlisting> +typedef void (*RecoveryArchiveCleanupCB) (const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +</programlisting> + + <replaceable>lastRestartPointFileName</replaceable> will contain the name + of the file containing the last valid restart point, like in + <link linkend="recovery-module-restore"><function>restore_cb</function></link>. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="recovery-module-end"> + <title>Recovery End Callback</title> + <para> + The <function>recovery_end_cb</function> callback is called once at the end + of recovery and is intended to provide a mechanism for cleanup following + replication or recovery. + +<programlisting> +typedef void (*RecoveryEndCB) (const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +</programlisting> + + <replaceable>lastRestartPointFileName</replaceable> will contain the name + of the file containing the last valid restart point, like in + <link linkend="recovery-module-restore"><function>restore_cb</function></link>. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="recovery-module-shutdown"> + <title>Shutdown Callback</title> + <para> + The <function>shutdown_cb</function> callback is called when a process that + has loaded the recovery module exits (e.g., after an error) or the value of + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> changes. If no + <function>shutdown_cb</function> is defined, no special action is taken in + these situations. + +<programlisting> +typedef void (*RecoveryShutdownCB) (void); </programlisting> </para> </sect2> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml index be05a33205..f44135061d 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/backup.sgml @@ -1180,9 +1180,27 @@ SELECT * FROM pg_backup_stop(wait_for_archive => true); <para> The key part of all this is to set up a recovery configuration that describes how you want to recover and how far the recovery should - run. The one thing that you absolutely must specify is the <varname>restore_command</varname>, - which tells <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> how to retrieve archived - WAL file segments. Like the <varname>archive_command</varname>, this is + run. The one thing that you absolutely must specify is either + <varname>restore_command</varname> or a <varname>restore_library</varname> + that defines a restore callback, which tells + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> how to retrieve archived WAL file + segments. + </para> + + <para> + Like the <varname>archive_library</varname> parameter, + <varname>restore_library</varname> is a shared library. Since such + libraries are written in <literal>C</literal>, creating your own may + require considerably more effort than writing a shell command. However, + recovery modules can be more performant than restoring via shell, and they + will have access to many useful server resources. For more information + about creating a <varname>restore_library</varname>, see + <xref linkend="archive-modules"/>. + </para> + + <para> + Like the <varname>archive_command</varname>, + <varname>restore_command</varname> is a shell command string. It can contain <literal>%f</literal>, which is replaced by the name of the desired WAL file, and <literal>%p</literal>, which is replaced by the path name to copy the WAL file to. @@ -1201,14 +1219,20 @@ restore_command = 'cp /mnt/server/archivedir/%f %p' </para> <para> - It is important that the command return nonzero exit status on failure. - The command <emphasis>will</emphasis> be called requesting files that are not - present in the archive; it must return nonzero when so asked. This is not - an error condition. An exception is that if the command was terminated by + It is important that the <varname>restore_command</varname> return nonzero + exit status on failure, or, if you are using a + <varname>restore_library</varname>, that the restore function returns + <literal>false</literal> on failure. The command or library + <emphasis>will</emphasis> be called requesting files that are not + present in the archive; it must fail when so asked. This is not + an error condition. An exception is that if the + <varname>restore_command</varname> was terminated by a signal (other than <systemitem>SIGTERM</systemitem>, which is used as part of a database server shutdown) or an error by the shell (such as command not found), then recovery will abort and the server will not start - up. + up. Likewise, if the restore function provided by the + <varname>restore_library</varname> emits an <literal>ERROR</literal> or + <literal>FATAL</literal>, recovery will abort and the server won't start. </para> <para> @@ -1232,7 +1256,8 @@ restore_command = 'cp /mnt/server/archivedir/%f %p' close as possible given the available WAL segments). Therefore, a normal recovery will end with a <quote>file not found</quote> message, the exact text of the error message depending upon your choice of - <varname>restore_command</varname>. You may also see an error message + <varname>restore_command</varname> or <varname>restore_library</varname>. + You may also see an error message at the start of recovery for a file named something like <filename>00000001.history</filename>. This is also normal and does not indicate a problem in simple recovery situations; see diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml index 60f23d2855..11fd670dbc 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/basic-archive.sgml @@ -8,17 +8,20 @@ </indexterm> <para> - <filename>basic_archive</filename> is an example of an archive module. This - module copies completed WAL segment files to the specified directory. This - may not be especially useful, but it can serve as a starting point for - developing your own archive module. For more information about archive - modules, see <xref linkend="archive-modules"/>. + <filename>basic_archive</filename> is an example of an archive and recovery + module. This module copies completed WAL segment files to or from the + specified directory. This may not be especially useful, but it can serve as + a starting point for developing your own archive and recovery modules. For + more information about archive and recovery modules, see + see <xref linkend="archive-modules"/>. </para> <para> - In order to function, this module must be loaded via + For use as an archive module, this module must be loaded via <xref linkend="guc-archive-library"/>, and <xref linkend="guc-archive-mode"/> - must be enabled. + must be enabled. For use as a recovery module, this module must be loaded + via <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/>, and recovery must be enabled (see + <xref linkend="runtime-config-wal-archive-recovery"/>). </para> <sect2 id="basic-archive-configuration-parameters"> @@ -34,11 +37,12 @@ </term> <listitem> <para> - The directory where the server should copy WAL segment files. This - directory must already exist. The default is an empty string, which - effectively halts WAL archiving, but if <xref linkend="guc-archive-mode"/> - is enabled, the server will accumulate WAL segment files in the - expectation that a value will soon be provided. + The directory where the server should copy WAL segment files to or from. + This directory must already exist. The default is an empty string, + which, when used for archiving, effectively halts WAL archival, but if + <xref linkend="guc-archive-mode"/> is enabled, the server will accumulate + WAL segment files in the expectation that a value will soon be provided. + When an empty string is used for recovery, restore will fail. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -46,7 +50,7 @@ <para> These parameters must be set in <filename>postgresql.conf</filename>. - Typical usage might be: + Typical usage as an archive module might be: </para> <programlisting> @@ -61,7 +65,8 @@ basic_archive.archive_directory = '/path/to/archive/directory' <title>Notes</title> <para> - Server crashes may leave temporary files with the prefix + When <filename>basic_archive</filename> is used as an archive module, server + crashes may leave temporary files with the prefix <filename>archtemp</filename> in the archive directory. It is recommended to delete such files before restarting the server after a crash. It is safe to remove such files while the server is running as long as they are unrelated diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml index 77574e2d4e..039d3360ac 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/config.sgml @@ -3773,7 +3773,8 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' recovery when the end of archived WAL is reached, but will keep trying to continue recovery by connecting to the sending server as specified by the <varname>primary_conninfo</varname> setting and/or by fetching new WAL - segments using <varname>restore_command</varname>. For this mode, the + segments using <varname>restore_command</varname> or + <varname>restore_library</varname>. For this mode, the parameters from this section and <xref linkend="runtime-config-replication-standby"/> are of interest. Parameters from <xref linkend="runtime-config-wal-recovery-target"/> will @@ -3801,7 +3802,8 @@ include_dir 'conf.d' <listitem> <para> The local shell command to execute to retrieve an archived segment of - the WAL file series. This parameter is required for archive recovery, + the WAL file series. Either <varname>restore_command</varname> or + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> is required for archive recovery, but optional for streaming replication. Any <literal>%f</literal> in the string is replaced by the name of the file to retrieve from the archive, @@ -3836,7 +3838,42 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows <para> This parameter can only be set in the <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> - file or on the server command line. + file or on the server command line. It is only used if + <varname>restore_library</varname> is set to an empty string. If both + <varname>restore_command</varname> and + <varname>restore_library</varname> are set, an error will be raised. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry id="guc-restore-library" xreflabel="restore_library"> + <term><varname>restore_library</varname> (<type>string</type>) + <indexterm> + <primary><varname>restore_library</varname> configuration parameter</primary> + </indexterm> + </term> + <listitem> + <para> + The library to use for recovery actions, including retrieving archived + segments of the WAL file series and executing tasks at restartpoints + and at recovery end. Either <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> or + <varname>restore_library</varname> is required for archive recovery, + but optional for streaming replication. If this parameter is set to an + empty string (the default), restoring via shell is enabled, and + <varname>restore_command</varname>, + <varname>archive_cleanup_command</varname> and + <varname>recovery_end_command</varname> are used. If both + <varname>restore_library</varname> and any of + <varname>restore_command</varname>, + <varname>archive_cleanup_command</varname> or + <varname>recovery_end_command</varname> are set, an error will be + raised. Otherwise, the specified shared library is used for recovery. + For more information, see <xref linkend="archive-modules"/>. + </para> + + <para> + This parameter can only be set in the + <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> file or on the server command line. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -3881,7 +3918,10 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows </para> <para> This parameter can only be set in the <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> - file or on the server command line. + file or on the server command line. It is only used if + <varname>restore_library</varname> is set to an empty string. If both + <varname>archive_cleanup_command</varname> and + <varname>restore_library</varname> are set, an error will be raised. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> @@ -3910,11 +3950,13 @@ restore_command = 'copy "C:\\server\\archivedir\\%f" "%p"' # Windows </para> <para> This parameter can only be set in the <filename>postgresql.conf</filename> - file or on the server command line. + file or on the server command line. It is only used if + <varname>restore_library</varname> is set to an empty string. If both + <varname>recovery_end_command</varname> and + <varname>restore_library</varname> are set, an error will be raised. </para> </listitem> </varlistentry> - </variablelist> </sect2> diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml index f180607528..6266e2df7f 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/high-availability.sgml @@ -627,7 +627,8 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <para> In standby mode, the server continuously applies WAL received from the primary server. The standby server can read WAL from a WAL archive - (see <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/>) or directly from the primary + (see <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> and + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/>) or directly from the primary over a TCP connection (streaming replication). The standby server will also attempt to restore any WAL found in the standby cluster's <filename>pg_wal</filename> directory. That typically happens after a server @@ -638,9 +639,11 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <para> At startup, the standby begins by restoring all WAL available in the - archive location, calling <varname>restore_command</varname>. Once it - reaches the end of WAL available there and <varname>restore_command</varname> - fails, it tries to restore any WAL available in the <filename>pg_wal</filename> directory. + archive location, either by calling <varname>restore_command</varname> or + by executing the <varname>restore_library</varname>'s restore callback. + Once it reaches the end of WAL available there and + <varname>restore_command</varname> or the restore callback fails, it tries + to restore any WAL available in the <filename>pg_wal</filename> directory. If that fails, and streaming replication has been configured, the standby tries to connect to the primary server and start streaming WAL from the last valid record found in archive or <filename>pg_wal</filename>. If that fails @@ -698,7 +701,8 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. server (see <xref linkend="backup-pitr-recovery"/>). Create a file <link linkend="file-standby-signal"><filename>standby.signal</filename></link><indexterm><primary>standby.signal</primary></indexterm> in the standby's cluster data - directory. Set <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> to a simple command to copy files from + directory. Set <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> or + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> to copy files from the WAL archive. If you plan to have multiple standby servers for high availability purposes, make sure that <varname>recovery_target_timeline</varname> is set to <literal>latest</literal> (the default), to make the standby server follow the timeline change @@ -707,7 +711,8 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <note> <para> - <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> should return immediately + <xref linkend="guc-restore-command"/> and restore callbacks provided by + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/> should return immediately if the file does not exist; the server will retry the command again if necessary. </para> @@ -731,8 +736,10 @@ protocol to make nodes agree on a serializable transactional order. <para> If you're using a WAL archive, its size can be minimized using the <xref - linkend="guc-archive-cleanup-command"/> parameter to remove files that are no - longer required by the standby server. + linkend="guc-archive-cleanup-command"/> parameter or the + <xref linkend="guc-restore-library"/>'s + <function>archive_cleanup_cb</function> callback function to remove files + that are no longer required by the standby server. The <application>pg_archivecleanup</application> utility is designed specifically to be used with <varname>archive_cleanup_command</varname> in typical single-standby configurations, see <xref linkend="pgarchivecleanup"/>. diff --git a/src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c b/src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c index 4752be0b9f..90283c601b 100644 --- a/src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c +++ b/src/backend/access/transam/shell_restore.c @@ -4,7 +4,8 @@ * Recovery functions for a user-specified shell command. * * These recovery functions use a user-specified shell command (e.g. based - * on the GUC restore_command). + * on the GUC restore_command). It is used as the default, but other + * modules may define their own recovery logic. * * Portions Copyright (c) 1996-2023, PostgreSQL Global Development Group * Portions Copyright (c) 1994, Regents of the University of California @@ -24,11 +25,25 @@ #include "storage/ipc.h" #include "utils/wait_event.h" +static bool shell_restore(const char *file, const char *path, + const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +static void shell_archive_cleanup(const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +static void shell_recovery_end(const char *lastRestartPointFileName); static bool ExecuteRecoveryCommand(const char *command, const char *commandName, bool failOnSignal, bool exitOnSigterm, uint32 wait_event_info, int fail_elevel); +void +shell_restore_init(RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb) +{ + AssertVariableIsOfType(&shell_restore_init, RecoveryModuleInit); + + cb->restore_cb = shell_restore; + cb->archive_cleanup_cb = shell_archive_cleanup; + cb->recovery_end_cb = shell_recovery_end; +} + /* * Attempt to execute a shell-based restore command. * @@ -83,7 +98,7 @@ shell_restore(const char *file, const char *path, /* * Attempt to execute a shell-based archive cleanup command. */ -void +static void shell_archive_cleanup(const char *lastRestartPointFileName) { char *cmd; @@ -99,7 +114,7 @@ shell_archive_cleanup(const char *lastRestartPointFileName) /* * Attempt to execute a shell-based end-of-recovery command. */ -void +static void shell_recovery_end(const char *lastRestartPointFileName) { char *cmd; diff --git a/src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c b/src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c index 8f47fb7570..ae537cd87f 100644 --- a/src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c +++ b/src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c @@ -4884,15 +4884,16 @@ static void CleanupAfterArchiveRecovery(TimeLineID EndOfLogTLI, XLogRecPtr EndOfLog, TimeLineID newTLI) { + /* - * Execute the recovery_end_command, if any. + * Execute the recovery-end callback, if any. */ - if (recoveryEndCommand && strcmp(recoveryEndCommand, "") != 0) + if (RecoveryContext.recovery_end_cb) { char lastRestartPointFname[MAXFNAMELEN]; GetOldestRestartPointFileName(lastRestartPointFname); - shell_recovery_end(lastRestartPointFname); + RecoveryContext.recovery_end_cb(lastRestartPointFname); } /* @@ -7307,14 +7308,14 @@ CreateRestartPoint(int flags) timestamptz_to_str(xtime)) : 0)); /* - * Finally, execute archive_cleanup_command, if any. + * Execute the archive-cleanup callback, if any. */ - if (archiveCleanupCommand && strcmp(archiveCleanupCommand, "") != 0) + if (RecoveryContext.archive_cleanup_cb) { char lastRestartPointFname[MAXFNAMELEN]; GetOldestRestartPointFileName(lastRestartPointFname); - shell_archive_cleanup(lastRestartPointFname); + RecoveryContext.archive_cleanup_cb(lastRestartPointFname); } return true; diff --git a/src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c b/src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c index 4b89addf97..4af5689c25 100644 --- a/src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c +++ b/src/backend/access/transam/xlogarchive.c @@ -22,6 +22,8 @@ #include "access/xlog.h" #include "access/xlog_internal.h" #include "access/xlogarchive.h" +#include "access/xlogrecovery.h" +#include "fmgr.h" #include "miscadmin.h" #include "pgstat.h" #include "postmaster/startup.h" @@ -31,6 +33,11 @@ #include "storage/ipc.h" #include "storage/lwlock.h" +/* + * Global context for recovery-related callbacks. + */ +RecoveryModuleCallbacks RecoveryContext; + /* * Attempt to retrieve the specified file from off-line archival storage. * If successful, fill "path" with its complete path (note that this will be @@ -70,7 +77,7 @@ RestoreArchivedFile(char *path, const char *xlogfname, goto not_available; /* In standby mode, restore_command might not be supplied */ - if (recoveryRestoreCommand == NULL || strcmp(recoveryRestoreCommand, "") == 0) + if (RecoveryContext.restore_cb == NULL) goto not_available; /* @@ -148,14 +155,15 @@ RestoreArchivedFile(char *path, const char *xlogfname, XLogFileName(lastRestartPointFname, 0, 0L, wal_segment_size); /* - * Check signals before restore command and reset afterwards. + * Check signals before restore callback and reset afterwards. */ PreRestoreCommand(); /* * Copy xlog from archival storage to XLOGDIR */ - ret = shell_restore(xlogfname, xlogpath, lastRestartPointFname); + ret = RecoveryContext.restore_cb(xlogfname, xlogpath, + lastRestartPointFname); PostRestoreCommand(); @@ -602,3 +610,59 @@ XLogArchiveCleanup(const char *xlog) unlink(archiveStatusPath); /* should we complain about failure? */ } + +/* + * Loads all the recovery callbacks into our global RecoveryContext. The + * caller is responsible for validating the combination of library/command + * parameters that are set (e.g., restore_command and restore_library cannot + * both be set). + */ +void +LoadRecoveryCallbacks(void) +{ + RecoveryModuleInit init; + + /* + * If the shell command is enabled, use our special initialization + * function. Otherwise, load the library and call its + * _PG_recovery_module_init(). + */ + if (restoreLibrary[0] == '\0') + init = shell_restore_init; + else + init = (RecoveryModuleInit) + load_external_function(restoreLibrary, "_PG_recovery_module_init", + false, NULL); + + if (init == NULL) + ereport(ERROR, + (errmsg("recovery modules have to define the symbol " + "_PG_recovery_module_init"))); + + memset(&RecoveryContext, 0, sizeof(RecoveryModuleCallbacks)); + (*init) (&RecoveryContext); + + /* + * If using shell commands, remove callbacks for any commands that are not + * set. + */ + if (restoreLibrary[0] == '\0') + { + if (recoveryRestoreCommand[0] == '\0') + RecoveryContext.restore_cb = NULL; + if (archiveCleanupCommand[0] == '\0') + RecoveryContext.archive_cleanup_cb = NULL; + if (recoveryEndCommand[0] == '\0') + RecoveryContext.recovery_end_cb = NULL; + } +} + +/* + * Call the shutdown callback of the loaded recovery module, if defined. + */ +void +call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb(int code, Datum arg) +{ + if (RecoveryContext.shutdown_cb) + RecoveryContext.shutdown_cb(); +} diff --git a/src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c b/src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c index 5e65785306..db0cd4469a 100644 --- a/src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c +++ b/src/backend/access/transam/xlogrecovery.c @@ -80,6 +80,7 @@ const struct config_enum_entry recovery_target_action_options[] = { /* options formerly taken from recovery.conf for archive recovery */ char *recoveryRestoreCommand = NULL; +char *restoreLibrary = NULL; char *recoveryEndCommand = NULL; char *archiveCleanupCommand = NULL; RecoveryTargetType recoveryTarget = RECOVERY_TARGET_UNSET; @@ -1053,24 +1054,37 @@ validateRecoveryParameters(void) if (!ArchiveRecoveryRequested) return; + /* + * Check for invalid combinations of the command/library parameters and + * load the callbacks. + */ + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + recoveryRestoreCommand, "restore_command"); + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + recoveryEndCommand, "recovery_end_command"); + before_shmem_exit(call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb, 0); + LoadRecoveryCallbacks(); + /* * Check for compulsory parameters */ if (StandbyModeRequested) { if ((PrimaryConnInfo == NULL || strcmp(PrimaryConnInfo, "") == 0) && - (recoveryRestoreCommand == NULL || strcmp(recoveryRestoreCommand, "") == 0)) + RecoveryContext.restore_cb == NULL) ereport(WARNING, - (errmsg("specified neither primary_conninfo nor restore_command"), - errhint("The database server will regularly poll the pg_wal subdirectory to check for files placed there."))); + (errmsg("specified neither primary_conninfo nor restore_command " + "nor a restore_library that defines a restore callback"), + errhint("The database server will regularly poll the pg_wal " + "subdirectory to check for files placed there."))); } else { - if (recoveryRestoreCommand == NULL || - strcmp(recoveryRestoreCommand, "") == 0) + if (RecoveryContext.restore_cb == NULL) ereport(FATAL, (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), - errmsg("must specify restore_command when standby mode is not enabled"))); + errmsg("must specify restore_command or a restore_library that defines " + "a restore callback when standby mode is not enabled"))); } /* diff --git a/src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c b/src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c index de0bbbfa79..6350fd0b83 100644 --- a/src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c +++ b/src/backend/postmaster/checkpointer.c @@ -38,6 +38,7 @@ #include "access/xlog.h" #include "access/xlog_internal.h" +#include "access/xlogarchive.h" #include "access/xlogrecovery.h" #include "libpq/pqsignal.h" #include "miscadmin.h" @@ -222,6 +223,16 @@ CheckpointerMain(void) */ before_shmem_exit(pgstat_before_server_shutdown, 0); + /* + * Check for invalid combinations of the command/library parameters and + * load the callbacks. We do this before setting up the exception handler + * so that any problems result in a server crash shortly after startup. + */ + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + archiveCleanupCommand, "archive_cleanup_command"); + before_shmem_exit(call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb, 0); + LoadRecoveryCallbacks(); + /* * Create a memory context that we will do all our work in. We do this so * that we can reset the context during error recovery and thereby avoid @@ -548,6 +559,9 @@ HandleCheckpointerInterrupts(void) if (ConfigReloadPending) { + char *prevRestoreLibrary = pstrdup(restoreLibrary); + char *prevArchiveCleanupCommand = pstrdup(archiveCleanupCommand); + ConfigReloadPending = false; ProcessConfigFile(PGC_SIGHUP); @@ -563,6 +577,18 @@ HandleCheckpointerInterrupts(void) * because of SIGHUP. */ UpdateSharedMemoryConfig(); + + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + archiveCleanupCommand, "archive_cleanup_command"); + if (strcmp(prevRestoreLibrary, restoreLibrary) != 0 || + strcmp(prevArchiveCleanupCommand, archiveCleanupCommand) != 0) + { + call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb(0, (Datum) 0); + LoadRecoveryCallbacks(); + } + + pfree(prevRestoreLibrary); + pfree(prevArchiveCleanupCommand); } if (ShutdownRequestPending) { diff --git a/src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c b/src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c index 8ecdb9ca23..8e91f2d70f 100644 --- a/src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c +++ b/src/backend/postmaster/pgarch.c @@ -831,11 +831,8 @@ LoadArchiveLibrary(void) { ArchiveModuleInit archive_init; - if (XLogArchiveLibrary[0] != '\0' && XLogArchiveCommand[0] != '\0') - ereport(ERROR, - (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), - errmsg("both archive_command and archive_library set"), - errdetail("Only one of archive_command, archive_library may be set."))); + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(XLogArchiveLibrary, "archive_library", + XLogArchiveCommand, "archive_command"); memset(&ArchiveContext, 0, sizeof(ArchiveModuleCallbacks)); diff --git a/src/backend/postmaster/startup.c b/src/backend/postmaster/startup.c index 8786186898..f9ff2b5583 100644 --- a/src/backend/postmaster/startup.c +++ b/src/backend/postmaster/startup.c @@ -20,6 +20,7 @@ #include "postgres.h" #include "access/xlog.h" +#include "access/xlogarchive.h" #include "access/xlogrecovery.h" #include "access/xlogutils.h" #include "libpq/pqsignal.h" @@ -133,13 +134,17 @@ StartupProcShutdownHandler(SIGNAL_ARGS) * Re-read the config file. * * If one of the critical walreceiver options has changed, flag xlog.c - * to restart it. + * to restart it. Also, check for invalid combinations of the command/library + * parameters and reload the recovery callbacks if necessary. */ static void StartupRereadConfig(void) { char *conninfo = pstrdup(PrimaryConnInfo); char *slotname = pstrdup(PrimarySlotName); + char *prevRestoreLibrary = pstrdup(restoreLibrary); + char *prevRestoreCommand = pstrdup(recoveryRestoreCommand); + char *prevRecoveryEndCommand = pstrdup(recoveryEndCommand); bool tempSlot = wal_receiver_create_temp_slot; bool conninfoChanged; bool slotnameChanged; @@ -161,6 +166,22 @@ StartupRereadConfig(void) if (conninfoChanged || slotnameChanged || tempSlotChanged) StartupRequestWalReceiverRestart(); + + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + recoveryRestoreCommand, "restore_command"); + CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(restoreLibrary, "restore_library", + recoveryEndCommand, "recovery_end_command"); + if (strcmp(prevRestoreLibrary, restoreLibrary) != 0 || + strcmp(prevRestoreCommand, recoveryRestoreCommand) != 0 || + strcmp(prevRecoveryEndCommand, recoveryEndCommand) != 0) + { + call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb(0, (Datum) 0); + LoadRecoveryCallbacks(); + } + + pfree(prevRestoreLibrary); + pfree(prevRestoreCommand); + pfree(prevRecoveryEndCommand); } /* Handle various signals that might be sent to the startup process */ diff --git a/src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c b/src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c index d52069f446..7858e9a649 100644 --- a/src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c +++ b/src/backend/utils/misc/guc.c @@ -6880,3 +6880,17 @@ call_enum_check_hook(struct config_enum *conf, int *newval, void **extra, return true; } + +/* + * ERROR if both parameters are set. + */ +void +CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(const char *p1val, const char *p1name, + const char *p2val, const char *p2name) +{ + if (p1val[0] != '\0' && p2val[0] != '\0') + ereport(ERROR, + (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), + errmsg("both %s and %s set", p1name, p2name), + errdetail("Only one of %s, %s may be set.", p1name, p2name))); +} diff --git a/src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c b/src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c index 5025e80f89..a8a516b0c6 100644 --- a/src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c +++ b/src/backend/utils/misc/guc_tables.c @@ -3776,6 +3776,16 @@ struct config_string ConfigureNamesString[] = NULL, NULL, NULL }, + { + {"restore_library", PGC_SIGHUP, WAL_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY, + gettext_noop("Sets the library that will be called for recovery actions."), + NULL + }, + &restoreLibrary, + "", + NULL, NULL, NULL + }, + { {"archive_cleanup_command", PGC_SIGHUP, WAL_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY, gettext_noop("Sets the shell command that will be executed at every restart point."), diff --git a/src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample b/src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample index 4cceda4162..38fb3e0823 100644 --- a/src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample +++ b/src/backend/utils/misc/postgresql.conf.sample @@ -269,6 +269,7 @@ # placeholders: %p = path of file to restore # %f = file name only # e.g. 'cp /mnt/server/archivedir/%f %p' +#restore_library = '' # library to use for recovery actions #archive_cleanup_command = '' # command to execute at every restartpoint #recovery_end_command = '' # command to execute at completion of recovery diff --git a/src/include/access/xlog_internal.h b/src/include/access/xlog_internal.h index 59fc7bc105..756f0898b5 100644 --- a/src/include/access/xlog_internal.h +++ b/src/include/access/xlog_internal.h @@ -400,5 +400,6 @@ extern PGDLLIMPORT bool ArchiveRecoveryRequested; extern PGDLLIMPORT bool InArchiveRecovery; extern PGDLLIMPORT bool StandbyMode; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *recoveryRestoreCommand; +extern PGDLLIMPORT char *restoreLibrary; #endif /* XLOG_INTERNAL_H */ diff --git a/src/include/access/xlogarchive.h b/src/include/access/xlogarchive.h index 299304703e..71c9b88165 100644 --- a/src/include/access/xlogarchive.h +++ b/src/include/access/xlogarchive.h @@ -30,9 +30,45 @@ extern bool XLogArchiveIsReady(const char *xlog); extern bool XLogArchiveIsReadyOrDone(const char *xlog); extern void XLogArchiveCleanup(const char *xlog); -extern bool shell_restore(const char *file, const char *path, - const char *lastRestartPointFileName); -extern void shell_archive_cleanup(const char *lastRestartPointFileName); -extern void shell_recovery_end(const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +/* + * Recovery module callbacks + * + * These callback functions should be defined by recovery libraries and + * returned via _PG_recovery_module_init(). For more information about the + * purpose of each callback, refer to the recovery modules documentation. + */ +typedef bool (*RecoveryRestoreCB) (const char *file, const char *path, + const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +typedef void (*RecoveryArchiveCleanupCB) (const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +typedef void (*RecoveryEndCB) (const char *lastRestartPointFileName); +typedef void (*RecoveryShutdownCB) (void); + +typedef struct RecoveryModuleCallbacks +{ + RecoveryRestoreCB restore_cb; + RecoveryArchiveCleanupCB archive_cleanup_cb; + RecoveryEndCB recovery_end_cb; + RecoveryShutdownCB shutdown_cb; +} RecoveryModuleCallbacks; + +extern RecoveryModuleCallbacks RecoveryContext; + +/* + * Type of the shared library symbol _PG_recovery_module_init that is looked up + * when loading a recovery library. + */ +typedef void (*RecoveryModuleInit) (RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb); + +extern PGDLLEXPORT void _PG_recovery_module_init(RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb); + +extern void LoadRecoveryCallbacks(void); +extern void call_recovery_module_shutdown_cb(int code, Datum arg); + +/* + * Since the logic for recovery via a shell command is in the core server and + * does not need to be loaded via a shared library, it has a special + * initialization function. + */ +extern void shell_restore_init(RecoveryModuleCallbacks *cb); #endif /* XLOG_ARCHIVE_H */ diff --git a/src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h b/src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h index 47c29350f5..35d1d09374 100644 --- a/src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h +++ b/src/include/access/xlogrecovery.h @@ -55,6 +55,7 @@ extern PGDLLIMPORT int recovery_min_apply_delay; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *PrimaryConnInfo; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *PrimarySlotName; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *recoveryRestoreCommand; +extern PGDLLIMPORT char *restoreLibrary; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *recoveryEndCommand; extern PGDLLIMPORT char *archiveCleanupCommand; diff --git a/src/include/utils/guc.h b/src/include/utils/guc.h index ba89d013e6..947597247f 100644 --- a/src/include/utils/guc.h +++ b/src/include/utils/guc.h @@ -404,6 +404,8 @@ extern void *guc_malloc(int elevel, size_t size); extern pg_nodiscard void *guc_realloc(int elevel, void *old, size_t size); extern char *guc_strdup(int elevel, const char *src); extern void guc_free(void *ptr); +extern void CheckMutuallyExclusiveGUCs(const char *p1val, const char *p1name, + const char *p2val, const char *p2name); #ifdef EXEC_BACKEND extern void write_nondefault_variables(GucContext context); -- 2.25.1 --UugvWAfsgieZRqgk-- ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 17+ messages in thread
* Re: jsonapi: scary new warnings with LTO enabled @ 2025-04-17 15:20 Tom Lane <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 1 reply; 17+ messages in thread From: Tom Lane @ 2025-04-17 15:20 UTC (permalink / raw) To: Daniel Gustafsson <[email protected]>; +Cc: Jacob Champion <[email protected]>; [email protected] Daniel Gustafsson <[email protected]> writes: > Agreed, moving to heap allocated structures for these callsites seem much > better. Something like the attached should be enough I think? I confirm this silences those warnings on my Fedora 41 box. I'm content to do it like this, but maybe Jacob wants to investigate alternatives? regards, tom lane ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 17+ messages in thread
* Re: jsonapi: scary new warnings with LTO enabled @ 2025-04-17 15:48 Jacob Champion <[email protected]> parent: Tom Lane <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 1 reply; 17+ messages in thread From: Jacob Champion @ 2025-04-17 15:48 UTC (permalink / raw) To: Tom Lane <[email protected]>; +Cc: Daniel Gustafsson <[email protected]>; [email protected] On Thu, Apr 17, 2025 at 8:20 AM Tom Lane <[email protected]> wrote: > I confirm this silences those warnings on my Fedora 41 box. Instead of doing lex = calloc(...); /* (error out on NULL return) */ makeJsonLexContextCstringLen(lex, ...); we need to do lex = makeJsonLexContextCstringLen(NULL, ...); /* (error out on NULL return) */ so that JSONLEX_FREE_STRUCT is set correctly. Otherwise we'll leak the main allocation: ==12550==ERROR: LeakSanitizer: detected memory leaks Direct leak of 120 byte(s) in 1 object(s) allocated from: #0 0xaaaae34d2a84 in __interceptor_calloc (/home/jacob/src/postgres/worktree-oauth/build-clang/src/interfaces/libpq/fuzz_libpq_handle_oauth_sasl_error+0x112a84) (BuildId: 359bf20b63a97771ccb3bd2c238485920485521f) #1 0xaaaae3510ff0 in handle_oauth_sasl_error /home/jacob/src/postgres/worktree-oauth/build-clang/../src/interfaces/libpq/fe-auth-oauth.c:511:8 > I'm content to do it like this, but maybe Jacob wants to > investigate alternatives? I was more worried about it when you said you wanted to get rid of the stack allocation API. (I like having the flexibility to choose between the two forms, not just for performance but also for struct embedding.) But I'm perfectly happy with just adjusting these sites. Thanks! --Jacob ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 17+ messages in thread
* Re: jsonapi: scary new warnings with LTO enabled @ 2025-04-19 21:15 Daniel Gustafsson <[email protected]> parent: Jacob Champion <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 1 reply; 17+ messages in thread From: Daniel Gustafsson @ 2025-04-19 21:15 UTC (permalink / raw) To: Jacob Champion <[email protected]>; +Cc: Tom Lane <[email protected]>; PostgreSQL Developers <[email protected]> > On 17 Apr 2025, at 17:48, Jacob Champion <[email protected]> wrote: > > On Thu, Apr 17, 2025 at 8:20 AM Tom Lane <[email protected]> wrote: >> I confirm this silences those warnings on my Fedora 41 box. > > Instead of doing > > lex = calloc(...); > /* (error out on NULL return) */ > makeJsonLexContextCstringLen(lex, ...); > > we need to do > > lex = makeJsonLexContextCstringLen(NULL, ...); > /* (error out on NULL return) */ > > so that JSONLEX_FREE_STRUCT is set correctly. Otherwise we'll leak the > main allocation: Since there is no way to determine if the allocation succeeded from outside of the JSON api it might be better to keep the calloc and explicitly free it? (Could a JsonLexContextBroken() function be useful perhaps?) -- Daniel Gustafsson Attachments: [application/octet-stream] v2-0001-Allocate-JsonLexContexts-on-the-heap-to-avoid-war.patch (5.5K, ../../[email protected]/2-v2-0001-Allocate-JsonLexContexts-on-the-heap-to-avoid-war.patch) download | inline diff: From c3b7d7e78330649fe05c8e5f97626e7eb03d2827 Mon Sep 17 00:00:00 2001 From: Daniel Gustafsson <[email protected]> Date: Sat, 19 Apr 2025 21:32:40 +0200 Subject: [PATCH v2] Allocate JsonLexContexts on the heap to avoid warnings The stack allocated JsonLexContexts, in combination with codepaths using goto, were causing warnings when compiling with LTO enabled as the optimizer is unable to figure out that is safe. Rather than contort the code with workarounds for this simply heap allocate the structs instead as these are not in any performance critical paths. Reported-by: Tom Lane <[email protected]> Reviewed-by: Jacob Champion <[email protected]> Reviewed-by: Tom Lane <[email protected]> Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/[email protected] --- src/interfaces/libpq/fe-auth-oauth.c | 24 ++++++++++++++----- .../test_json_parser_incremental.c | 22 ++++++++++------- 2 files changed, 31 insertions(+), 15 deletions(-) diff --git a/src/interfaces/libpq/fe-auth-oauth.c b/src/interfaces/libpq/fe-auth-oauth.c index cf1a25e2ccc..5ebca6a0ef6 100644 --- a/src/interfaces/libpq/fe-auth-oauth.c +++ b/src/interfaces/libpq/fe-auth-oauth.c @@ -476,7 +476,7 @@ issuer_from_well_known_uri(PGconn *conn, const char *wkuri) static bool handle_oauth_sasl_error(PGconn *conn, const char *msg, int msglen) { - JsonLexContext lex = {0}; + JsonLexContext *lex; JsonSemAction sem = {0}; JsonParseErrorType err; struct json_ctx ctx = {0}; @@ -504,8 +504,19 @@ handle_oauth_sasl_error(PGconn *conn, const char *msg, int msglen) return false; } - makeJsonLexContextCstringLen(&lex, msg, msglen, PG_UTF8, true); - setJsonLexContextOwnsTokens(&lex, true); /* must not leak on error */ + /* + * Later error paths need to go via the cleanup label but since ctx hasn't + * been initiated yet we return immediately here. + */ + lex = calloc(1, sizeof(JsonLexContext)); + if (!lex) + { + libpq_append_conn_error(conn, "out of memory"); + return false; + } + + makeJsonLexContextCstringLen(lex, msg, msglen, PG_UTF8, true); + setJsonLexContextOwnsTokens(lex, true); /* must not leak on error */ initPQExpBuffer(&ctx.errbuf); sem.semstate = &ctx; @@ -516,7 +527,7 @@ handle_oauth_sasl_error(PGconn *conn, const char *msg, int msglen) sem.array_start = oauth_json_array_start; sem.scalar = oauth_json_scalar; - err = pg_parse_json(&lex, &sem); + err = pg_parse_json(lex, &sem); if (err == JSON_SEM_ACTION_FAILED) { @@ -535,7 +546,7 @@ handle_oauth_sasl_error(PGconn *conn, const char *msg, int msglen) } } else if (err != JSON_SUCCESS) - errmsg = json_errdetail(err, &lex); + errmsg = json_errdetail(err, lex); if (errmsg) libpq_append_conn_error(conn, @@ -544,7 +555,8 @@ handle_oauth_sasl_error(PGconn *conn, const char *msg, int msglen) /* Don't need the error buffer or the JSON lexer anymore. */ termPQExpBuffer(&ctx.errbuf); - freeJsonLexContext(&lex); + freeJsonLexContext(lex); + free(lex); if (errmsg) goto cleanup; diff --git a/src/test/modules/test_json_parser/test_json_parser_incremental.c b/src/test/modules/test_json_parser/test_json_parser_incremental.c index a529ee47e9b..357152e0ae0 100644 --- a/src/test/modules/test_json_parser/test_json_parser_incremental.c +++ b/src/test/modules/test_json_parser/test_json_parser_incremental.c @@ -84,7 +84,7 @@ main(int argc, char **argv) char buff[BUFSIZE]; FILE *json_file; JsonParseErrorType result; - JsonLexContext lex; + JsonLexContext *lex; StringInfoData json; int n_read; size_t chunk_size = DEFAULT_CHUNK_SIZE; @@ -98,6 +98,10 @@ main(int argc, char **argv) pg_logging_init(argv[0]); + lex = calloc(1, sizeof(JsonLexContext)); + if (!lex) + pg_fatal("out of memory"); + while ((c = getopt(argc, argv, "c:os")) != -1) { switch (c) @@ -113,7 +117,7 @@ main(int argc, char **argv) case 's': /* do semantic processing */ testsem = &sem; sem.semstate = palloc(sizeof(struct DoState)); - ((struct DoState *) sem.semstate)->lex = &lex; + ((struct DoState *) sem.semstate)->lex = lex; ((struct DoState *) sem.semstate)->buf = makeStringInfo(); need_strings = true; break; @@ -131,8 +135,8 @@ main(int argc, char **argv) exit(1); } - makeJsonLexContextIncremental(&lex, PG_UTF8, need_strings); - setJsonLexContextOwnsTokens(&lex, lex_owns_tokens); + makeJsonLexContextIncremental(lex, PG_UTF8, need_strings); + setJsonLexContextOwnsTokens(lex, lex_owns_tokens); initStringInfo(&json); if ((json_file = fopen(testfile, PG_BINARY_R)) == NULL) @@ -165,12 +169,12 @@ main(int argc, char **argv) bytes_left -= n_read; if (bytes_left > 0) { - result = pg_parse_json_incremental(&lex, testsem, + result = pg_parse_json_incremental(lex, testsem, json.data, n_read, false); if (result != JSON_INCOMPLETE) { - fprintf(stderr, "%s\n", json_errdetail(result, &lex)); + fprintf(stderr, "%s\n", json_errdetail(result, lex)); ret = 1; goto cleanup; } @@ -178,12 +182,12 @@ main(int argc, char **argv) } else { - result = pg_parse_json_incremental(&lex, testsem, + result = pg_parse_json_incremental(lex, testsem, json.data, n_read, true); if (result != JSON_SUCCESS) { - fprintf(stderr, "%s\n", json_errdetail(result, &lex)); + fprintf(stderr, "%s\n", json_errdetail(result, lex)); ret = 1; goto cleanup; } @@ -195,7 +199,7 @@ main(int argc, char **argv) cleanup: fclose(json_file); - freeJsonLexContext(&lex); + freeJsonLexContext(lex); free(json.data); return ret; -- 2.39.3 (Apple Git-146) ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 17+ messages in thread
* Re: jsonapi: scary new warnings with LTO enabled @ 2025-04-21 15:33 Jacob Champion <[email protected]> parent: Daniel Gustafsson <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 1 reply; 17+ messages in thread From: Jacob Champion @ 2025-04-21 15:33 UTC (permalink / raw) To: Daniel Gustafsson <[email protected]>; +Cc: Tom Lane <[email protected]>; PostgreSQL Developers <[email protected]> On Sat, Apr 19, 2025 at 2:15 PM Daniel Gustafsson <[email protected]> wrote: > Since there is no way to determine if the allocation succeeded from outside of > the JSON api it might be better to keep the calloc and explicitly free it? I don't think so; pg_parse_json() will error out quickly, so I don't see much advantage to the extra code. Raw performance isn't much of a concern for the out-of-memory case, IMO. > (Could a JsonLexContextBroken() function be useful perhaps?) Maybe if there's ever a client that absolutely must initialize a context before doing a bunch of independent work? But I don't think that's true here. (Any callers we're converting from the stack API are going to have short-lived contexts.) --Jacob ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 17+ messages in thread
* Re: jsonapi: scary new warnings with LTO enabled @ 2025-04-21 18:20 Daniel Gustafsson <[email protected]> parent: Jacob Champion <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 1 reply; 17+ messages in thread From: Daniel Gustafsson @ 2025-04-21 18:20 UTC (permalink / raw) To: Jacob Champion <[email protected]>; +Cc: Tom Lane <[email protected]>; PostgreSQL Developers <[email protected]> > On 21 Apr 2025, at 17:33, Jacob Champion <[email protected]> wrote: > > On Sat, Apr 19, 2025 at 2:15 PM Daniel Gustafsson <[email protected]> wrote: >> Since there is no way to determine if the allocation succeeded from outside of >> the JSON api it might be better to keep the calloc and explicitly free it? > > I don't think so; pg_parse_json() will error out quickly, so I don't > see much advantage to the extra code. Raw performance isn't much of a > concern for the out-of-memory case, IMO. Sure, but I fear we'll get an endless stream of static analysis reports for the allocation leaking if we don't free it. -- Daniel Gustafsson ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 17+ messages in thread
* Re: jsonapi: scary new warnings with LTO enabled @ 2025-04-21 18:28 Jacob Champion <[email protected]> parent: Daniel Gustafsson <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 1 reply; 17+ messages in thread From: Jacob Champion @ 2025-04-21 18:28 UTC (permalink / raw) To: Daniel Gustafsson <[email protected]>; +Cc: Tom Lane <[email protected]>; PostgreSQL Developers <[email protected]> On Mon, Apr 21, 2025 at 11:20 AM Daniel Gustafsson <[email protected]> wrote: > Sure, but I fear we'll get an endless stream of static analysis reports for the > allocation leaking if we don't free it. But we do free it, in freeJsonLexContext(). That usage of the API goes back to 2023, with 1c99cde2f344. Or am I misunderstanding? --Jacob ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 17+ messages in thread
* Re: jsonapi: scary new warnings with LTO enabled @ 2025-04-21 18:46 Daniel Gustafsson <[email protected]> parent: Jacob Champion <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 1 reply; 17+ messages in thread From: Daniel Gustafsson @ 2025-04-21 18:46 UTC (permalink / raw) To: Jacob Champion <[email protected]>; +Cc: Tom Lane <[email protected]>; PostgreSQL Developers <[email protected]> > On 21 Apr 2025, at 20:28, Jacob Champion <[email protected]> wrote: > > On Mon, Apr 21, 2025 at 11:20 AM Daniel Gustafsson <[email protected]> wrote: >> Sure, but I fear we'll get an endless stream of static analysis reports for the >> allocation leaking if we don't free it. > > But we do free it, in freeJsonLexContext(). That usage of the API goes > back to 2023, with 1c99cde2f344. Or am I misunderstanding? We do, but with the current coding we call setJsonLexContextOwnsTokens immediately after creation which derefences the pointer without checkinf for allocation failure. This means we dereference the pointer before we can check for an OOM return from pg_parse_json which even if safe seems to violate code readability no? -- Daniel Gustafsson ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 17+ messages in thread
* Re: jsonapi: scary new warnings with LTO enabled @ 2025-04-21 18:58 Jacob Champion <[email protected]> parent: Daniel Gustafsson <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 17+ messages in thread From: Jacob Champion @ 2025-04-21 18:58 UTC (permalink / raw) To: Daniel Gustafsson <[email protected]>; +Cc: Tom Lane <[email protected]>; PostgreSQL Developers <[email protected]> On Mon, Apr 21, 2025 at 11:46 AM Daniel Gustafsson <[email protected]> wrote: > We do, but with the current coding we call setJsonLexContextOwnsTokens > immediately after creation which derefences the pointer without checkinf for > allocation failure. Right. (The flag does nothing on the OOM sentinel.) > This means we dereference the pointer before we can check > for an OOM return from pg_parse_json which even if safe seems to violate code > readability no? Personally, I'm fine with can't-fail APIs, as long as they're documented as such. (I think the deferred error API was probably chosen so that src/common JSON clients could be written without a lot of pain?) --Jacob ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 17+ messages in thread
end of thread, other threads:[~2025-04-21 18:58 UTC | newest] Thread overview: 17+ messages (download: mbox mbox.gz follow: Atom feed) -- links below jump to the message on this page -- 2022-12-10 03:40 [PATCH v3 3/3] Allow recovery via loadable modules. Nathan Bossart <[email protected]> 2022-12-10 03:40 [PATCH v5 3/3] Allow recovery via loadable modules. Nathan Bossart <[email protected]> 2022-12-10 03:40 [PATCH v9 1/1] Allow recovery via loadable modules. Nathan Bossart <[email protected]> 2022-12-10 03:40 [PATCH v7 2/2] Allow recovery via loadable modules. Nathan Bossart <[email protected]> 2022-12-10 03:40 [PATCH v8 2/2] Allow recovery via loadable modules. Nathan Bossart <[email protected]> 2022-12-10 03:40 [PATCH v1 3/3] Allow recovery via loadable modules. Nathan Bossart <[email protected]> 2022-12-10 03:40 [PATCH v2 3/3] Allow recovery via loadable modules. Nathan Bossart <[email protected]> 2022-12-10 03:40 [PATCH v4 3/3] Allow recovery via loadable modules. Nathan Bossart <[email protected]> 2022-12-10 03:40 [PATCH v6 3/3] Allow recovery via loadable modules. Nathan Bossart <[email protected]> 2025-04-17 15:20 Re: jsonapi: scary new warnings with LTO enabled Tom Lane <[email protected]> 2025-04-17 15:48 ` Re: jsonapi: scary new warnings with LTO enabled Jacob Champion <[email protected]> 2025-04-19 21:15 ` Re: jsonapi: scary new warnings with LTO enabled Daniel Gustafsson <[email protected]> 2025-04-21 15:33 ` Re: jsonapi: scary new warnings with LTO enabled Jacob Champion <[email protected]> 2025-04-21 18:20 ` Re: jsonapi: scary new warnings with LTO enabled Daniel Gustafsson <[email protected]> 2025-04-21 18:28 ` Re: jsonapi: scary new warnings with LTO enabled Jacob Champion <[email protected]> 2025-04-21 18:46 ` Re: jsonapi: scary new warnings with LTO enabled Daniel Gustafsson <[email protected]> 2025-04-21 18:58 ` Re: jsonapi: scary new warnings with LTO enabled Jacob Champion <[email protected]>
This inbox is served by agora; see mirroring instructions for how to clone and mirror all data and code used for this inbox